summaryrefslogtreecommitdiffstats
path: root/depedencies/include
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
Diffstat (limited to 'depedencies/include')
-rw-r--r--depedencies/include/imconfig.h58
-rw-r--r--depedencies/include/imgui.h1487
-rw-r--r--depedencies/include/imgui_internal.h829
-rw-r--r--depedencies/include/stb_rect_pack.h583
-rw-r--r--depedencies/include/stb_textedit.h1322
-rw-r--r--depedencies/include/stb_truetype.h4018
6 files changed, 8297 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/depedencies/include/imconfig.h b/depedencies/include/imconfig.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..e557fa0
--- /dev/null
+++ b/depedencies/include/imconfig.h
@@ -0,0 +1,58 @@
+//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+// USER IMPLEMENTATION
+// This file contains compile-time options for ImGui.
+// Other options (memory allocation overrides, callbacks, etc.) can be set at runtime via the ImGuiIO structure - ImGui::GetIO().
+//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+#pragma once
+
+//---- Define assertion handler. Defaults to calling assert().
+//#define IM_ASSERT(_EXPR) MyAssert(_EXPR)
+
+//---- Define attributes of all API symbols declarations, e.g. for DLL under Windows.
+//#define IMGUI_API __declspec( dllexport )
+//#define IMGUI_API __declspec( dllimport )
+
+//---- Include imgui_user.h at the end of imgui.h
+//#define IMGUI_INCLUDE_IMGUI_USER_H
+
+//---- Don't implement default handlers for Windows (so as not to link with OpenClipboard() and others Win32 functions)
+//#define IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_CLIPBOARD_FUNCS
+//#define IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_IME_FUNCS
+
+//---- Don't implement test window functionality (ShowTestWindow()/ShowStyleEditor()/ShowUserGuide() methods will be empty)
+//---- It is very strongly recommended to NOT disable the test windows. Please read the comment at the top of imgui_demo.cpp to learn why.
+//#define IMGUI_DISABLE_TEST_WINDOWS
+
+//---- Don't define obsolete functions names. Consider enabling from time to time or when updating to reduce like hood of using already obsolete function/names
+//#define IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS
+
+//---- Pack colors to BGRA instead of RGBA (remove need to post process vertex buffer in back ends)
+//#define IMGUI_USE_BGRA_PACKED_COLOR
+
+//---- Implement STB libraries in a namespace to avoid conflicts
+//#define IMGUI_STB_NAMESPACE ImGuiStb
+
+//---- Define constructor and implicit cast operators to convert back<>forth from your math types and ImVec2/ImVec4.
+/*
+#define IM_VEC2_CLASS_EXTRA \
+ ImVec2(const MyVec2& f) { x = f.x; y = f.y; } \
+ operator MyVec2() const { return MyVec2(x,y); }
+
+#define IM_VEC4_CLASS_EXTRA \
+ ImVec4(const MyVec4& f) { x = f.x; y = f.y; z = f.z; w = f.w; } \
+ operator MyVec4() const { return MyVec4(x,y,z,w); }
+*/
+
+//---- Use 32-bit vertex indices (instead of default: 16-bit) to allow meshes with more than 64K vertices
+//#define ImDrawIdx unsigned int
+
+//---- Tip: You can add extra functions within the ImGui:: namespace, here or in your own headers files.
+//---- e.g. create variants of the ImGui::Value() helper for your low-level math types, or your own widgets/helpers.
+/*
+namespace ImGui
+{
+ void Value(const char* prefix, const MyMatrix44& v, const char* float_format = NULL);
+}
+*/
+
diff --git a/depedencies/include/imgui.h b/depedencies/include/imgui.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..7100fb2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/depedencies/include/imgui.h
@@ -0,0 +1,1487 @@
+// dear imgui, v1.52 WIP
+// (headers)
+
+// See imgui.cpp file for documentation.
+// See ImGui::ShowTestWindow() in imgui_demo.cpp for demo code.
+// Read 'Programmer guide' in imgui.cpp for notes on how to setup ImGui in your codebase.
+// Get latest version at https://github.com/ocornut/imgui
+
+#pragma once
+
+#if !defined(IMGUI_DISABLE_INCLUDE_IMCONFIG_H) || defined(IMGUI_INCLUDE_IMCONFIG_H)
+#include "imconfig.h" // User-editable configuration file
+#endif
+#include <float.h> // FLT_MAX
+#include <stdarg.h> // va_list
+#include <stddef.h> // ptrdiff_t, NULL
+#include <string.h> // memset, memmove, memcpy, strlen, strchr, strcpy, strcmp
+
+#define IMGUI_VERSION "1.52 WIP"
+
+// Define attributes of all API symbols declarations, e.g. for DLL under Windows.
+#ifndef IMGUI_API
+#define IMGUI_API
+#endif
+
+// Define assertion handler.
+#ifndef IM_ASSERT
+#include <assert.h>
+#define IM_ASSERT(_EXPR) assert(_EXPR)
+#endif
+
+// Some compilers support applying printf-style warnings to user functions.
+#if defined(__clang__) || defined(__GNUC__)
+#define IM_FMTARGS(FMT) __attribute__((format(printf, FMT, FMT+1)))
+#define IM_FMTLIST(FMT) __attribute__((format(printf, FMT, 0)))
+#else
+#define IM_FMTARGS(FMT)
+#define IM_FMTLIST(FMT)
+#endif
+
+#if defined(__clang__)
+#pragma clang diagnostic push
+#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wold-style-cast"
+#endif
+
+// Forward declarations
+struct ImDrawChannel; // Temporary storage for outputting drawing commands out of order, used by ImDrawList::ChannelsSplit()
+struct ImDrawCmd; // A single draw command within a parent ImDrawList (generally maps to 1 GPU draw call)
+struct ImDrawData; // All draw command lists required to render the frame
+struct ImDrawList; // A single draw command list (generally one per window)
+struct ImDrawVert; // A single vertex (20 bytes by default, override layout with IMGUI_OVERRIDE_DRAWVERT_STRUCT_LAYOUT)
+struct ImFont; // Runtime data for a single font within a parent ImFontAtlas
+struct ImFontAtlas; // Runtime data for multiple fonts, bake multiple fonts into a single texture, TTF/OTF font loader
+struct ImFontConfig; // Configuration data when adding a font or merging fonts
+struct ImColor; // Helper functions to create a color that can be converted to either u32 or float4
+struct ImGuiIO; // Main configuration and I/O between your application and ImGui
+struct ImGuiOnceUponAFrame; // Simple helper for running a block of code not more than once a frame, used by IMGUI_ONCE_UPON_A_FRAME macro
+struct ImGuiStorage; // Simple custom key value storage
+struct ImGuiStyle; // Runtime data for styling/colors
+struct ImGuiTextFilter; // Parse and apply text filters. In format "aaaaa[,bbbb][,ccccc]"
+struct ImGuiTextBuffer; // Text buffer for logging/accumulating text
+struct ImGuiTextEditCallbackData; // Shared state of ImGui::InputText() when using custom ImGuiTextEditCallback (rare/advanced use)
+struct ImGuiSizeConstraintCallbackData;// Structure used to constraint window size in custom ways when using custom ImGuiSizeConstraintCallback (rare/advanced use)
+struct ImGuiListClipper; // Helper to manually clip large list of items
+struct ImGuiContext; // ImGui context (opaque)
+
+// Typedefs and Enumerations (declared as int for compatibility and to not pollute the top of this file)
+typedef unsigned int ImU32; // 32-bit unsigned integer (typically used to store packed colors)
+typedef unsigned int ImGuiID; // unique ID used by widgets (typically hashed from a stack of string)
+typedef unsigned short ImWchar; // character for keyboard input/display
+typedef void* ImTextureID; // user data to identify a texture (this is whatever to you want it to be! read the FAQ about ImTextureID in imgui.cpp)
+typedef int ImGuiCol; // a color identifier for styling // enum ImGuiCol_
+typedef int ImGuiStyleVar; // a variable identifier for styling // enum ImGuiStyleVar_
+typedef int ImGuiKey; // a key identifier (ImGui-side enum) // enum ImGuiKey_
+typedef int ImGuiColorEditFlags; // color edit flags for Color*() // enum ImGuiColorEditFlags_
+typedef int ImGuiMouseCursor; // a mouse cursor identifier // enum ImGuiMouseCursor_
+typedef int ImGuiWindowFlags; // window flags for Begin*() // enum ImGuiWindowFlags_
+typedef int ImGuiCond; // condition flags for Set*() // enum ImGuiCond_
+typedef int ImGuiColumnsFlags; // flags for *Columns*() // enum ImGuiColumnsFlags_
+typedef int ImGuiInputTextFlags; // flags for InputText*() // enum ImGuiInputTextFlags_
+typedef int ImGuiSelectableFlags; // flags for Selectable() // enum ImGuiSelectableFlags_
+typedef int ImGuiTreeNodeFlags; // flags for TreeNode*(), Collapsing*() // enum ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_
+typedef int (*ImGuiTextEditCallback)(ImGuiTextEditCallbackData *data);
+typedef void (*ImGuiSizeConstraintCallback)(ImGuiSizeConstraintCallbackData* data);
+#ifdef _MSC_VER
+typedef unsigned __int64 ImU64; // 64-bit unsigned integer
+#else
+typedef unsigned long long ImU64; // 64-bit unsigned integer
+#endif
+
+// Others helpers at bottom of the file:
+// class ImVector<> // Lightweight std::vector like class.
+// IMGUI_ONCE_UPON_A_FRAME // Execute a block of code once per frame only (convenient for creating UI within deep-nested code that runs multiple times)
+
+struct ImVec2
+{
+ float x, y;
+ ImVec2() { x = y = 0.0f; }
+ ImVec2(float _x, float _y) { x = _x; y = _y; }
+#ifdef IM_VEC2_CLASS_EXTRA // Define constructor and implicit cast operators in imconfig.h to convert back<>forth from your math types and ImVec2.
+ IM_VEC2_CLASS_EXTRA
+#endif
+};
+
+struct ImVec4
+{
+ float x, y, z, w;
+ ImVec4() { x = y = z = w = 0.0f; }
+ ImVec4(float _x, float _y, float _z, float _w) { x = _x; y = _y; z = _z; w = _w; }
+#ifdef IM_VEC4_CLASS_EXTRA // Define constructor and implicit cast operators in imconfig.h to convert back<>forth from your math types and ImVec4.
+ IM_VEC4_CLASS_EXTRA
+#endif
+};
+
+// ImGui end-user API
+// In a namespace so that user can add extra functions in a separate file (e.g. Value() helpers for your vector or common types)
+namespace ImGui
+{
+ // Main
+ IMGUI_API ImGuiIO& GetIO();
+ IMGUI_API ImGuiStyle& GetStyle();
+ IMGUI_API ImDrawData* GetDrawData(); // same value as passed to your io.RenderDrawListsFn() function. valid after Render() and until the next call to NewFrame()
+ IMGUI_API void NewFrame(); // start a new ImGui frame, you can submit any command from this point until NewFrame()/Render().
+ IMGUI_API void Render(); // ends the ImGui frame, finalize rendering data, then call your io.RenderDrawListsFn() function if set.
+ IMGUI_API void Shutdown();
+
+ // Demo/Debug/Info
+ IMGUI_API void ShowTestWindow(bool* p_open = NULL); // create demo/test window. demonstrate most ImGui features. call this to learn about the library! try to make it always available in your application!
+ IMGUI_API void ShowMetricsWindow(bool* p_open = NULL); // create metrics window. display ImGui internals: browse window list, draw commands, individual vertices, basic internal state, etc.
+ IMGUI_API void ShowStyleEditor(ImGuiStyle* ref = NULL); // add style editor block (not a window). you can pass in a reference ImGuiStyle structure to compare to, revert to and save to (else it uses the default style)
+ IMGUI_API void ShowUserGuide(); // add basic help/info block (not a window): how to manipulate ImGui as a end-user (mouse/keyboard controls).
+
+ // Window
+ IMGUI_API bool Begin(const char* name, bool* p_open = NULL, ImGuiWindowFlags flags = 0); // push window to the stack and start appending to it. see .cpp for details. return false when window is collapsed, so you can early out in your code. 'bool* p_open' creates a widget on the upper-right to close the window (which sets your bool to false).
+ IMGUI_API bool Begin(const char* name, bool* p_open, const ImVec2& size_on_first_use, float bg_alpha = -1.0f, ImGuiWindowFlags flags = 0); // OBSOLETE. this is the older/longer API. the extra parameters aren't very relevant. call SetNextWindowSize() instead if you want to set a window size. For regular windows, 'size_on_first_use' only applies to the first time EVER the window is created and probably not what you want! might obsolete this API eventually.
+ IMGUI_API void End(); // finish appending to current window, pop it off the window stack.
+ IMGUI_API bool BeginChild(const char* str_id, const ImVec2& size = ImVec2(0,0), bool border = false, ImGuiWindowFlags extra_flags = 0); // begin a scrolling region. size==0.0f: use remaining window size, size<0.0f: use remaining window size minus abs(size). size>0.0f: fixed size. each axis can use a different mode, e.g. ImVec2(0,400).
+ IMGUI_API bool BeginChild(ImGuiID id, const ImVec2& size = ImVec2(0,0), bool border = false, ImGuiWindowFlags extra_flags = 0); // "
+ IMGUI_API void EndChild();
+ IMGUI_API ImVec2 GetContentRegionMax(); // current content boundaries (typically window boundaries including scrolling, or current column boundaries), in windows coordinates
+ IMGUI_API ImVec2 GetContentRegionAvail(); // == GetContentRegionMax() - GetCursorPos()
+ IMGUI_API float GetContentRegionAvailWidth(); //
+ IMGUI_API ImVec2 GetWindowContentRegionMin(); // content boundaries min (roughly (0,0)-Scroll), in window coordinates
+ IMGUI_API ImVec2 GetWindowContentRegionMax(); // content boundaries max (roughly (0,0)+Size-Scroll) where Size can be override with SetNextWindowContentSize(), in window coordinates
+ IMGUI_API float GetWindowContentRegionWidth(); //
+ IMGUI_API ImDrawList* GetWindowDrawList(); // get rendering command-list if you want to append your own draw primitives
+ IMGUI_API ImVec2 GetWindowPos(); // get current window position in screen space (useful if you want to do your own drawing via the DrawList api)
+ IMGUI_API ImVec2 GetWindowSize(); // get current window size
+ IMGUI_API float GetWindowWidth();
+ IMGUI_API float GetWindowHeight();
+ IMGUI_API bool IsWindowCollapsed();
+ IMGUI_API void SetWindowFontScale(float scale); // per-window font scale. Adjust IO.FontGlobalScale if you want to scale all windows
+
+ IMGUI_API void SetNextWindowPos(const ImVec2& pos, ImGuiCond cond = 0); // set next window position. call before Begin()
+ IMGUI_API void SetNextWindowPosCenter(ImGuiCond cond = 0); // set next window position to be centered on screen. call before Begin()
+ IMGUI_API void SetNextWindowSize(const ImVec2& size, ImGuiCond cond = 0); // set next window size. set axis to 0.0f to force an auto-fit on this axis. call before Begin()
+ IMGUI_API void SetNextWindowSizeConstraints(const ImVec2& size_min, const ImVec2& size_max, ImGuiSizeConstraintCallback custom_callback = NULL, void* custom_callback_data = NULL); // set next window size limits. use -1,-1 on either X/Y axis to preserve the current size. Use callback to apply non-trivial programmatic constraints.
+ IMGUI_API void SetNextWindowContentSize(const ImVec2& size); // set next window content size (enforce the range of scrollbars). set axis to 0.0f to leave it automatic. call before Begin()
+ IMGUI_API void SetNextWindowContentWidth(float width); // set next window content width (enforce the range of horizontal scrollbar). call before Begin()
+ IMGUI_API void SetNextWindowCollapsed(bool collapsed, ImGuiCond cond = 0); // set next window collapsed state. call before Begin()
+ IMGUI_API void SetNextWindowFocus(); // set next window to be focused / front-most. call before Begin()
+ IMGUI_API void SetWindowPos(const ImVec2& pos, ImGuiCond cond = 0); // (not recommended) set current window position - call within Begin()/End(). prefer using SetNextWindowPos(), as this may incur tearing and side-effects.
+ IMGUI_API void SetWindowSize(const ImVec2& size, ImGuiCond cond = 0); // (not recommended) set current window size - call within Begin()/End(). set to ImVec2(0,0) to force an auto-fit. prefer using SetNextWindowSize(), as this may incur tearing and minor side-effects.
+ IMGUI_API void SetWindowCollapsed(bool collapsed, ImGuiCond cond = 0); // (not recommended) set current window collapsed state. prefer using SetNextWindowCollapsed().
+ IMGUI_API void SetWindowFocus(); // (not recommended) set current window to be focused / front-most. prefer using SetNextWindowFocus().
+ IMGUI_API void SetWindowPos(const char* name, const ImVec2& pos, ImGuiCond cond = 0); // set named window position.
+ IMGUI_API void SetWindowSize(const char* name, const ImVec2& size, ImGuiCond cond = 0); // set named window size. set axis to 0.0f to force an auto-fit on this axis.
+ IMGUI_API void SetWindowCollapsed(const char* name, bool collapsed, ImGuiCond cond = 0); // set named window collapsed state
+ IMGUI_API void SetWindowFocus(const char* name); // set named window to be focused / front-most. use NULL to remove focus.
+
+ IMGUI_API float GetScrollX(); // get scrolling amount [0..GetScrollMaxX()]
+ IMGUI_API float GetScrollY(); // get scrolling amount [0..GetScrollMaxY()]
+ IMGUI_API float GetScrollMaxX(); // get maximum scrolling amount ~~ ContentSize.X - WindowSize.X
+ IMGUI_API float GetScrollMaxY(); // get maximum scrolling amount ~~ ContentSize.Y - WindowSize.Y
+ IMGUI_API void SetScrollX(float scroll_x); // set scrolling amount [0..GetScrollMaxX()]
+ IMGUI_API void SetScrollY(float scroll_y); // set scrolling amount [0..GetScrollMaxY()]
+ IMGUI_API void SetScrollHere(float center_y_ratio = 0.5f); // adjust scrolling amount to make current cursor position visible. center_y_ratio=0.0: top, 0.5: center, 1.0: bottom.
+ IMGUI_API void SetScrollFromPosY(float pos_y, float center_y_ratio = 0.5f); // adjust scrolling amount to make given position valid. use GetCursorPos() or GetCursorStartPos()+offset to get valid positions.
+ IMGUI_API void SetKeyboardFocusHere(int offset = 0); // focus keyboard on the next widget. Use positive 'offset' to access sub components of a multiple component widget. Use negative 'offset' to access previous widgets.
+ IMGUI_API void SetStateStorage(ImGuiStorage* tree); // replace tree state storage with our own (if you want to manipulate it yourself, typically clear subsection of it)
+ IMGUI_API ImGuiStorage* GetStateStorage();
+
+ // Parameters stacks (shared)
+ IMGUI_API void PushFont(ImFont* font); // use NULL as a shortcut to push default font
+ IMGUI_API void PopFont();
+ IMGUI_API void PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol idx, ImU32 col);
+ IMGUI_API void PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol idx, const ImVec4& col);
+ IMGUI_API void PopStyleColor(int count = 1);
+ IMGUI_API void PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar idx, float val);
+ IMGUI_API void PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar idx, const ImVec2& val);
+ IMGUI_API void PopStyleVar(int count = 1);
+ IMGUI_API const ImVec4& GetStyleColorVec4(ImGuiCol idx); // retrieve style color as stored in ImGuiStyle structure. use to feed back into PushStyleColor(), otherwhise use GetColorU32() to get style color + style alpha.
+ IMGUI_API ImFont* GetFont(); // get current font
+ IMGUI_API float GetFontSize(); // get current font size (= height in pixels) of current font with current scale applied
+ IMGUI_API ImVec2 GetFontTexUvWhitePixel(); // get UV coordinate for a while pixel, useful to draw custom shapes via the ImDrawList API
+ IMGUI_API ImU32 GetColorU32(ImGuiCol idx, float alpha_mul = 1.0f); // retrieve given style color with style alpha applied and optional extra alpha multiplier
+ IMGUI_API ImU32 GetColorU32(const ImVec4& col); // retrieve given color with style alpha applied
+ IMGUI_API ImU32 GetColorU32(ImU32 col); // retrieve given color with style alpha applied
+
+ // Parameters stacks (current window)
+ IMGUI_API void PushItemWidth(float item_width); // width of items for the common item+label case, pixels. 0.0f = default to ~2/3 of windows width, >0.0f: width in pixels, <0.0f align xx pixels to the right of window (so -1.0f always align width to the right side)
+ IMGUI_API void PopItemWidth();
+ IMGUI_API float CalcItemWidth(); // width of item given pushed settings and current cursor position
+ IMGUI_API void PushTextWrapPos(float wrap_pos_x = 0.0f); // word-wrapping for Text*() commands. < 0.0f: no wrapping; 0.0f: wrap to end of window (or column); > 0.0f: wrap at 'wrap_pos_x' position in window local space
+ IMGUI_API void PopTextWrapPos();
+ IMGUI_API void PushAllowKeyboardFocus(bool v); // allow focusing using TAB/Shift-TAB, enabled by default but you can disable it for certain widgets
+ IMGUI_API void PopAllowKeyboardFocus();
+ IMGUI_API void PushButtonRepeat(bool repeat); // in 'repeat' mode, Button*() functions return repeated true in a typematic manner (uses io.KeyRepeatDelay/io.KeyRepeatRate for now). Note that you can call IsItemActive() after any Button() to tell if the button is held in the current frame.
+ IMGUI_API void PopButtonRepeat();
+
+ // Cursor / Layout
+ IMGUI_API void Separator(); // horizontal line
+ IMGUI_API void SameLine(float pos_x = 0.0f, float spacing_w = -1.0f); // call between widgets or groups to layout them horizontally
+ IMGUI_API void NewLine(); // undo a SameLine()
+ IMGUI_API void Spacing(); // add vertical spacing
+ IMGUI_API void Dummy(const ImVec2& size); // add a dummy item of given size
+ IMGUI_API void Indent(float indent_w = 0.0f); // move content position toward the right, by style.IndentSpacing or indent_w if >0
+ IMGUI_API void Unindent(float indent_w = 0.0f); // move content position back to the left, by style.IndentSpacing or indent_w if >0
+ IMGUI_API void BeginGroup(); // lock horizontal starting position + capture group bounding box into one "item" (so you can use IsItemHovered() or layout primitives such as SameLine() on whole group, etc.)
+ IMGUI_API void EndGroup();
+ IMGUI_API ImVec2 GetCursorPos(); // cursor position is relative to window position
+ IMGUI_API float GetCursorPosX(); // "
+ IMGUI_API float GetCursorPosY(); // "
+ IMGUI_API void SetCursorPos(const ImVec2& local_pos); // "
+ IMGUI_API void SetCursorPosX(float x); // "
+ IMGUI_API void SetCursorPosY(float y); // "
+ IMGUI_API ImVec2 GetCursorStartPos(); // initial cursor position
+ IMGUI_API ImVec2 GetCursorScreenPos(); // cursor position in absolute screen coordinates [0..io.DisplaySize] (useful to work with ImDrawList API)
+ IMGUI_API void SetCursorScreenPos(const ImVec2& pos); // cursor position in absolute screen coordinates [0..io.DisplaySize]
+ IMGUI_API void AlignFirstTextHeightToWidgets(); // call once if the first item on the line is a Text() item and you want to vertically lower it to match subsequent (bigger) widgets
+ IMGUI_API float GetTextLineHeight(); // height of font == GetWindowFontSize()
+ IMGUI_API float GetTextLineHeightWithSpacing(); // distance (in pixels) between 2 consecutive lines of text == GetWindowFontSize() + GetStyle().ItemSpacing.y
+ IMGUI_API float GetItemsLineHeightWithSpacing(); // distance (in pixels) between 2 consecutive lines of standard height widgets == GetWindowFontSize() + GetStyle().FramePadding.y*2 + GetStyle().ItemSpacing.y
+
+ // Columns
+ // You can also use SameLine(pos_x) for simplified columns. The columns API is still work-in-progress and rather lacking.
+ IMGUI_API void Columns(int count = 1, const char* id = NULL, bool border = true);
+ IMGUI_API void NextColumn(); // next column, defaults to current row or next row if the current row is finished
+ IMGUI_API int GetColumnIndex(); // get current column index
+ IMGUI_API float GetColumnWidth(int column_index = -1); // get column width (in pixels). pass -1 to use current column
+ IMGUI_API void SetColumnWidth(int column_index, float width); // set column width (in pixels). pass -1 to use current column
+ IMGUI_API float GetColumnOffset(int column_index = -1); // get position of column line (in pixels, from the left side of the contents region). pass -1 to use current column, otherwise 0..GetColumnsCount() inclusive. column 0 is typically 0.0f
+ IMGUI_API void SetColumnOffset(int column_index, float offset_x); // set position of column line (in pixels, from the left side of the contents region). pass -1 to use current column
+ IMGUI_API int GetColumnsCount();
+
+ // ID scopes
+ // If you are creating widgets in a loop you most likely want to push a unique identifier (e.g. object pointer, loop index) so ImGui can differentiate them.
+ // You can also use the "##foobar" syntax within widget label to distinguish them from each others. Read "A primer on the use of labels/IDs" in the FAQ for more details.
+ IMGUI_API void PushID(const char* str_id); // push identifier into the ID stack. IDs are hash of the entire stack!
+ IMGUI_API void PushID(const char* str_id_begin, const char* str_id_end);
+ IMGUI_API void PushID(const void* ptr_id);
+ IMGUI_API void PushID(int int_id);
+ IMGUI_API void PopID();
+ IMGUI_API ImGuiID GetID(const char* str_id); // calculate unique ID (hash of whole ID stack + given parameter). e.g. if you want to query into ImGuiStorage yourself
+ IMGUI_API ImGuiID GetID(const char* str_id_begin, const char* str_id_end);
+ IMGUI_API ImGuiID GetID(const void* ptr_id);
+
+ // Widgets: Text
+ IMGUI_API void TextUnformatted(const char* text, const char* text_end = NULL); // doesn't require null terminated string if 'text_end' is specified. no copy done, no limits, recommended for long chunks of text
+ IMGUI_API void Text(const char* fmt, ...) IM_FMTARGS(1); // simple formatted text
+ IMGUI_API void TextV(const char* fmt, va_list args) IM_FMTLIST(1);
+ IMGUI_API void TextColored(const ImVec4& col, const char* fmt, ...) IM_FMTARGS(2); // shortcut for PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Text, col); Text(fmt, ...); PopStyleColor();
+ IMGUI_API void TextColoredV(const ImVec4& col, const char* fmt, va_list args) IM_FMTLIST(2);
+ IMGUI_API void TextDisabled(const char* fmt, ...) IM_FMTARGS(1); // shortcut for PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Text, style.Colors[ImGuiCol_TextDisabled]); Text(fmt, ...); PopStyleColor();
+ IMGUI_API void TextDisabledV(const char* fmt, va_list args) IM_FMTLIST(1);
+ IMGUI_API void TextWrapped(const char* fmt, ...) IM_FMTARGS(1); // shortcut for PushTextWrapPos(0.0f); Text(fmt, ...); PopTextWrapPos();. Note that this won't work on an auto-resizing window if there's no other widgets to extend the window width, yoy may need to set a size using SetNextWindowSize().
+ IMGUI_API void TextWrappedV(const char* fmt, va_list args) IM_FMTLIST(1);
+ IMGUI_API void LabelText(const char* label, const char* fmt, ...) IM_FMTARGS(2); // display text+label aligned the same way as value+label widgets
+ IMGUI_API void LabelTextV(const char* label, const char* fmt, va_list args) IM_FMTLIST(2);
+ IMGUI_API void BulletText(const char* fmt, ...) IM_FMTARGS(1); // shortcut for Bullet()+Text()
+ IMGUI_API void BulletTextV(const char* fmt, va_list args) IM_FMTLIST(1);
+ IMGUI_API void Bullet(); // draw a small circle and keep the cursor on the same line. advance cursor x position by GetTreeNodeToLabelSpacing(), same distance that TreeNode() uses
+
+ // Widgets: Main
+ IMGUI_API bool Button(const char* label, const ImVec2& size = ImVec2(0,0)); // button
+ IMGUI_API bool SmallButton(const char* label); // button with FramePadding=(0,0) to easily embed within text
+ IMGUI_API bool InvisibleButton(const char* str_id, const ImVec2& size);
+ IMGUI_API void Image(ImTextureID user_texture_id, const ImVec2& size, const ImVec2& uv0 = ImVec2(0,0), const ImVec2& uv1 = ImVec2(1,1), const ImVec4& tint_col = ImVec4(1,1,1,1), const ImVec4& border_col = ImVec4(0,0,0,0));
+ IMGUI_API bool ImageButton(ImTextureID user_texture_id, const ImVec2& size, const ImVec2& uv0 = ImVec2(0,0), const ImVec2& uv1 = ImVec2(1,1), int frame_padding = -1, const ImVec4& bg_col = ImVec4(0,0,0,0), const ImVec4& tint_col = ImVec4(1,1,1,1)); // <0 frame_padding uses default frame padding settings. 0 for no padding
+ IMGUI_API bool Checkbox(const char* label, bool* v);
+ IMGUI_API bool CheckboxFlags(const char* label, unsigned int* flags, unsigned int flags_value);
+ IMGUI_API bool RadioButton(const char* label, bool active);
+ IMGUI_API bool RadioButton(const char* label, int* v, int v_button);
+ IMGUI_API bool Combo(const char* label, int* current_item, const char* const* items, int items_count, int height_in_items = -1);
+ IMGUI_API bool Combo(const char* label, int* current_item, const char* items_separated_by_zeros, int height_in_items = -1); // separate items with \0, end item-list with \0\0
+ IMGUI_API bool Combo(const char* label, int* current_item, bool (*items_getter)(void* data, int idx, const char** out_text), void* data, int items_count, int height_in_items = -1);
+ IMGUI_API void PlotLines(const char* label, const float* values, int values_count, int values_offset = 0, const char* overlay_text = NULL, float scale_min = FLT_MAX, float scale_max = FLT_MAX, ImVec2 graph_size = ImVec2(0,0), int stride = sizeof(float));
+ IMGUI_API void PlotLines(const char* label, float (*values_getter)(void* data, int idx), void* data, int values_count, int values_offset = 0, const char* overlay_text = NULL, float scale_min = FLT_MAX, float scale_max = FLT_MAX, ImVec2 graph_size = ImVec2(0,0));
+ IMGUI_API void PlotHistogram(const char* label, const float* values, int values_count, int values_offset = 0, const char* overlay_text = NULL, float scale_min = FLT_MAX, float scale_max = FLT_MAX, ImVec2 graph_size = ImVec2(0,0), int stride = sizeof(float));
+ IMGUI_API void PlotHistogram(const char* label, float (*values_getter)(void* data, int idx), void* data, int values_count, int values_offset = 0, const char* overlay_text = NULL, float scale_min = FLT_MAX, float scale_max = FLT_MAX, ImVec2 graph_size = ImVec2(0,0));
+ IMGUI_API void ProgressBar(float fraction, const ImVec2& size_arg = ImVec2(-1,0), const char* overlay = NULL);
+
+ // Widgets: Drags (tip: ctrl+click on a drag box to input with keyboard. manually input values aren't clamped, can go off-bounds)
+ // For all the Float2/Float3/Float4/Int2/Int3/Int4 versions of every functions, note that a 'float v[X]' function argument is the same as 'float* v', the array syntax is just a way to document the number of elements that are expected to be accessible. You can pass address of your first element out of a contiguous set, e.g. &myvector.x
+ IMGUI_API bool DragFloat(const char* label, float* v, float v_speed = 1.0f, float v_min = 0.0f, float v_max = 0.0f, const char* display_format = "%.3f", float power = 1.0f); // If v_min >= v_max we have no bound
+ IMGUI_API bool DragFloat2(const char* label, float v[2], float v_speed = 1.0f, float v_min = 0.0f, float v_max = 0.0f, const char* display_format = "%.3f", float power = 1.0f);
+ IMGUI_API bool DragFloat3(const char* label, float v[3], float v_speed = 1.0f, float v_min = 0.0f, float v_max = 0.0f, const char* display_format = "%.3f", float power = 1.0f);
+ IMGUI_API bool DragFloat4(const char* label, float v[4], float v_speed = 1.0f, float v_min = 0.0f, float v_max = 0.0f, const char* display_format = "%.3f", float power = 1.0f);
+ IMGUI_API bool DragFloatRange2(const char* label, float* v_current_min, float* v_current_max, float v_speed = 1.0f, float v_min = 0.0f, float v_max = 0.0f, const char* display_format = "%.3f", const char* display_format_max = NULL, float power = 1.0f);
+ IMGUI_API bool DragInt(const char* label, int* v, float v_speed = 1.0f, int v_min = 0, int v_max = 0, const char* display_format = "%.0f"); // If v_min >= v_max we have no bound
+ IMGUI_API bool DragInt2(const char* label, int v[2], float v_speed = 1.0f, int v_min = 0, int v_max = 0, const char* display_format = "%.0f");
+ IMGUI_API bool DragInt3(const char* label, int v[3], float v_speed = 1.0f, int v_min = 0, int v_max = 0, const char* display_format = "%.0f");
+ IMGUI_API bool DragInt4(const char* label, int v[4], float v_speed = 1.0f, int v_min = 0, int v_max = 0, const char* display_format = "%.0f");
+ IMGUI_API bool DragIntRange2(const char* label, int* v_current_min, int* v_current_max, float v_speed = 1.0f, int v_min = 0, int v_max = 0, const char* display_format = "%.0f", const char* display_format_max = NULL);
+
+ // Widgets: Input with Keyboard
+ IMGUI_API bool InputText(const char* label, char* buf, size_t buf_size, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags = 0, ImGuiTextEditCallback callback = NULL, void* user_data = NULL);
+ IMGUI_API bool InputTextMultiline(const char* label, char* buf, size_t buf_size, const ImVec2& size = ImVec2(0,0), ImGuiInputTextFlags flags = 0, ImGuiTextEditCallback callback = NULL, void* user_data = NULL);
+ IMGUI_API bool InputFloat(const char* label, float* v, float step = 0.0f, float step_fast = 0.0f, int decimal_precision = -1, ImGuiInputTextFlags extra_flags = 0);
+ IMGUI_API bool InputFloat2(const char* label, float v[2], int decimal_precision = -1, ImGuiInputTextFlags extra_flags = 0);
+ IMGUI_API bool InputFloat3(const char* label, float v[3], int decimal_precision = -1, ImGuiInputTextFlags extra_flags = 0);
+ IMGUI_API bool InputFloat4(const char* label, float v[4], int decimal_precision = -1, ImGuiInputTextFlags extra_flags = 0);
+ IMGUI_API bool InputInt(const char* label, int* v, int step = 1, int step_fast = 100, ImGuiInputTextFlags extra_flags = 0);
+ IMGUI_API bool InputInt2(const char* label, int v[2], ImGuiInputTextFlags extra_flags = 0);
+ IMGUI_API bool InputInt3(const char* label, int v[3], ImGuiInputTextFlags extra_flags = 0);
+ IMGUI_API bool InputInt4(const char* label, int v[4], ImGuiInputTextFlags extra_flags = 0);
+
+ // Widgets: Sliders (tip: ctrl+click on a slider to input with keyboard. manually input values aren't clamped, can go off-bounds)
+ IMGUI_API bool SliderFloat(const char* label, float* v, float v_min, float v_max, const char* display_format = "%.3f", float power = 1.0f); // adjust display_format to decorate the value with a prefix or a suffix for in-slider labels or unit display. Use power!=1.0 for logarithmic sliders
+ IMGUI_API bool SliderFloat2(const char* label, float v[2], float v_min, float v_max, const char* display_format = "%.3f", float power = 1.0f);
+ IMGUI_API bool SliderFloat3(const char* label, float v[3], float v_min, float v_max, const char* display_format = "%.3f", float power = 1.0f);
+ IMGUI_API bool SliderFloat4(const char* label, float v[4], float v_min, float v_max, const char* display_format = "%.3f", float power = 1.0f);
+ IMGUI_API bool SliderAngle(const char* label, float* v_rad, float v_degrees_min = -360.0f, float v_degrees_max = +360.0f);
+ IMGUI_API bool SliderInt(const char* label, int* v, int v_min, int v_max, const char* display_format = "%.0f");
+ IMGUI_API bool SliderInt2(const char* label, int v[2], int v_min, int v_max, const char* display_format = "%.0f");
+ IMGUI_API bool SliderInt3(const char* label, int v[3], int v_min, int v_max, const char* display_format = "%.0f");
+ IMGUI_API bool SliderInt4(const char* label, int v[4], int v_min, int v_max, const char* display_format = "%.0f");
+ IMGUI_API bool VSliderFloat(const char* label, const ImVec2& size, float* v, float v_min, float v_max, const char* display_format = "%.3f", float power = 1.0f);
+ IMGUI_API bool VSliderInt(const char* label, const ImVec2& size, int* v, int v_min, int v_max, const char* display_format = "%.0f");
+
+ // Widgets: Color Editor/Picker (tip: the ColorEdit* functions have a little colored preview square that can be left-clicked to open a picker, and right-clicked to open an option menu.)
+ // Note that a 'float v[X]' function argument is the same as 'float* v', the array syntax is just a way to document the number of elements that are expected to be accessible. You can the pass the address of a first float element out of a contiguous structure, e.g. &myvector.x
+ IMGUI_API bool ColorEdit3(const char* label, float col[3], ImGuiColorEditFlags flags = 0);
+ IMGUI_API bool ColorEdit4(const char* label, float col[4], ImGuiColorEditFlags flags = 0);
+ IMGUI_API bool ColorPicker3(const char* label, float col[3], ImGuiColorEditFlags flags = 0);
+ IMGUI_API bool ColorPicker4(const char* label, float col[4], ImGuiColorEditFlags flags = 0, const float* ref_col = NULL);
+ IMGUI_API bool ColorButton(const char* desc_id, const ImVec4& col, ImGuiColorEditFlags flags = 0, ImVec2 size = ImVec2(0,0)); // display a colored square/button, hover for details, return true when pressed.
+ IMGUI_API void SetColorEditOptions(ImGuiColorEditFlags flags); // initialize current options (generally on application startup) if you want to select a default format, picker type, etc. User will be able to change many settings, unless you pass the _NoOptions flag to your calls.
+
+ // Widgets: Trees
+ IMGUI_API bool TreeNode(const char* label); // if returning 'true' the node is open and the tree id is pushed into the id stack. user is responsible for calling TreePop().
+ IMGUI_API bool TreeNode(const char* str_id, const char* fmt, ...) IM_FMTARGS(2); // read the FAQ about why and how to use ID. to align arbitrary text at the same level as a TreeNode() you can use Bullet().
+ IMGUI_API bool TreeNode(const void* ptr_id, const char* fmt, ...) IM_FMTARGS(2); // "
+ IMGUI_API bool TreeNodeV(const char* str_id, const char* fmt, va_list args) IM_FMTLIST(2);
+ IMGUI_API bool TreeNodeV(const void* ptr_id, const char* fmt, va_list args) IM_FMTLIST(2);
+ IMGUI_API bool TreeNodeEx(const char* label, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags = 0);
+ IMGUI_API bool TreeNodeEx(const char* str_id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* fmt, ...) IM_FMTARGS(3);
+ IMGUI_API bool TreeNodeEx(const void* ptr_id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* fmt, ...) IM_FMTARGS(3);
+ IMGUI_API bool TreeNodeExV(const char* str_id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* fmt, va_list args) IM_FMTLIST(3);
+ IMGUI_API bool TreeNodeExV(const void* ptr_id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* fmt, va_list args) IM_FMTLIST(3);
+ IMGUI_API void TreePush(const char* str_id = NULL); // ~ Indent()+PushId(). Already called by TreeNode() when returning true, but you can call Push/Pop yourself for layout purpose
+ IMGUI_API void TreePush(const void* ptr_id = NULL); // "
+ IMGUI_API void TreePop(); // ~ Unindent()+PopId()
+ IMGUI_API void TreeAdvanceToLabelPos(); // advance cursor x position by GetTreeNodeToLabelSpacing()
+ IMGUI_API float GetTreeNodeToLabelSpacing(); // horizontal distance preceding label when using TreeNode*() or Bullet() == (g.FontSize + style.FramePadding.x*2) for a regular unframed TreeNode
+ IMGUI_API void SetNextTreeNodeOpen(bool is_open, ImGuiCond cond = 0); // set next TreeNode/CollapsingHeader open state.
+ IMGUI_API bool CollapsingHeader(const char* label, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags = 0); // if returning 'true' the header is open. doesn't indent nor push on ID stack. user doesn't have to call TreePop().
+ IMGUI_API bool CollapsingHeader(const char* label, bool* p_open, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags = 0); // when 'p_open' isn't NULL, display an additional small close button on upper right of the header
+
+ // Widgets: Selectable / Lists
+ IMGUI_API bool Selectable(const char* label, bool selected = false, ImGuiSelectableFlags flags = 0, const ImVec2& size = ImVec2(0,0)); // size.x==0.0: use remaining width, size.x>0.0: specify width. size.y==0.0: use label height, size.y>0.0: specify height
+ IMGUI_API bool Selectable(const char* label, bool* p_selected, ImGuiSelectableFlags flags = 0, const ImVec2& size = ImVec2(0,0));
+ IMGUI_API bool ListBox(const char* label, int* current_item, const char* const* items, int items_count, int height_in_items = -1);
+ IMGUI_API bool ListBox(const char* label, int* current_item, bool (*items_getter)(void* data, int idx, const char** out_text), void* data, int items_count, int height_in_items = -1);
+ IMGUI_API bool ListBoxHeader(const char* label, const ImVec2& size = ImVec2(0,0)); // use if you want to reimplement ListBox() will custom data or interactions. make sure to call ListBoxFooter() afterwards.
+ IMGUI_API bool ListBoxHeader(const char* label, int items_count, int height_in_items = -1); // "
+ IMGUI_API void ListBoxFooter(); // terminate the scrolling region
+
+ // Widgets: Value() Helpers. Output single value in "name: value" format (tip: freely declare more in your code to handle your types. you can add functions to the ImGui namespace)
+ IMGUI_API void Value(const char* prefix, bool b);
+ IMGUI_API void Value(const char* prefix, int v);
+ IMGUI_API void Value(const char* prefix, unsigned int v);
+ IMGUI_API void Value(const char* prefix, float v, const char* float_format = NULL);
+
+ // Tooltips
+ IMGUI_API void SetTooltip(const char* fmt, ...) IM_FMTARGS(1); // set text tooltip under mouse-cursor, typically use with ImGui::IsItemHovered(). overidde any previous call to SetTooltip().
+ IMGUI_API void SetTooltipV(const char* fmt, va_list args) IM_FMTLIST(1);
+ IMGUI_API void BeginTooltip(); // begin/append a tooltip window. to create full-featured tooltip (with any kind of contents).
+ IMGUI_API void EndTooltip();
+
+ // Menus
+ IMGUI_API bool BeginMainMenuBar(); // create and append to a full screen menu-bar. only call EndMainMenuBar() if this returns true!
+ IMGUI_API void EndMainMenuBar();
+ IMGUI_API bool BeginMenuBar(); // append to menu-bar of current window (requires ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar flag set). only call EndMenuBar() if this returns true!
+ IMGUI_API void EndMenuBar();
+ IMGUI_API bool BeginMenu(const char* label, bool enabled = true); // create a sub-menu entry. only call EndMenu() if this returns true!
+ IMGUI_API void EndMenu();
+ IMGUI_API bool MenuItem(const char* label, const char* shortcut = NULL, bool selected = false, bool enabled = true); // return true when activated. shortcuts are displayed for convenience but not processed by ImGui at the moment
+ IMGUI_API bool MenuItem(const char* label, const char* shortcut, bool* p_selected, bool enabled = true); // return true when activated + toggle (*p_selected) if p_selected != NULL
+
+ // Popups
+ IMGUI_API void OpenPopup(const char* str_id); // call to mark popup as open (don't call every frame!). popups are closed when user click outside, or if CloseCurrentPopup() is called within a BeginPopup()/EndPopup() block. By default, Selectable()/MenuItem() are calling CloseCurrentPopup(). Popup identifiers are relative to the current ID-stack (so OpenPopup and BeginPopup needs to be at the same level).
+ IMGUI_API bool BeginPopup(const char* str_id); // return true if the popup is open, and you can start outputting to it. only call EndPopup() if BeginPopup() returned true!
+ IMGUI_API bool BeginPopupModal(const char* name, bool* p_open = NULL, ImGuiWindowFlags extra_flags = 0); // modal dialog (block interactions behind the modal window, can't close the modal window by clicking outside)
+ IMGUI_API bool BeginPopupContextItem(const char* str_id, int mouse_button = 1); // helper to open and begin popup when clicked on last item. read comments in .cpp!
+ IMGUI_API bool BeginPopupContextWindow(const char* str_id = NULL, int mouse_button = 1, bool also_over_items = true); // helper to open and begin popup when clicked on current window.
+ IMGUI_API bool BeginPopupContextVoid(const char* str_id = NULL, int mouse_button = 1); // helper to open and begin popup when clicked in void (no window).
+ IMGUI_API void EndPopup();
+ IMGUI_API bool IsPopupOpen(const char* str_id); // return true if the popup is open
+ IMGUI_API void CloseCurrentPopup(); // close the popup we have begin-ed into. clicking on a MenuItem or Selectable automatically close the current popup.
+
+ // Logging: all text output from interface is redirected to tty/file/clipboard. By default, tree nodes are automatically opened during logging.
+ IMGUI_API void LogToTTY(int max_depth = -1); // start logging to tty
+ IMGUI_API void LogToFile(int max_depth = -1, const char* filename = NULL); // start logging to file
+ IMGUI_API void LogToClipboard(int max_depth = -1); // start logging to OS clipboard
+ IMGUI_API void LogFinish(); // stop logging (close file, etc.)
+ IMGUI_API void LogButtons(); // helper to display buttons for logging to tty/file/clipboard
+ IMGUI_API void LogText(const char* fmt, ...) IM_FMTARGS(1); // pass text data straight to log (without being displayed)
+
+ // Clipping
+ IMGUI_API void PushClipRect(const ImVec2& clip_rect_min, const ImVec2& clip_rect_max, bool intersect_with_current_clip_rect);
+ IMGUI_API void PopClipRect();
+
+ // Utilities
+ IMGUI_API bool IsItemHovered(); // was the last item hovered by mouse?
+ IMGUI_API bool IsItemRectHovered(); // was the last item hovered by mouse? even if another item is active or window is blocked by popup while we are hovering this
+ IMGUI_API bool IsItemActive(); // was the last item active? (e.g. button being held, text field being edited- items that don't interact will always return false)
+ IMGUI_API bool IsItemClicked(int mouse_button = 0); // was the last item clicked? (e.g. button/node just clicked on)
+ IMGUI_API bool IsItemVisible(); // was the last item visible? (aka not out of sight due to clipping/scrolling.)
+ IMGUI_API bool IsAnyItemHovered();
+ IMGUI_API bool IsAnyItemActive();
+ IMGUI_API ImVec2 GetItemRectMin(); // get bounding rect of last item in screen space
+ IMGUI_API ImVec2 GetItemRectMax(); // "
+ IMGUI_API ImVec2 GetItemRectSize(); // "
+ IMGUI_API void SetItemAllowOverlap(); // allow last item to be overlapped by a subsequent item. sometimes useful with invisible buttons, selectables, etc. to catch unused area.
+ IMGUI_API bool IsWindowFocused(); // is current window focused
+ IMGUI_API bool IsWindowHovered(); // is current window hovered and hoverable (not blocked by a popup) (differentiate child windows from each others)
+ IMGUI_API bool IsWindowRectHovered(); // is current window rectnagle hovered, disregarding of any consideration of being blocked by a popup. (unlike IsWindowHovered() this will return true even if the window is blocked because of a popup)
+ IMGUI_API bool IsRootWindowFocused(); // is current root window focused (root = top-most parent of a child, otherwise self)
+ IMGUI_API bool IsRootWindowOrAnyChildFocused(); // is current root window or any of its child (including current window) focused
+ IMGUI_API bool IsRootWindowOrAnyChildHovered(); // is current root window or any of its child (including current window) hovered and hoverable (not blocked by a popup)
+ IMGUI_API bool IsAnyWindowHovered(); // is mouse hovering any visible window
+ IMGUI_API bool IsRectVisible(const ImVec2& size); // test if rectangle (of given size, starting from cursor position) is visible / not clipped.
+ IMGUI_API bool IsRectVisible(const ImVec2& rect_min, const ImVec2& rect_max); // test if rectangle (in screen space) is visible / not clipped. to perform coarse clipping on user's side.
+ IMGUI_API float GetTime();
+ IMGUI_API int GetFrameCount();
+ IMGUI_API const char* GetStyleColorName(ImGuiCol idx);
+ IMGUI_API ImVec2 CalcItemRectClosestPoint(const ImVec2& pos, bool on_edge = false, float outward = +0.0f); // utility to find the closest point the last item bounding rectangle edge. useful to visually link items
+ IMGUI_API ImVec2 CalcTextSize(const char* text, const char* text_end = NULL, bool hide_text_after_double_hash = false, float wrap_width = -1.0f);
+ IMGUI_API void CalcListClipping(int items_count, float items_height, int* out_items_display_start, int* out_items_display_end); // calculate coarse clipping for large list of evenly sized items. Prefer using the ImGuiListClipper higher-level helper if you can.
+
+ IMGUI_API bool BeginChildFrame(ImGuiID id, const ImVec2& size, ImGuiWindowFlags extra_flags = 0); // helper to create a child window / scrolling region that looks like a normal widget frame
+ IMGUI_API void EndChildFrame();
+
+ IMGUI_API ImVec4 ColorConvertU32ToFloat4(ImU32 in);
+ IMGUI_API ImU32 ColorConvertFloat4ToU32(const ImVec4& in);
+ IMGUI_API void ColorConvertRGBtoHSV(float r, float g, float b, float& out_h, float& out_s, float& out_v);
+ IMGUI_API void ColorConvertHSVtoRGB(float h, float s, float v, float& out_r, float& out_g, float& out_b);
+
+ // Inputs
+ IMGUI_API int GetKeyIndex(ImGuiKey imgui_key); // map ImGuiKey_* values into user's key index. == io.KeyMap[key]
+ IMGUI_API bool IsKeyDown(int user_key_index); // is key being held. == io.KeysDown[user_key_index]. note that imgui doesn't know the semantic of each entry of io.KeyDown[]. Use your own indices/enums according to how your backend/engine stored them into KeyDown[]!
+ IMGUI_API bool IsKeyPressed(int user_key_index, bool repeat = true); // was key pressed (went from !Down to Down). if repeat=true, uses io.KeyRepeatDelay / KeyRepeatRate
+ IMGUI_API bool IsKeyReleased(int user_key_index); // was key released (went from Down to !Down)..
+ IMGUI_API bool IsMouseDown(int button); // is mouse button held
+ IMGUI_API bool IsMouseClicked(int button, bool repeat = false); // did mouse button clicked (went from !Down to Down)
+ IMGUI_API bool IsMouseDoubleClicked(int button); // did mouse button double-clicked. a double-click returns false in IsMouseClicked(). uses io.MouseDoubleClickTime.
+ IMGUI_API bool IsMouseReleased(int button); // did mouse button released (went from Down to !Down)
+ IMGUI_API bool IsMouseDragging(int button = 0, float lock_threshold = -1.0f); // is mouse dragging. if lock_threshold < -1.0f uses io.MouseDraggingThreshold
+ IMGUI_API bool IsMouseHoveringRect(const ImVec2& r_min, const ImVec2& r_max, bool clip = true); // is mouse hovering given bounding rect (in screen space). clipped by current clipping settings. disregarding of consideration of focus/window ordering/blocked by a popup.
+ IMGUI_API bool IsMousePosValid(const ImVec2* mouse_pos = NULL); //
+ IMGUI_API ImVec2 GetMousePos(); // shortcut to ImGui::GetIO().MousePos provided by user, to be consistent with other calls
+ IMGUI_API ImVec2 GetMousePosOnOpeningCurrentPopup(); // retrieve backup of mouse positioning at the time of opening popup we have BeginPopup() into
+ IMGUI_API ImVec2 GetMouseDragDelta(int button = 0, float lock_threshold = -1.0f); // dragging amount since clicking. if lock_threshold < -1.0f uses io.MouseDraggingThreshold
+ IMGUI_API void ResetMouseDragDelta(int button = 0); //
+ IMGUI_API ImGuiMouseCursor GetMouseCursor(); // get desired cursor type, reset in ImGui::NewFrame(), this is updated during the frame. valid before Render(). If you use software rendering by setting io.MouseDrawCursor ImGui will render those for you
+ IMGUI_API void SetMouseCursor(ImGuiMouseCursor type); // set desired cursor type
+ IMGUI_API void CaptureKeyboardFromApp(bool capture = true); // manually override io.WantCaptureKeyboard flag next frame (said flag is entirely left for your application handle). e.g. force capture keyboard when your widget is being hovered.
+ IMGUI_API void CaptureMouseFromApp(bool capture = true); // manually override io.WantCaptureMouse flag next frame (said flag is entirely left for your application handle).
+
+ // Helpers functions to access functions pointers in ImGui::GetIO()
+ IMGUI_API void* MemAlloc(size_t sz);
+ IMGUI_API void MemFree(void* ptr);
+ IMGUI_API const char* GetClipboardText();
+ IMGUI_API void SetClipboardText(const char* text);
+
+ // Internal context access - if you want to use multiple context, share context between modules (e.g. DLL). There is a default context created and active by default.
+ // All contexts share a same ImFontAtlas by default. If you want different font atlas, you can new() them and overwrite the GetIO().Fonts variable of an ImGui context.
+ IMGUI_API const char* GetVersion();
+ IMGUI_API ImGuiContext* CreateContext(void* (*malloc_fn)(size_t) = NULL, void (*free_fn)(void*) = NULL);
+ IMGUI_API void DestroyContext(ImGuiContext* ctx);
+ IMGUI_API ImGuiContext* GetCurrentContext();
+ IMGUI_API void SetCurrentContext(ImGuiContext* ctx);
+
+ // Obsolete functions (Will be removed! Also see 'API BREAKING CHANGES' section in imgui.cpp)
+#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS
+ static inline bool IsItemHoveredRect() { return IsItemRectHovered(); } // OBSOLETE 1.51+
+ static inline bool IsPosHoveringAnyWindow(const ImVec2&) { IM_ASSERT(0); return false; } // OBSOLETE 1.51+. This was partly broken. You probably wanted to use ImGui::GetIO().WantCaptureMouse instead.
+ static inline bool IsMouseHoveringAnyWindow() { return IsAnyWindowHovered(); } // OBSOLETE 1.51+
+ static inline bool IsMouseHoveringWindow() { return IsWindowRectHovered(); } // OBSOLETE 1.51+
+ static inline bool CollapsingHeader(const char* label, const char* str_id, bool framed = true, bool default_open = false) { (void)str_id; (void)framed; ImGuiTreeNodeFlags default_open_flags = 1<<5; return CollapsingHeader(label, (default_open ? default_open_flags : 0)); } // OBSOLETE 1.49+
+ static inline ImFont* GetWindowFont() { return GetFont(); } // OBSOLETE 1.48+
+ static inline float GetWindowFontSize() { return GetFontSize(); } // OBSOLETE 1.48+
+ static inline void SetScrollPosHere() { SetScrollHere(); } // OBSOLETE 1.42+
+ static inline bool GetWindowCollapsed() { return ImGui::IsWindowCollapsed(); } // OBSOLETE 1.39+
+ static inline bool IsRectClipped(const ImVec2& size) { return !IsRectVisible(size); } // OBSOLETE 1.39+
+#endif
+
+} // namespace ImGui
+
+// Flags for ImGui::Begin()
+enum ImGuiWindowFlags_
+{
+ // Default: 0
+ ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar = 1 << 0, // Disable title-bar
+ ImGuiWindowFlags_NoResize = 1 << 1, // Disable user resizing with the lower-right grip
+ ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove = 1 << 2, // Disable user moving the window
+ ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollbar = 1 << 3, // Disable scrollbars (window can still scroll with mouse or programatically)
+ ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollWithMouse = 1 << 4, // Disable user vertically scrolling with mouse wheel
+ ImGuiWindowFlags_NoCollapse = 1 << 5, // Disable user collapsing window by double-clicking on it
+ ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize = 1 << 6, // Resize every window to its content every frame
+ ImGuiWindowFlags_ShowBorders = 1 << 7, // Show borders around windows and items
+ ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings = 1 << 8, // Never load/save settings in .ini file
+ ImGuiWindowFlags_NoInputs = 1 << 9, // Disable catching mouse or keyboard inputs
+ ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar = 1 << 10, // Has a menu-bar
+ ImGuiWindowFlags_HorizontalScrollbar = 1 << 11, // Allow horizontal scrollbar to appear (off by default). You may use SetNextWindowContentSize(ImVec2(width,0.0f)); prior to calling Begin() to specify width. Read code in imgui_demo in the "Horizontal Scrolling" section.
+ ImGuiWindowFlags_NoFocusOnAppearing = 1 << 12, // Disable taking focus when transitioning from hidden to visible state
+ ImGuiWindowFlags_NoBringToFrontOnFocus = 1 << 13, // Disable bringing window to front when taking focus (e.g. clicking on it or programatically giving it focus)
+ ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysVerticalScrollbar= 1 << 14, // Always show vertical scrollbar (even if ContentSize.y < Size.y)
+ ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysHorizontalScrollbar=1<< 15, // Always show horizontal scrollbar (even if ContentSize.x < Size.x)
+ ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysUseWindowPadding = 1 << 16, // Ensure child windows without border uses style.WindowPadding (ignored by default for non-bordered child windows, because more convenient)
+ // [Internal]
+ ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow = 1 << 22, // Don't use! For internal use by BeginChild()
+ ImGuiWindowFlags_ComboBox = 1 << 23, // Don't use! For internal use by ComboBox()
+ ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip = 1 << 24, // Don't use! For internal use by BeginTooltip()
+ ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup = 1 << 25, // Don't use! For internal use by BeginPopup()
+ ImGuiWindowFlags_Modal = 1 << 26, // Don't use! For internal use by BeginPopupModal()
+ ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu = 1 << 27 // Don't use! For internal use by BeginMenu()
+};
+
+// Flags for ImGui::InputText()
+enum ImGuiInputTextFlags_
+{
+ // Default: 0
+ ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsDecimal = 1 << 0, // Allow 0123456789.+-*/
+ ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsHexadecimal = 1 << 1, // Allow 0123456789ABCDEFabcdef
+ ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsUppercase = 1 << 2, // Turn a..z into A..Z
+ ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsNoBlank = 1 << 3, // Filter out spaces, tabs
+ ImGuiInputTextFlags_AutoSelectAll = 1 << 4, // Select entire text when first taking mouse focus
+ ImGuiInputTextFlags_EnterReturnsTrue = 1 << 5, // Return 'true' when Enter is pressed (as opposed to when the value was modified)
+ ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCompletion = 1 << 6, // Call user function on pressing TAB (for completion handling)
+ ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackHistory = 1 << 7, // Call user function on pressing Up/Down arrows (for history handling)
+ ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackAlways = 1 << 8, // Call user function every time. User code may query cursor position, modify text buffer.
+ ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCharFilter = 1 << 9, // Call user function to filter character. Modify data->EventChar to replace/filter input, or return 1 to discard character.
+ ImGuiInputTextFlags_AllowTabInput = 1 << 10, // Pressing TAB input a '\t' character into the text field
+ ImGuiInputTextFlags_CtrlEnterForNewLine = 1 << 11, // In multi-line mode, unfocus with Enter, add new line with Ctrl+Enter (default is opposite: unfocus with Ctrl+Enter, add line with Enter).
+ ImGuiInputTextFlags_NoHorizontalScroll = 1 << 12, // Disable following the cursor horizontally
+ ImGuiInputTextFlags_AlwaysInsertMode = 1 << 13, // Insert mode
+ ImGuiInputTextFlags_ReadOnly = 1 << 14, // Read-only mode
+ ImGuiInputTextFlags_Password = 1 << 15, // Password mode, display all characters as '*'
+ // [Internal]
+ ImGuiInputTextFlags_Multiline = 1 << 20 // For internal use by InputTextMultiline()
+};
+
+// Flags for ImGui::TreeNodeEx(), ImGui::CollapsingHeader*()
+enum ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_
+{
+ ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Selected = 1 << 0, // Draw as selected
+ ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Framed = 1 << 1, // Full colored frame (e.g. for CollapsingHeader)
+ ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_AllowOverlapMode = 1 << 2, // Hit testing to allow subsequent widgets to overlap this one
+ ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoTreePushOnOpen = 1 << 3, // Don't do a TreePush() when open (e.g. for CollapsingHeader) = no extra indent nor pushing on ID stack
+ ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoAutoOpenOnLog = 1 << 4, // Don't automatically and temporarily open node when Logging is active (by default logging will automatically open tree nodes)
+ ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_DefaultOpen = 1 << 5, // Default node to be open
+ ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnDoubleClick = 1 << 6, // Need double-click to open node
+ ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnArrow = 1 << 7, // Only open when clicking on the arrow part. If ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnDoubleClick is also set, single-click arrow or double-click all box to open.
+ ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Leaf = 1 << 8, // No collapsing, no arrow (use as a convenience for leaf nodes).
+ ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Bullet = 1 << 9, // Display a bullet instead of arrow
+ //ImGuITreeNodeFlags_SpanAllAvailWidth = 1 << 10, // FIXME: TODO: Extend hit box horizontally even if not framed
+ //ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoScrollOnOpen = 1 << 11, // FIXME: TODO: Disable automatic scroll on TreePop() if node got just open and contents is not visible
+ ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_CollapsingHeader = ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Framed | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoAutoOpenOnLog
+};
+
+// Flags for ImGui::Selectable()
+enum ImGuiSelectableFlags_
+{
+ // Default: 0
+ ImGuiSelectableFlags_DontClosePopups = 1 << 0, // Clicking this don't close parent popup window
+ ImGuiSelectableFlags_SpanAllColumns = 1 << 1, // Selectable frame can span all columns (text will still fit in current column)
+ ImGuiSelectableFlags_AllowDoubleClick = 1 << 2 // Generate press events on double clicks too
+};
+
+// User fill ImGuiIO.KeyMap[] array with indices into the ImGuiIO.KeysDown[512] array
+enum ImGuiKey_
+{
+ ImGuiKey_Tab, // for tabbing through fields
+ ImGuiKey_LeftArrow, // for text edit
+ ImGuiKey_RightArrow,// for text edit
+ ImGuiKey_UpArrow, // for text edit
+ ImGuiKey_DownArrow, // for text edit
+ ImGuiKey_PageUp,
+ ImGuiKey_PageDown,
+ ImGuiKey_Home, // for text edit
+ ImGuiKey_End, // for text edit
+ ImGuiKey_Delete, // for text edit
+ ImGuiKey_Backspace, // for text edit
+ ImGuiKey_Enter, // for text edit
+ ImGuiKey_Escape, // for text edit
+ ImGuiKey_A, // for text edit CTRL+A: select all
+ ImGuiKey_C, // for text edit CTRL+C: copy
+ ImGuiKey_V, // for text edit CTRL+V: paste
+ ImGuiKey_X, // for text edit CTRL+X: cut
+ ImGuiKey_Y, // for text edit CTRL+Y: redo
+ ImGuiKey_Z, // for text edit CTRL+Z: undo
+ ImGuiKey_COUNT
+};
+
+// Enumeration for PushStyleColor() / PopStyleColor()
+enum ImGuiCol_
+{
+ ImGuiCol_Text,
+ ImGuiCol_TextDisabled,
+ ImGuiCol_WindowBg, // Background of normal windows
+ ImGuiCol_ChildWindowBg, // Background of child windows
+ ImGuiCol_PopupBg, // Background of popups, menus, tooltips windows
+ ImGuiCol_Border,
+ ImGuiCol_BorderShadow,
+ ImGuiCol_FrameBg, // Background of checkbox, radio button, plot, slider, text input
+ ImGuiCol_FrameBgHovered,
+ ImGuiCol_FrameBgActive,
+ ImGuiCol_TitleBg,
+ ImGuiCol_TitleBgCollapsed,
+ ImGuiCol_TitleBgActive,
+ ImGuiCol_MenuBarBg,
+ ImGuiCol_ScrollbarBg,
+ ImGuiCol_ScrollbarGrab,
+ ImGuiCol_ScrollbarGrabHovered,
+ ImGuiCol_ScrollbarGrabActive,
+ ImGuiCol_ComboBg,
+ ImGuiCol_CheckMark,
+ ImGuiCol_SliderGrab,
+ ImGuiCol_SliderGrabActive,
+ ImGuiCol_Button,
+ ImGuiCol_ButtonHovered,
+ ImGuiCol_ButtonActive,
+ ImGuiCol_Header,
+ ImGuiCol_HeaderHovered,
+ ImGuiCol_HeaderActive,
+ ImGuiCol_Separator,
+ ImGuiCol_SeparatorHovered,
+ ImGuiCol_SeparatorActive,
+ ImGuiCol_ResizeGrip,
+ ImGuiCol_ResizeGripHovered,
+ ImGuiCol_ResizeGripActive,
+ ImGuiCol_CloseButton,
+ ImGuiCol_CloseButtonHovered,
+ ImGuiCol_CloseButtonActive,
+ ImGuiCol_PlotLines,
+ ImGuiCol_PlotLinesHovered,
+ ImGuiCol_PlotHistogram,
+ ImGuiCol_PlotHistogramHovered,
+ ImGuiCol_TextSelectedBg,
+ ImGuiCol_ModalWindowDarkening, // darken entire screen when a modal window is active
+ ImGuiCol_COUNT
+
+ // Obsolete names (will be removed)
+#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS
+ , ImGuiCol_Column = ImGuiCol_Separator, ImGuiCol_ColumnHovered = ImGuiCol_SeparatorHovered, ImGuiCol_ColumnActive = ImGuiCol_SeparatorActive
+#endif
+};
+
+// Enumeration for PushStyleVar() / PopStyleVar() to temporarily modify the ImGuiStyle structure.
+// NB: the enum only refers to fields of ImGuiStyle which makes sense to be pushed/poped inside UI code. During initialization, feel free to just poke into ImGuiStyle directly.
+// NB: if changing this enum, you need to update the associated internal table GStyleVarInfo[] accordingly. This is where we link enum values to members offset/type.
+enum ImGuiStyleVar_
+{
+ // Enum name ......................// Member in ImGuiStyle structure (see ImGuiStyle for descriptions)
+ ImGuiStyleVar_Alpha, // float Alpha
+ ImGuiStyleVar_WindowPadding, // ImVec2 WindowPadding
+ ImGuiStyleVar_WindowRounding, // float WindowRounding
+ ImGuiStyleVar_WindowMinSize, // ImVec2 WindowMinSize
+ ImGuiStyleVar_ChildWindowRounding, // float ChildWindowRounding
+ ImGuiStyleVar_FramePadding, // ImVec2 FramePadding
+ ImGuiStyleVar_FrameRounding, // float FrameRounding
+ ImGuiStyleVar_ItemSpacing, // ImVec2 ItemSpacing
+ ImGuiStyleVar_ItemInnerSpacing, // ImVec2 ItemInnerSpacing
+ ImGuiStyleVar_IndentSpacing, // float IndentSpacing
+ ImGuiStyleVar_GrabMinSize, // float GrabMinSize
+ ImGuiStyleVar_ButtonTextAlign, // ImVec2 ButtonTextAlign
+ ImGuiStyleVar_Count_
+};
+
+// Enumeration for ColorEdit3() / ColorEdit4() / ColorPicker3() / ColorPicker4() / ColorButton()
+enum ImGuiColorEditFlags_
+{
+ ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha = 1 << 1, // // ColorEdit, ColorPicker, ColorButton: ignore Alpha component (read 3 components from the input pointer).
+ ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoPicker = 1 << 2, // // ColorEdit: disable picker when clicking on colored square.
+ ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoOptions = 1 << 3, // // ColorEdit: disable toggling options menu when right-clicking on inputs/small preview.
+ ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoSmallPreview = 1 << 4, // // ColorEdit, ColorPicker: disable colored square preview next to the inputs. (e.g. to show only the inputs)
+ ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoInputs = 1 << 5, // // ColorEdit, ColorPicker: disable inputs sliders/text widgets (e.g. to show only the small preview colored square).
+ ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoTooltip = 1 << 6, // // ColorEdit, ColorPicker, ColorButton: disable tooltip when hovering the preview.
+ ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoLabel = 1 << 7, // // ColorEdit, ColorPicker: disable display of inline text label (the label is still forwarded to the tooltip and picker).
+ ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoSidePreview = 1 << 8, // // ColorPicker: disable bigger color preview on right side of the picker, use small colored square preview instead.
+ // User Options (right-click on widget to change some of them). You can set application defaults using SetColorEditOptions(). The idea is that you probably don't want to override them in most of your calls, let the user choose and/or call SetColorEditOptions() during startup.
+ ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaBar = 1 << 9, // // ColorEdit, ColorPicker: show vertical alpha bar/gradient in picker.
+ ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreview = 1 << 10, // // ColorEdit, ColorPicker, ColorButton: display preview as a transparent color over a checkerboard, instead of opaque.
+ ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreviewHalf= 1 << 11, // // ColorEdit, ColorPicker, ColorButton: display half opaque / half checkerboard, instead of opaque.
+ ImGuiColorEditFlags_HDR = 1 << 12, // // (WIP) ColorEdit: Currently only disable 0.0f..1.0f limits in RGBA edition (note: you probably want to use ImGuiColorEditFlags_Float flag as well).
+ ImGuiColorEditFlags_RGB = 1 << 13, // [Inputs] // ColorEdit: choose one among RGB/HSV/HEX. ColorPicker: choose any combination using RGB/HSV/HEX.
+ ImGuiColorEditFlags_HSV = 1 << 14, // [Inputs] // "
+ ImGuiColorEditFlags_HEX = 1 << 15, // [Inputs] // "
+ ImGuiColorEditFlags_Uint8 = 1 << 16, // [DataType] // ColorEdit, ColorPicker, ColorButton: _display_ values formatted as 0..255.
+ ImGuiColorEditFlags_Float = 1 << 17, // [DataType] // ColorEdit, ColorPicker, ColorButton: _display_ values formatted as 0.0f..1.0f floats instead of 0..255 integers. No round-trip of value via integers.
+ ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerHueBar = 1 << 18, // [PickerMode] // ColorPicker: bar for Hue, rectangle for Sat/Value.
+ ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerHueWheel = 1 << 19, // [PickerMode] // ColorPicker: wheel for Hue, triangle for Sat/Value.
+ // Internals/Masks
+ ImGuiColorEditFlags__InputsMask = ImGuiColorEditFlags_RGB|ImGuiColorEditFlags_HSV|ImGuiColorEditFlags_HEX,
+ ImGuiColorEditFlags__DataTypeMask = ImGuiColorEditFlags_Uint8|ImGuiColorEditFlags_Float,
+ ImGuiColorEditFlags__PickerMask = ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerHueWheel|ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerHueBar,
+ ImGuiColorEditFlags__OptionsDefault = ImGuiColorEditFlags_Uint8|ImGuiColorEditFlags_RGB|ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerHueBar // Change application default using SetColorEditOptions()
+};
+
+// Enumeration for GetMouseCursor()
+enum ImGuiMouseCursor_
+{
+ ImGuiMouseCursor_None = -1,
+ ImGuiMouseCursor_Arrow = 0,
+ ImGuiMouseCursor_TextInput, // When hovering over InputText, etc.
+ ImGuiMouseCursor_Move, // Unused
+ ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeNS, // Unused
+ ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeEW, // When hovering over a column
+ ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeNESW, // Unused
+ ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeNWSE, // When hovering over the bottom-right corner of a window
+ ImGuiMouseCursor_Count_
+};
+
+// Condition flags for ImGui::SetWindow***(), SetNextWindow***(), SetNextTreeNode***() functions
+// All those functions treat 0 as a shortcut to ImGuiCond_Always
+enum ImGuiCond_
+{
+ ImGuiCond_Always = 1 << 0, // Set the variable
+ ImGuiCond_Once = 1 << 1, // Set the variable once per runtime session (only the first call with succeed)
+ ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver = 1 << 2, // Set the variable if the window has no saved data (if doesn't exist in the .ini file)
+ ImGuiCond_Appearing = 1 << 3 // Set the variable if the window is appearing after being hidden/inactive (or the first time)
+
+ // Obsolete names (will be removed)
+#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS
+ , ImGuiSetCond_Always = ImGuiCond_Always, ImGuiSetCond_Once = ImGuiCond_Once, ImGuiSetCond_FirstUseEver = ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver, ImGuiSetCond_Appearing = ImGuiCond_Appearing
+#endif
+};
+
+struct ImGuiStyle
+{
+ float Alpha; // Global alpha applies to everything in ImGui
+ ImVec2 WindowPadding; // Padding within a window
+ ImVec2 WindowMinSize; // Minimum window size
+ float WindowRounding; // Radius of window corners rounding. Set to 0.0f to have rectangular windows
+ ImVec2 WindowTitleAlign; // Alignment for title bar text. Defaults to (0.0f,0.5f) for left-aligned,vertically centered.
+ float ChildWindowRounding; // Radius of child window corners rounding. Set to 0.0f to have rectangular windows
+ ImVec2 FramePadding; // Padding within a framed rectangle (used by most widgets)
+ float FrameRounding; // Radius of frame corners rounding. Set to 0.0f to have rectangular frame (used by most widgets).
+ ImVec2 ItemSpacing; // Horizontal and vertical spacing between widgets/lines
+ ImVec2 ItemInnerSpacing; // Horizontal and vertical spacing between within elements of a composed widget (e.g. a slider and its label)
+ ImVec2 TouchExtraPadding; // Expand reactive bounding box for touch-based system where touch position is not accurate enough. Unfortunately we don't sort widgets so priority on overlap will always be given to the first widget. So don't grow this too much!
+ float IndentSpacing; // Horizontal indentation when e.g. entering a tree node. Generally == (FontSize + FramePadding.x*2).
+ float ColumnsMinSpacing; // Minimum horizontal spacing between two columns
+ float ScrollbarSize; // Width of the vertical scrollbar, Height of the horizontal scrollbar
+ float ScrollbarRounding; // Radius of grab corners for scrollbar
+ float GrabMinSize; // Minimum width/height of a grab box for slider/scrollbar.
+ float GrabRounding; // Radius of grabs corners rounding. Set to 0.0f to have rectangular slider grabs.
+ ImVec2 ButtonTextAlign; // Alignment of button text when button is larger than text. Defaults to (0.5f,0.5f) for horizontally+vertically centered.
+ ImVec2 DisplayWindowPadding; // Window positions are clamped to be visible within the display area by at least this amount. Only covers regular windows.
+ ImVec2 DisplaySafeAreaPadding; // If you cannot see the edge of your screen (e.g. on a TV) increase the safe area padding. Covers popups/tooltips as well regular windows.
+ bool AntiAliasedLines; // Enable anti-aliasing on lines/borders. Disable if you are really tight on CPU/GPU.
+ bool AntiAliasedShapes; // Enable anti-aliasing on filled shapes (rounded rectangles, circles, etc.)
+ float CurveTessellationTol; // Tessellation tolerance. Decrease for highly tessellated curves (higher quality, more polygons), increase to reduce quality.
+ ImVec4 Colors[ImGuiCol_COUNT];
+
+ IMGUI_API ImGuiStyle();
+};
+
+// This is where your app communicate with ImGui. Access via ImGui::GetIO().
+// Read 'Programmer guide' section in .cpp file for general usage.
+struct ImGuiIO
+{
+ //------------------------------------------------------------------
+ // Settings (fill once) // Default value:
+ //------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+ ImVec2 DisplaySize; // <unset> // Display size, in pixels. For clamping windows positions.
+ float DeltaTime; // = 1.0f/60.0f // Time elapsed since last frame, in seconds.
+ float IniSavingRate; // = 5.0f // Maximum time between saving positions/sizes to .ini file, in seconds.
+ const char* IniFilename; // = "imgui.ini" // Path to .ini file. NULL to disable .ini saving.
+ const char* LogFilename; // = "imgui_log.txt" // Path to .log file (default parameter to ImGui::LogToFile when no file is specified).
+ float MouseDoubleClickTime; // = 0.30f // Time for a double-click, in seconds.
+ float MouseDoubleClickMaxDist; // = 6.0f // Distance threshold to stay in to validate a double-click, in pixels.
+ float MouseDragThreshold; // = 6.0f // Distance threshold before considering we are dragging
+ int KeyMap[ImGuiKey_COUNT]; // <unset> // Map of indices into the KeysDown[512] entries array
+ float KeyRepeatDelay; // = 0.250f // When holding a key/button, time before it starts repeating, in seconds (for buttons in Repeat mode, etc.).
+ float KeyRepeatRate; // = 0.020f // When holding a key/button, rate at which it repeats, in seconds.
+ void* UserData; // = NULL // Store your own data for retrieval by callbacks.
+
+ ImFontAtlas* Fonts; // <auto> // Load and assemble one or more fonts into a single tightly packed texture. Output to Fonts array.
+ float FontGlobalScale; // = 1.0f // Global scale all fonts
+ bool FontAllowUserScaling; // = false // Allow user scaling text of individual window with CTRL+Wheel.
+ ImFont* FontDefault; // = NULL // Font to use on NewFrame(). Use NULL to uses Fonts->Fonts[0].
+ ImVec2 DisplayFramebufferScale; // = (1.0f,1.0f) // For retina display or other situations where window coordinates are different from framebuffer coordinates. User storage only, presently not used by ImGui.
+ ImVec2 DisplayVisibleMin; // <unset> (0.0f,0.0f) // If you use DisplaySize as a virtual space larger than your screen, set DisplayVisibleMin/Max to the visible area.
+ ImVec2 DisplayVisibleMax; // <unset> (0.0f,0.0f) // If the values are the same, we defaults to Min=(0.0f) and Max=DisplaySize
+
+ // Advanced/subtle behaviors
+ bool OSXBehaviors; // = defined(__APPLE__) // OS X style: Text editing cursor movement using Alt instead of Ctrl, Shortcuts using Cmd/Super instead of Ctrl, Line/Text Start and End using Cmd+Arrows instead of Home/End, Double click selects by word instead of selecting whole text, Multi-selection in lists uses Cmd/Super instead of Ctrl
+
+ //------------------------------------------------------------------
+ // Settings (User Functions)
+ //------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+ // Rendering function, will be called in Render().
+ // Alternatively you can keep this to NULL and call GetDrawData() after Render() to get the same pointer.
+ // See example applications if you are unsure of how to implement this.
+ void (*RenderDrawListsFn)(ImDrawData* data);
+
+ // Optional: access OS clipboard
+ // (default to use native Win32 clipboard on Windows, otherwise uses a private clipboard. Override to access OS clipboard on other architectures)
+ const char* (*GetClipboardTextFn)(void* user_data);
+ void (*SetClipboardTextFn)(void* user_data, const char* text);
+ void* ClipboardUserData;
+
+ // Optional: override memory allocations. MemFreeFn() may be called with a NULL pointer.
+ // (default to posix malloc/free)
+ void* (*MemAllocFn)(size_t sz);
+ void (*MemFreeFn)(void* ptr);
+
+ // Optional: notify OS Input Method Editor of the screen position of your cursor for text input position (e.g. when using Japanese/Chinese IME in Windows)
+ // (default to use native imm32 api on Windows)
+ void (*ImeSetInputScreenPosFn)(int x, int y);
+ void* ImeWindowHandle; // (Windows) Set this to your HWND to get automatic IME cursor positioning.
+
+ //------------------------------------------------------------------
+ // Input - Fill before calling NewFrame()
+ //------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+ ImVec2 MousePos; // Mouse position, in pixels. Set to ImVec2(-FLT_MAX,-FLT_MAX) if mouse is unavailable (on another screen, etc.)
+ bool MouseDown[5]; // Mouse buttons: left, right, middle + extras. ImGui itself mostly only uses left button (BeginPopupContext** are using right button). Others buttons allows us to track if the mouse is being used by your application + available to user as a convenience via IsMouse** API.
+ float MouseWheel; // Mouse wheel: 1 unit scrolls about 5 lines text.
+ bool MouseDrawCursor; // Request ImGui to draw a mouse cursor for you (if you are on a platform without a mouse cursor).
+ bool KeyCtrl; // Keyboard modifier pressed: Control
+ bool KeyShift; // Keyboard modifier pressed: Shift
+ bool KeyAlt; // Keyboard modifier pressed: Alt
+ bool KeySuper; // Keyboard modifier pressed: Cmd/Super/Windows
+ bool KeysDown[512]; // Keyboard keys that are pressed (in whatever storage order you naturally have access to keyboard data)
+ ImWchar InputCharacters[16+1]; // List of characters input (translated by user from keypress+keyboard state). Fill using AddInputCharacter() helper.
+
+ // Functions
+ IMGUI_API void AddInputCharacter(ImWchar c); // Add new character into InputCharacters[]
+ IMGUI_API void AddInputCharactersUTF8(const char* utf8_chars); // Add new characters into InputCharacters[] from an UTF-8 string
+ inline void ClearInputCharacters() { InputCharacters[0] = 0; } // Clear the text input buffer manually
+
+ //------------------------------------------------------------------
+ // Output - Retrieve after calling NewFrame()
+ //------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+ bool WantCaptureMouse; // Mouse is hovering a window or widget is active (= ImGui will use your mouse input). Use to hide mouse from the rest of your application
+ bool WantCaptureKeyboard; // Widget is active (= ImGui will use your keyboard input). Use to hide keyboard from the rest of your application
+ bool WantTextInput; // Some text input widget is active, which will read input characters from the InputCharacters array. Use to activate on screen keyboard if your system needs one
+ float Framerate; // Application framerate estimation, in frame per second. Solely for convenience. Rolling average estimation based on IO.DeltaTime over 120 frames
+ int MetricsAllocs; // Number of active memory allocations
+ int MetricsRenderVertices; // Vertices output during last call to Render()
+ int MetricsRenderIndices; // Indices output during last call to Render() = number of triangles * 3
+ int MetricsActiveWindows; // Number of visible root windows (exclude child windows)
+ ImVec2 MouseDelta; // Mouse delta. Note that this is zero if either current or previous position are negative, so a disappearing/reappearing mouse won't have a huge delta for one frame.
+
+ //------------------------------------------------------------------
+ // [Private] ImGui will maintain those fields. Forward compatibility not guaranteed!
+ //------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+ ImVec2 MousePosPrev; // Previous mouse position temporary storage (nb: not for public use, set to MousePos in NewFrame())
+ bool MouseClicked[5]; // Mouse button went from !Down to Down
+ ImVec2 MouseClickedPos[5]; // Position at time of clicking
+ float MouseClickedTime[5]; // Time of last click (used to figure out double-click)
+ bool MouseDoubleClicked[5]; // Has mouse button been double-clicked?
+ bool MouseReleased[5]; // Mouse button went from Down to !Down
+ bool MouseDownOwned[5]; // Track if button was clicked inside a window. We don't request mouse capture from the application if click started outside ImGui bounds.
+ float MouseDownDuration[5]; // Duration the mouse button has been down (0.0f == just clicked)
+ float MouseDownDurationPrev[5]; // Previous time the mouse button has been down
+ float MouseDragMaxDistanceSqr[5]; // Squared maximum distance of how much mouse has traveled from the click point
+ float KeysDownDuration[512]; // Duration the keyboard key has been down (0.0f == just pressed)
+ float KeysDownDurationPrev[512]; // Previous duration the key has been down
+
+ IMGUI_API ImGuiIO();
+};
+
+//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+// Helpers
+//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+// Lightweight std::vector<> like class to avoid dragging dependencies (also: windows implementation of STL with debug enabled is absurdly slow, so let's bypass it so our code runs fast in debug).
+// Our implementation does NOT call c++ constructors because we don't use them in ImGui. Don't use this class as a straight std::vector replacement in your code!
+template<typename T>
+class ImVector
+{
+public:
+ int Size;
+ int Capacity;
+ T* Data;
+
+ typedef T value_type;
+ typedef value_type* iterator;
+ typedef const value_type* const_iterator;
+
+ ImVector() { Size = Capacity = 0; Data = NULL; }
+ ~ImVector() { if (Data) ImGui::MemFree(Data); }
+
+ inline bool empty() const { return Size == 0; }
+ inline int size() const { return Size; }
+ inline int capacity() const { return Capacity; }
+
+ inline value_type& operator[](int i) { IM_ASSERT(i < Size); return Data[i]; }
+ inline const value_type& operator[](int i) const { IM_ASSERT(i < Size); return Data[i]; }
+
+ inline void clear() { if (Data) { Size = Capacity = 0; ImGui::MemFree(Data); Data = NULL; } }
+ inline iterator begin() { return Data; }
+ inline const_iterator begin() const { return Data; }
+ inline iterator end() { return Data + Size; }
+ inline const_iterator end() const { return Data + Size; }
+ inline value_type& front() { IM_ASSERT(Size > 0); return Data[0]; }
+ inline const value_type& front() const { IM_ASSERT(Size > 0); return Data[0]; }
+ inline value_type& back() { IM_ASSERT(Size > 0); return Data[Size-1]; }
+ inline const value_type& back() const { IM_ASSERT(Size > 0); return Data[Size-1]; }
+ inline void swap(ImVector<T>& rhs) { int rhs_size = rhs.Size; rhs.Size = Size; Size = rhs_size; int rhs_cap = rhs.Capacity; rhs.Capacity = Capacity; Capacity = rhs_cap; value_type* rhs_data = rhs.Data; rhs.Data = Data; Data = rhs_data; }
+
+ inline int _grow_capacity(int size) const { int new_capacity = Capacity ? (Capacity + Capacity/2) : 8; return new_capacity > size ? new_capacity : size; }
+
+ inline void resize(int new_size) { if (new_size > Capacity) reserve(_grow_capacity(new_size)); Size = new_size; }
+ inline void reserve(int new_capacity)
+ {
+ if (new_capacity <= Capacity) return;
+ T* new_data = (value_type*)ImGui::MemAlloc((size_t)new_capacity * sizeof(value_type));
+ if (Data)
+ memcpy(new_data, Data, (size_t)Size * sizeof(value_type));
+ ImGui::MemFree(Data);
+ Data = new_data;
+ Capacity = new_capacity;
+ }
+
+ inline void push_back(const value_type& v) { if (Size == Capacity) reserve(_grow_capacity(Size+1)); Data[Size++] = v; }
+ inline void pop_back() { IM_ASSERT(Size > 0); Size--; }
+
+ inline iterator erase(const_iterator it) { IM_ASSERT(it >= Data && it < Data+Size); const ptrdiff_t off = it - Data; memmove(Data + off, Data + off + 1, ((size_t)Size - (size_t)off - 1) * sizeof(value_type)); Size--; return Data + off; }
+ inline iterator insert(const_iterator it, const value_type& v) { IM_ASSERT(it >= Data && it <= Data+Size); const ptrdiff_t off = it - Data; if (Size == Capacity) reserve(Capacity ? Capacity * 2 : 4); if (off < (int)Size) memmove(Data + off + 1, Data + off, ((size_t)Size - (size_t)off) * sizeof(value_type)); Data[off] = v; Size++; return Data + off; }
+};
+
+// Helper: execute a block of code at maximum once a frame. Convenient if you want to quickly create an UI within deep-nested code that runs multiple times every frame.
+// Usage:
+// static ImGuiOnceUponAFrame oaf;
+// if (oaf)
+// ImGui::Text("This will be called only once per frame");
+struct ImGuiOnceUponAFrame
+{
+ ImGuiOnceUponAFrame() { RefFrame = -1; }
+ mutable int RefFrame;
+ operator bool() const { int current_frame = ImGui::GetFrameCount(); if (RefFrame == current_frame) return false; RefFrame = current_frame; return true; }
+};
+
+// Helper macro for ImGuiOnceUponAFrame. Attention: The macro expands into 2 statement so make sure you don't use it within e.g. an if() statement without curly braces.
+#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS // Will obsolete
+#define IMGUI_ONCE_UPON_A_FRAME static ImGuiOnceUponAFrame imgui_oaf; if (imgui_oaf)
+#endif
+
+// Helper: Parse and apply text filters. In format "aaaaa[,bbbb][,ccccc]"
+struct ImGuiTextFilter
+{
+ struct TextRange
+ {
+ const char* b;
+ const char* e;
+
+ TextRange() { b = e = NULL; }
+ TextRange(const char* _b, const char* _e) { b = _b; e = _e; }
+ const char* begin() const { return b; }
+ const char* end() const { return e; }
+ bool empty() const { return b == e; }
+ char front() const { return *b; }
+ static bool is_blank(char c) { return c == ' ' || c == '\t'; }
+ void trim_blanks() { while (b < e && is_blank(*b)) b++; while (e > b && is_blank(*(e-1))) e--; }
+ IMGUI_API void split(char separator, ImVector<TextRange>& out);
+ };
+
+ char InputBuf[256];
+ ImVector<TextRange> Filters;
+ int CountGrep;
+
+ IMGUI_API ImGuiTextFilter(const char* default_filter = "");
+ ~ImGuiTextFilter() {}
+ void Clear() { InputBuf[0] = 0; Build(); }
+ IMGUI_API bool Draw(const char* label = "Filter (inc,-exc)", float width = 0.0f); // Helper calling InputText+Build
+ IMGUI_API bool PassFilter(const char* text, const char* text_end = NULL) const;
+ bool IsActive() const { return !Filters.empty(); }
+ IMGUI_API void Build();
+};
+
+// Helper: Text buffer for logging/accumulating text
+struct ImGuiTextBuffer
+{
+ ImVector<char> Buf;
+
+ ImGuiTextBuffer() { Buf.push_back(0); }
+ inline char operator[](int i) { return Buf.Data[i]; }
+ const char* begin() const { return &Buf.front(); }
+ const char* end() const { return &Buf.back(); } // Buf is zero-terminated, so end() will point on the zero-terminator
+ int size() const { return Buf.Size - 1; }
+ bool empty() { return Buf.Size <= 1; }
+ void clear() { Buf.clear(); Buf.push_back(0); }
+ const char* c_str() const { return Buf.Data; }
+ IMGUI_API void append(const char* fmt, ...) IM_FMTARGS(2);
+ IMGUI_API void appendv(const char* fmt, va_list args) IM_FMTLIST(2);
+};
+
+// Helper: Simple Key->value storage
+// Typically you don't have to worry about this since a storage is held within each Window.
+// We use it to e.g. store collapse state for a tree (Int 0/1), store color edit options.
+// This is optimized for efficient reading (dichotomy into a contiguous buffer), rare writing (typically tied to user interactions)
+// You can use it as custom user storage for temporary values. Declare your own storage if, for example:
+// - You want to manipulate the open/close state of a particular sub-tree in your interface (tree node uses Int 0/1 to store their state).
+// - You want to store custom debug data easily without adding or editing structures in your code (probably not efficient, but convenient)
+// Types are NOT stored, so it is up to you to make sure your Key don't collide with different types.
+struct ImGuiStorage
+{
+ struct Pair
+ {
+ ImGuiID key;
+ union { int val_i; float val_f; void* val_p; };
+ Pair(ImGuiID _key, int _val_i) { key = _key; val_i = _val_i; }
+ Pair(ImGuiID _key, float _val_f) { key = _key; val_f = _val_f; }
+ Pair(ImGuiID _key, void* _val_p) { key = _key; val_p = _val_p; }
+ };
+ ImVector<Pair> Data;
+
+ // - Get***() functions find pair, never add/allocate. Pairs are sorted so a query is O(log N)
+ // - Set***() functions find pair, insertion on demand if missing.
+ // - Sorted insertion is costly, paid once. A typical frame shouldn't need to insert any new pair.
+ IMGUI_API void Clear();
+ IMGUI_API int GetInt(ImGuiID key, int default_val = 0) const;
+ IMGUI_API void SetInt(ImGuiID key, int val);
+ IMGUI_API bool GetBool(ImGuiID key, bool default_val = false) const;
+ IMGUI_API void SetBool(ImGuiID key, bool val);
+ IMGUI_API float GetFloat(ImGuiID key, float default_val = 0.0f) const;
+ IMGUI_API void SetFloat(ImGuiID key, float val);
+ IMGUI_API void* GetVoidPtr(ImGuiID key) const; // default_val is NULL
+ IMGUI_API void SetVoidPtr(ImGuiID key, void* val);
+
+ // - Get***Ref() functions finds pair, insert on demand if missing, return pointer. Useful if you intend to do Get+Set.
+ // - References are only valid until a new value is added to the storage. Calling a Set***() function or a Get***Ref() function invalidates the pointer.
+ // - A typical use case where this is convenient for quick hacking (e.g. add storage during a live Edit&Continue session if you can't modify existing struct)
+ // float* pvar = ImGui::GetFloatRef(key); ImGui::SliderFloat("var", pvar, 0, 100.0f); some_var += *pvar;
+ IMGUI_API int* GetIntRef(ImGuiID key, int default_val = 0);
+ IMGUI_API bool* GetBoolRef(ImGuiID key, bool default_val = false);
+ IMGUI_API float* GetFloatRef(ImGuiID key, float default_val = 0.0f);
+ IMGUI_API void** GetVoidPtrRef(ImGuiID key, void* default_val = NULL);
+
+ // Use on your own storage if you know only integer are being stored (open/close all tree nodes)
+ IMGUI_API void SetAllInt(int val);
+};
+
+// Shared state of InputText(), passed to callback when a ImGuiInputTextFlags_Callback* flag is used and the corresponding callback is triggered.
+struct ImGuiTextEditCallbackData
+{
+ ImGuiInputTextFlags EventFlag; // One of ImGuiInputTextFlags_Callback* // Read-only
+ ImGuiInputTextFlags Flags; // What user passed to InputText() // Read-only
+ void* UserData; // What user passed to InputText() // Read-only
+ bool ReadOnly; // Read-only mode // Read-only
+
+ // CharFilter event:
+ ImWchar EventChar; // Character input // Read-write (replace character or set to zero)
+
+ // Completion,History,Always events:
+ // If you modify the buffer contents make sure you update 'BufTextLen' and set 'BufDirty' to true.
+ ImGuiKey EventKey; // Key pressed (Up/Down/TAB) // Read-only
+ char* Buf; // Current text buffer // Read-write (pointed data only, can't replace the actual pointer)
+ int BufTextLen; // Current text length in bytes // Read-write
+ int BufSize; // Maximum text length in bytes // Read-only
+ bool BufDirty; // Set if you modify Buf/BufTextLen!! // Write
+ int CursorPos; // // Read-write
+ int SelectionStart; // // Read-write (== to SelectionEnd when no selection)
+ int SelectionEnd; // // Read-write
+
+ // NB: Helper functions for text manipulation. Calling those function loses selection.
+ IMGUI_API void DeleteChars(int pos, int bytes_count);
+ IMGUI_API void InsertChars(int pos, const char* text, const char* text_end = NULL);
+ bool HasSelection() const { return SelectionStart != SelectionEnd; }
+};
+
+// Resizing callback data to apply custom constraint. As enabled by SetNextWindowSizeConstraints(). Callback is called during the next Begin().
+// NB: For basic min/max size constraint on each axis you don't need to use the callback! The SetNextWindowSizeConstraints() parameters are enough.
+struct ImGuiSizeConstraintCallbackData
+{
+ void* UserData; // Read-only. What user passed to SetNextWindowSizeConstraints()
+ ImVec2 Pos; // Read-only. Window position, for reference.
+ ImVec2 CurrentSize; // Read-only. Current window size.
+ ImVec2 DesiredSize; // Read-write. Desired size, based on user's mouse position. Write to this field to restrain resizing.
+};
+
+// Helpers macros to generate 32-bits encoded colors
+#ifdef IMGUI_USE_BGRA_PACKED_COLOR
+#define IM_COL32_R_SHIFT 16
+#define IM_COL32_G_SHIFT 8
+#define IM_COL32_B_SHIFT 0
+#define IM_COL32_A_SHIFT 24
+#define IM_COL32_A_MASK 0xFF000000
+#else
+#define IM_COL32_R_SHIFT 0
+#define IM_COL32_G_SHIFT 8
+#define IM_COL32_B_SHIFT 16
+#define IM_COL32_A_SHIFT 24
+#define IM_COL32_A_MASK 0xFF000000
+#endif
+#define IM_COL32(R,G,B,A) (((ImU32)(A)<<IM_COL32_A_SHIFT) | ((ImU32)(B)<<IM_COL32_B_SHIFT) | ((ImU32)(G)<<IM_COL32_G_SHIFT) | ((ImU32)(R)<<IM_COL32_R_SHIFT))
+#define IM_COL32_WHITE IM_COL32(255,255,255,255) // Opaque white = 0xFFFFFFFF
+#define IM_COL32_BLACK IM_COL32(0,0,0,255) // Opaque black
+#define IM_COL32_BLACK_TRANS IM_COL32(0,0,0,0) // Transparent black = 0x00000000
+
+// ImColor() helper to implicity converts colors to either ImU32 (packed 4x1 byte) or ImVec4 (4x1 float)
+// Prefer using IM_COL32() macros if you want a guaranteed compile-time ImU32 for usage with ImDrawList API.
+// **Avoid storing ImColor! Store either u32 of ImVec4. This is not a full-featured color class. MAY OBSOLETE.
+// **None of the ImGui API are using ImColor directly but you can use it as a convenience to pass colors in either ImU32 or ImVec4 formats. Explicitly cast to ImU32 or ImVec4 if needed.
+struct ImColor
+{
+ ImVec4 Value;
+
+ ImColor() { Value.x = Value.y = Value.z = Value.w = 0.0f; }
+ ImColor(int r, int g, int b, int a = 255) { float sc = 1.0f/255.0f; Value.x = (float)r * sc; Value.y = (float)g * sc; Value.z = (float)b * sc; Value.w = (float)a * sc; }
+ ImColor(ImU32 rgba) { float sc = 1.0f/255.0f; Value.x = (float)((rgba>>IM_COL32_R_SHIFT)&0xFF) * sc; Value.y = (float)((rgba>>IM_COL32_G_SHIFT)&0xFF) * sc; Value.z = (float)((rgba>>IM_COL32_B_SHIFT)&0xFF) * sc; Value.w = (float)((rgba>>IM_COL32_A_SHIFT)&0xFF) * sc; }
+ ImColor(float r, float g, float b, float a = 1.0f) { Value.x = r; Value.y = g; Value.z = b; Value.w = a; }
+ ImColor(const ImVec4& col) { Value = col; }
+ inline operator ImU32() const { return ImGui::ColorConvertFloat4ToU32(Value); }
+ inline operator ImVec4() const { return Value; }
+
+ // FIXME-OBSOLETE: May need to obsolete/cleanup those helpers.
+ inline void SetHSV(float h, float s, float v, float a = 1.0f){ ImGui::ColorConvertHSVtoRGB(h, s, v, Value.x, Value.y, Value.z); Value.w = a; }
+ static ImColor HSV(float h, float s, float v, float a = 1.0f) { float r,g,b; ImGui::ColorConvertHSVtoRGB(h, s, v, r, g, b); return ImColor(r,g,b,a); }
+};
+
+// Helper: Manually clip large list of items.
+// If you are submitting lots of evenly spaced items and you have a random access to the list, you can perform coarse clipping based on visibility to save yourself from processing those items at all.
+// The clipper calculates the range of visible items and advance the cursor to compensate for the non-visible items we have skipped.
+// ImGui already clip items based on their bounds but it needs to measure text size to do so. Coarse clipping before submission makes this cost and your own data fetching/submission cost null.
+// Usage:
+// ImGuiListClipper clipper(1000); // we have 1000 elements, evenly spaced.
+// while (clipper.Step())
+// for (int i = clipper.DisplayStart; i < clipper.DisplayEnd; i++)
+// ImGui::Text("line number %d", i);
+// - Step 0: the clipper let you process the first element, regardless of it being visible or not, so we can measure the element height (step skipped if we passed a known height as second arg to constructor).
+// - Step 1: the clipper infer height from first element, calculate the actual range of elements to display, and position the cursor before the first element.
+// - (Step 2: dummy step only required if an explicit items_height was passed to constructor or Begin() and user call Step(). Does nothing and switch to Step 3.)
+// - Step 3: the clipper validate that we have reached the expected Y position (corresponding to element DisplayEnd), advance the cursor to the end of the list and then returns 'false' to end the loop.
+struct ImGuiListClipper
+{
+ float StartPosY;
+ float ItemsHeight;
+ int ItemsCount, StepNo, DisplayStart, DisplayEnd;
+
+ // items_count: Use -1 to ignore (you can call Begin later). Use INT_MAX if you don't know how many items you have (in which case the cursor won't be advanced in the final step).
+ // items_height: Use -1.0f to be calculated automatically on first step. Otherwise pass in the distance between your items, typically GetTextLineHeightWithSpacing() or GetItemsLineHeightWithSpacing().
+ // If you don't specify an items_height, you NEED to call Step(). If you specify items_height you may call the old Begin()/End() api directly, but prefer calling Step().
+ ImGuiListClipper(int items_count = -1, float items_height = -1.0f) { Begin(items_count, items_height); } // NB: Begin() initialize every fields (as we allow user to call Begin/End multiple times on a same instance if they want).
+ ~ImGuiListClipper() { IM_ASSERT(ItemsCount == -1); } // Assert if user forgot to call End() or Step() until false.
+
+ IMGUI_API bool Step(); // Call until it returns false. The DisplayStart/DisplayEnd fields will be set and you can process/draw those items.
+ IMGUI_API void Begin(int items_count, float items_height = -1.0f); // Automatically called by constructor if you passed 'items_count' or by Step() in Step 1.
+ IMGUI_API void End(); // Automatically called on the last call of Step() that returns false.
+};
+
+//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+// Draw List
+// Hold a series of drawing commands. The user provides a renderer for ImDrawData which essentially contains an array of ImDrawList.
+//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+// Draw callbacks for advanced uses.
+// NB- You most likely do NOT need to use draw callbacks just to create your own widget or customized UI rendering (you can poke into the draw list for that)
+// Draw callback may be useful for example, A) Change your GPU render state, B) render a complex 3D scene inside a UI element (without an intermediate texture/render target), etc.
+// The expected behavior from your rendering function is 'if (cmd.UserCallback != NULL) cmd.UserCallback(parent_list, cmd); else RenderTriangles()'
+typedef void (*ImDrawCallback)(const ImDrawList* parent_list, const ImDrawCmd* cmd);
+
+// Typically, 1 command = 1 gpu draw call (unless command is a callback)
+struct ImDrawCmd
+{
+ unsigned int ElemCount; // Number of indices (multiple of 3) to be rendered as triangles. Vertices are stored in the callee ImDrawList's vtx_buffer[] array, indices in idx_buffer[].
+ ImVec4 ClipRect; // Clipping rectangle (x1, y1, x2, y2)
+ ImTextureID TextureId; // User-provided texture ID. Set by user in ImfontAtlas::SetTexID() for fonts or passed to Image*() functions. Ignore if never using images or multiple fonts atlas.
+ ImDrawCallback UserCallback; // If != NULL, call the function instead of rendering the vertices. clip_rect and texture_id will be set normally.
+ void* UserCallbackData; // The draw callback code can access this.
+
+ ImDrawCmd() { ElemCount = 0; ClipRect.x = ClipRect.y = -8192.0f; ClipRect.z = ClipRect.w = +8192.0f; TextureId = NULL; UserCallback = NULL; UserCallbackData = NULL; }
+};
+
+// Vertex index (override with '#define ImDrawIdx unsigned int' inside in imconfig.h)
+#ifndef ImDrawIdx
+typedef unsigned short ImDrawIdx;
+#endif
+
+// Vertex layout
+#ifndef IMGUI_OVERRIDE_DRAWVERT_STRUCT_LAYOUT
+struct ImDrawVert
+{
+ ImVec2 pos;
+ ImVec2 uv;
+ ImU32 col;
+};
+#else
+// You can override the vertex format layout by defining IMGUI_OVERRIDE_DRAWVERT_STRUCT_LAYOUT in imconfig.h
+// The code expect ImVec2 pos (8 bytes), ImVec2 uv (8 bytes), ImU32 col (4 bytes), but you can re-order them or add other fields as needed to simplify integration in your engine.
+// The type has to be described within the macro (you can either declare the struct or use a typedef)
+// NOTE: IMGUI DOESN'T CLEAR THE STRUCTURE AND DOESN'T CALL A CONSTRUCTOR SO ANY CUSTOM FIELD WILL BE UNINITIALIZED. IF YOU ADD EXTRA FIELDS (SUCH AS A 'Z' COORDINATES) YOU WILL NEED TO CLEAR THEM DURING RENDER OR TO IGNORE THEM.
+IMGUI_OVERRIDE_DRAWVERT_STRUCT_LAYOUT;
+#endif
+
+// Draw channels are used by the Columns API to "split" the render list into different channels while building, so items of each column can be batched together.
+// You can also use them to simulate drawing layers and submit primitives in a different order than how they will be rendered.
+struct ImDrawChannel
+{
+ ImVector<ImDrawCmd> CmdBuffer;
+ ImVector<ImDrawIdx> IdxBuffer;
+};
+
+// Draw command list
+// This is the low-level list of polygons that ImGui functions are filling. At the end of the frame, all command lists are passed to your ImGuiIO::RenderDrawListFn function for rendering.
+// At the moment, each ImGui window contains its own ImDrawList but they could potentially be merged in the future.
+// If you want to add custom rendering within a window, you can use ImGui::GetWindowDrawList() to access the current draw list and add your own primitives.
+// You can interleave normal ImGui:: calls and adding primitives to the current draw list.
+// All positions are generally in pixel coordinates (top-left at (0,0), bottom-right at io.DisplaySize), however you are totally free to apply whatever transformation matrix to want to the data (if you apply such transformation you'll want to apply it to ClipRect as well)
+// Primitives are always added to the list and not culled (culling is done at higher-level by ImGui:: functions).
+struct ImDrawList
+{
+ // This is what you have to render
+ ImVector<ImDrawCmd> CmdBuffer; // Commands. Typically 1 command = 1 GPU draw call.
+ ImVector<ImDrawIdx> IdxBuffer; // Index buffer. Each command consume ImDrawCmd::ElemCount of those
+ ImVector<ImDrawVert> VtxBuffer; // Vertex buffer.
+
+ // [Internal, used while building lists]
+ const char* _OwnerName; // Pointer to owner window's name for debugging
+ unsigned int _VtxCurrentIdx; // [Internal] == VtxBuffer.Size
+ ImDrawVert* _VtxWritePtr; // [Internal] point within VtxBuffer.Data after each add command (to avoid using the ImVector<> operators too much)
+ ImDrawIdx* _IdxWritePtr; // [Internal] point within IdxBuffer.Data after each add command (to avoid using the ImVector<> operators too much)
+ ImVector<ImVec4> _ClipRectStack; // [Internal]
+ ImVector<ImTextureID> _TextureIdStack; // [Internal]
+ ImVector<ImVec2> _Path; // [Internal] current path building
+ int _ChannelsCurrent; // [Internal] current channel number (0)
+ int _ChannelsCount; // [Internal] number of active channels (1+)
+ ImVector<ImDrawChannel> _Channels; // [Internal] draw channels for columns API (not resized down so _ChannelsCount may be smaller than _Channels.Size)
+
+ ImDrawList() { _OwnerName = NULL; Clear(); }
+ ~ImDrawList() { ClearFreeMemory(); }
+ IMGUI_API void PushClipRect(ImVec2 clip_rect_min, ImVec2 clip_rect_max, bool intersect_with_current_clip_rect = false); // Render-level scissoring. This is passed down to your render function but not used for CPU-side coarse clipping. Prefer using higher-level ImGui::PushClipRect() to affect logic (hit-testing and widget culling)
+ IMGUI_API void PushClipRectFullScreen();
+ IMGUI_API void PopClipRect();
+ IMGUI_API void PushTextureID(const ImTextureID& texture_id);
+ IMGUI_API void PopTextureID();
+ inline ImVec2 GetClipRectMin() const { const ImVec4& cr = _ClipRectStack.back(); return ImVec2(cr.x, cr.y); }
+ inline ImVec2 GetClipRectMax() const { const ImVec4& cr = _ClipRectStack.back(); return ImVec2(cr.z, cr.w); }
+
+ // Primitives
+ IMGUI_API void AddLine(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, ImU32 col, float thickness = 1.0f);
+ IMGUI_API void AddRect(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, ImU32 col, float rounding = 0.0f, int rounding_corners_flags = ~0, float thickness = 1.0f); // a: upper-left, b: lower-right, rounding_corners_flags: 4-bits corresponding to which corner to round
+ IMGUI_API void AddRectFilled(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, ImU32 col, float rounding = 0.0f, int rounding_corners_flags = ~0); // a: upper-left, b: lower-right
+ IMGUI_API void AddRectFilledMultiColor(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, ImU32 col_upr_left, ImU32 col_upr_right, ImU32 col_bot_right, ImU32 col_bot_left);
+ IMGUI_API void AddQuad(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& c, const ImVec2& d, ImU32 col, float thickness = 1.0f);
+ IMGUI_API void AddQuadFilled(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& c, const ImVec2& d, ImU32 col);
+ IMGUI_API void AddTriangle(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& c, ImU32 col, float thickness = 1.0f);
+ IMGUI_API void AddTriangleFilled(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& c, ImU32 col);
+ IMGUI_API void AddCircle(const ImVec2& centre, float radius, ImU32 col, int num_segments = 12, float thickness = 1.0f);
+ IMGUI_API void AddCircleFilled(const ImVec2& centre, float radius, ImU32 col, int num_segments = 12);
+ IMGUI_API void AddText(const ImVec2& pos, ImU32 col, const char* text_begin, const char* text_end = NULL);
+ IMGUI_API void AddText(const ImFont* font, float font_size, const ImVec2& pos, ImU32 col, const char* text_begin, const char* text_end = NULL, float wrap_width = 0.0f, const ImVec4* cpu_fine_clip_rect = NULL);
+ IMGUI_API void AddImage(ImTextureID user_texture_id, const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& uv_a = ImVec2(0,0), const ImVec2& uv_b = ImVec2(1,1), ImU32 col = 0xFFFFFFFF);
+ IMGUI_API void AddImageQuad(ImTextureID user_texture_id, const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& c, const ImVec2& d, const ImVec2& uv_a = ImVec2(0,0), const ImVec2& uv_b = ImVec2(1,0), const ImVec2& uv_c = ImVec2(1,1), const ImVec2& uv_d = ImVec2(0,1), ImU32 col = 0xFFFFFFFF);
+ IMGUI_API void AddPolyline(const ImVec2* points, const int num_points, ImU32 col, bool closed, float thickness, bool anti_aliased);
+ IMGUI_API void AddConvexPolyFilled(const ImVec2* points, const int num_points, ImU32 col, bool anti_aliased);
+ IMGUI_API void AddBezierCurve(const ImVec2& pos0, const ImVec2& cp0, const ImVec2& cp1, const ImVec2& pos1, ImU32 col, float thickness, int num_segments = 0);
+
+ // Stateful path API, add points then finish with PathFill() or PathStroke()
+ inline void PathClear() { _Path.resize(0); }
+ inline void PathLineTo(const ImVec2& pos) { _Path.push_back(pos); }
+ inline void PathLineToMergeDuplicate(const ImVec2& pos) { if (_Path.Size == 0 || memcmp(&_Path[_Path.Size-1], &pos, 8) != 0) _Path.push_back(pos); }
+ inline void PathFillConvex(ImU32 col) { AddConvexPolyFilled(_Path.Data, _Path.Size, col, true); PathClear(); }
+ inline void PathStroke(ImU32 col, bool closed, float thickness = 1.0f) { AddPolyline(_Path.Data, _Path.Size, col, closed, thickness, true); PathClear(); }
+ IMGUI_API void PathArcTo(const ImVec2& centre, float radius, float a_min, float a_max, int num_segments = 10);
+ IMGUI_API void PathArcToFast(const ImVec2& centre, float radius, int a_min_of_12, int a_max_of_12); // Use precomputed angles for a 12 steps circle
+ IMGUI_API void PathBezierCurveTo(const ImVec2& p1, const ImVec2& p2, const ImVec2& p3, int num_segments = 0);
+ IMGUI_API void PathRect(const ImVec2& rect_min, const ImVec2& rect_max, float rounding = 0.0f, int rounding_corners_flags = ~0); // rounding_corners_flags: 4-bits corresponding to which corner to round
+
+ // Channels
+ // - Use to simulate layers. By switching channels to can render out-of-order (e.g. submit foreground primitives before background primitives)
+ // - Use to minimize draw calls (e.g. if going back-and-forth between multiple non-overlapping clipping rectangles, prefer to append into separate channels then merge at the end)
+ IMGUI_API void ChannelsSplit(int channels_count);
+ IMGUI_API void ChannelsMerge();
+ IMGUI_API void ChannelsSetCurrent(int channel_index);
+
+ // Advanced
+ IMGUI_API void AddCallback(ImDrawCallback callback, void* callback_data); // Your rendering function must check for 'UserCallback' in ImDrawCmd and call the function instead of rendering triangles.
+ IMGUI_API void AddDrawCmd(); // This is useful if you need to forcefully create a new draw call (to allow for dependent rendering / blending). Otherwise primitives are merged into the same draw-call as much as possible
+
+ // Internal helpers
+ // NB: all primitives needs to be reserved via PrimReserve() beforehand!
+ IMGUI_API void Clear();
+ IMGUI_API void ClearFreeMemory();
+ IMGUI_API void PrimReserve(int idx_count, int vtx_count);
+ IMGUI_API void PrimRect(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, ImU32 col); // Axis aligned rectangle (composed of two triangles)
+ IMGUI_API void PrimRectUV(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& uv_a, const ImVec2& uv_b, ImU32 col);
+ IMGUI_API void PrimQuadUV(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& c, const ImVec2& d, const ImVec2& uv_a, const ImVec2& uv_b, const ImVec2& uv_c, const ImVec2& uv_d, ImU32 col);
+ inline void PrimWriteVtx(const ImVec2& pos, const ImVec2& uv, ImU32 col){ _VtxWritePtr->pos = pos; _VtxWritePtr->uv = uv; _VtxWritePtr->col = col; _VtxWritePtr++; _VtxCurrentIdx++; }
+ inline void PrimWriteIdx(ImDrawIdx idx) { *_IdxWritePtr = idx; _IdxWritePtr++; }
+ inline void PrimVtx(const ImVec2& pos, const ImVec2& uv, ImU32 col) { PrimWriteIdx((ImDrawIdx)_VtxCurrentIdx); PrimWriteVtx(pos, uv, col); }
+ IMGUI_API void UpdateClipRect();
+ IMGUI_API void UpdateTextureID();
+};
+
+// All draw data to render an ImGui frame
+struct ImDrawData
+{
+ bool Valid; // Only valid after Render() is called and before the next NewFrame() is called.
+ ImDrawList** CmdLists;
+ int CmdListsCount;
+ int TotalVtxCount; // For convenience, sum of all cmd_lists vtx_buffer.Size
+ int TotalIdxCount; // For convenience, sum of all cmd_lists idx_buffer.Size
+
+ // Functions
+ ImDrawData() { Valid = false; CmdLists = NULL; CmdListsCount = TotalVtxCount = TotalIdxCount = 0; }
+ IMGUI_API void DeIndexAllBuffers(); // For backward compatibility or convenience: convert all buffers from indexed to de-indexed, in case you cannot render indexed. Note: this is slow and most likely a waste of resources. Always prefer indexed rendering!
+ IMGUI_API void ScaleClipRects(const ImVec2& sc); // Helper to scale the ClipRect field of each ImDrawCmd. Use if your final output buffer is at a different scale than ImGui expects, or if there is a difference between your window resolution and framebuffer resolution.
+};
+
+struct ImFontConfig
+{
+ void* FontData; // // TTF/OTF data
+ int FontDataSize; // // TTF/OTF data size
+ bool FontDataOwnedByAtlas; // true // TTF/OTF data ownership taken by the container ImFontAtlas (will delete memory itself).
+ int FontNo; // 0 // Index of font within TTF/OTF file
+ float SizePixels; // // Size in pixels for rasterizer.
+ int OversampleH, OversampleV; // 3, 1 // Rasterize at higher quality for sub-pixel positioning. We don't use sub-pixel positions on the Y axis.
+ bool PixelSnapH; // false // Align every glyph to pixel boundary. Useful e.g. if you are merging a non-pixel aligned font with the default font. If enabled, you can set OversampleH/V to 1.
+ ImVec2 GlyphExtraSpacing; // 0, 0 // Extra spacing (in pixels) between glyphs. Only X axis is supported for now.
+ ImVec2 GlyphOffset; // 0, 0 // Offset all glyphs from this font input.
+ const ImWchar* GlyphRanges; // NULL // Pointer to a user-provided list of Unicode range (2 value per range, values are inclusive, zero-terminated list). THE ARRAY DATA NEEDS TO PERSIST AS LONG AS THE FONT IS ALIVE.
+ bool MergeMode; // false // Merge into previous ImFont, so you can combine multiple inputs font into one ImFont (e.g. ASCII font + icons + Japanese glyphs). You may want to use GlyphOffset.y when merge font of different heights.
+ unsigned int RasterizerFlags; // 0x00 // Settings for custom font rasterizer (e.g. ImGuiFreeType). Leave as zero if you aren't using one.
+ float RasterizerMultiply; // 1.0f // Brighten (>1.0f) or darken (<1.0f) font output. Brightening small fonts may be a good workaround to make them more readable.
+
+ // [Internal]
+ char Name[32]; // Name (strictly to ease debugging)
+ ImFont* DstFont;
+
+ IMGUI_API ImFontConfig();
+};
+
+// Load and rasterize multiple TTF/OTF fonts into a same texture.
+// Sharing a texture for multiple fonts allows us to reduce the number of draw calls during rendering.
+// We also add custom graphic data into the texture that serves for ImGui.
+// 1. (Optional) Call AddFont*** functions. If you don't call any, the default font will be loaded for you.
+// 2. Call GetTexDataAsAlpha8() or GetTexDataAsRGBA32() to build and retrieve pixels data.
+// 3. Upload the pixels data into a texture within your graphics system.
+// 4. Call SetTexID(my_tex_id); and pass the pointer/identifier to your texture. This value will be passed back to you during rendering to identify the texture.
+// IMPORTANT: If you pass a 'glyph_ranges' array to AddFont*** functions, you need to make sure that your array persist up until the ImFont is build (when calling GetTextData*** or Build()). We only copy the pointer, not the data.
+struct ImFontAtlas
+{
+ IMGUI_API ImFontAtlas();
+ IMGUI_API ~ImFontAtlas();
+ IMGUI_API ImFont* AddFont(const ImFontConfig* font_cfg);
+ IMGUI_API ImFont* AddFontDefault(const ImFontConfig* font_cfg = NULL);
+ IMGUI_API ImFont* AddFontFromFileTTF(const char* filename, float size_pixels, const ImFontConfig* font_cfg = NULL, const ImWchar* glyph_ranges = NULL);
+ IMGUI_API ImFont* AddFontFromMemoryTTF(void* font_data, int font_size, float size_pixels, const ImFontConfig* font_cfg = NULL, const ImWchar* glyph_ranges = NULL); // Transfer ownership of 'ttf_data' to ImFontAtlas, will be deleted after Build()
+ IMGUI_API ImFont* AddFontFromMemoryCompressedTTF(const void* compressed_font_data, int compressed_font_size, float size_pixels, const ImFontConfig* font_cfg = NULL, const ImWchar* glyph_ranges = NULL); // 'compressed_font_data' still owned by caller. Compress with binary_to_compressed_c.cpp
+ IMGUI_API ImFont* AddFontFromMemoryCompressedBase85TTF(const char* compressed_font_data_base85, float size_pixels, const ImFontConfig* font_cfg = NULL, const ImWchar* glyph_ranges = NULL); // 'compressed_font_data_base85' still owned by caller. Compress with binary_to_compressed_c.cpp with -base85 paramaeter
+ IMGUI_API void ClearTexData(); // Clear the CPU-side texture data. Saves RAM once the texture has been copied to graphics memory.
+ IMGUI_API void ClearInputData(); // Clear the input TTF data (inc sizes, glyph ranges)
+ IMGUI_API void ClearFonts(); // Clear the ImGui-side font data (glyphs storage, UV coordinates)
+ IMGUI_API void Clear(); // Clear all
+
+ // Retrieve texture data
+ // User is in charge of copying the pixels into graphics memory, then call SetTextureUserID()
+ // After loading the texture into your graphic system, store your texture handle in 'TexID' (ignore if you aren't using multiple fonts nor images)
+ // RGBA32 format is provided for convenience and high compatibility, but note that all RGB pixels are white, so 75% of the memory is wasted.
+ // Pitch = Width * BytesPerPixels
+ IMGUI_API void GetTexDataAsAlpha8(unsigned char** out_pixels, int* out_width, int* out_height, int* out_bytes_per_pixel = NULL); // 1 byte per-pixel
+ IMGUI_API void GetTexDataAsRGBA32(unsigned char** out_pixels, int* out_width, int* out_height, int* out_bytes_per_pixel = NULL); // 4 bytes-per-pixel
+ void SetTexID(ImTextureID id) { TexID = id; }
+
+ // Helpers to retrieve list of common Unicode ranges (2 value per range, values are inclusive, zero-terminated list)
+ // NB: Make sure that your string are UTF-8 and NOT in your local code page. In C++11, you can create UTF-8 string literal using the u8"Hello world" syntax. See FAQ for details.
+ IMGUI_API const ImWchar* GetGlyphRangesDefault(); // Basic Latin, Extended Latin
+ IMGUI_API const ImWchar* GetGlyphRangesKorean(); // Default + Korean characters
+ IMGUI_API const ImWchar* GetGlyphRangesJapanese(); // Default + Hiragana, Katakana, Half-Width, Selection of 1946 Ideographs
+ IMGUI_API const ImWchar* GetGlyphRangesChinese(); // Japanese + full set of about 21000 CJK Unified Ideographs
+ IMGUI_API const ImWchar* GetGlyphRangesCyrillic(); // Default + about 400 Cyrillic characters
+ IMGUI_API const ImWchar* GetGlyphRangesThai(); // Default + Thai characters
+
+ // Helpers to build glyph ranges from text data. Feed all your application strings/characters to it then call BuildRanges().
+ struct GlyphRangesBuilder
+ {
+ ImVector<unsigned char> UsedChars; // Store 1-bit per Unicode code point (0=unused, 1=used)
+ GlyphRangesBuilder() { UsedChars.resize(0x10000 / 8); memset(UsedChars.Data, 0, 0x10000 / 8); }
+ bool GetBit(int n) { return (UsedChars[n >> 3] & (1 << (n & 7))) != 0; }
+ void SetBit(int n) { UsedChars[n >> 3] |= 1 << (n & 7); } // Set bit 'c' in the array
+ void AddChar(ImWchar c) { SetBit(c); } // Add character
+ IMGUI_API void AddText(const char* text, const char* text_end = NULL); // Add string (each character of the UTF-8 string are added)
+ IMGUI_API void AddRanges(const ImWchar* ranges); // Add ranges, e.g. builder.AddRanges(ImFontAtlas::GetGlyphRangesDefault) to force add all of ASCII/Latin+Ext
+ IMGUI_API void BuildRanges(ImVector<ImWchar>* out_ranges); // Output new ranges
+ };
+
+ // Members
+ // (Access texture data via GetTexData*() calls which will setup a default font for you.)
+ ImTextureID TexID; // User data to refer to the texture once it has been uploaded to user's graphic systems. It is passed back to you during rendering via the ImDrawCmd structure.
+ unsigned char* TexPixelsAlpha8; // 1 component per pixel, each component is unsigned 8-bit. Total size = TexWidth * TexHeight
+ unsigned int* TexPixelsRGBA32; // 4 component per pixel, each component is unsigned 8-bit. Total size = TexWidth * TexHeight * 4
+ int TexWidth; // Texture width calculated during Build().
+ int TexHeight; // Texture height calculated during Build().
+ int TexDesiredWidth; // Texture width desired by user before Build(). Must be a power-of-two. If have many glyphs your graphics API have texture size restrictions you may want to increase texture width to decrease height.
+ int TexGlyphPadding; // Padding between glyphs within texture in pixels. Defaults to 1.
+ ImVec2 TexUvWhitePixel; // Texture coordinates to a white pixel
+ ImVector<ImFont*> Fonts; // Hold all the fonts returned by AddFont*. Fonts[0] is the default font upon calling ImGui::NewFrame(), use ImGui::PushFont()/PopFont() to change the current font.
+
+ // [Private] User rectangle for packing custom texture data into the atlas.
+ struct CustomRect
+ {
+ unsigned int ID; // Input // User ID. <0x10000 for font mapped data (WIP/UNSUPPORTED), >=0x10000 for other texture data
+ unsigned short Width, Height; // Input // Desired rectangle dimension
+ unsigned short X, Y; // Output // Packed position in Atlas
+ CustomRect() { ID = 0xFFFFFFFF; Width = Height = 0; X = Y = 0xFFFF; }
+ bool IsPacked() const { return X != 0xFFFF; }
+ };
+
+ // [Private] Members
+ ImVector<CustomRect> CustomRects; // Rectangles for packing custom texture data into the atlas.
+ ImVector<ImFontConfig> ConfigData; // Internal data
+ IMGUI_API bool Build(); // Build pixels data. This is automatically for you by the GetTexData*** functions.
+ IMGUI_API int CustomRectRegister(unsigned int id, int width, int height);
+ IMGUI_API void CustomRectCalcUV(const CustomRect* rect, ImVec2* out_uv_min, ImVec2* out_uv_max);
+};
+
+// Font runtime data and rendering
+// ImFontAtlas automatically loads a default embedded font for you when you call GetTexDataAsAlpha8() or GetTexDataAsRGBA32().
+struct ImFont
+{
+ struct Glyph
+ {
+ ImWchar Codepoint;
+ float XAdvance;
+ float X0, Y0, X1, Y1;
+ float U0, V0, U1, V1; // Texture coordinates
+ };
+
+ // Members: Hot ~62/78 bytes
+ float FontSize; // <user set> // Height of characters, set during loading (don't change after loading)
+ float Scale; // = 1.f // Base font scale, multiplied by the per-window font scale which you can adjust with SetFontScale()
+ ImVec2 DisplayOffset; // = (0.f,1.f) // Offset font rendering by xx pixels
+ ImVector<Glyph> Glyphs; // // All glyphs.
+ ImVector<float> IndexXAdvance; // // Sparse. Glyphs->XAdvance in a directly indexable way (more cache-friendly, for CalcTextSize functions which are often bottleneck in large UI).
+ ImVector<unsigned short> IndexLookup; // // Sparse. Index glyphs by Unicode code-point.
+ const Glyph* FallbackGlyph; // == FindGlyph(FontFallbackChar)
+ float FallbackXAdvance; // == FallbackGlyph->XAdvance
+ ImWchar FallbackChar; // = '?' // Replacement glyph if one isn't found. Only set via SetFallbackChar()
+
+ // Members: Cold ~18/26 bytes
+ short ConfigDataCount; // ~ 1 // Number of ImFontConfig involved in creating this font. Bigger than 1 when merging multiple font sources into one ImFont.
+ ImFontConfig* ConfigData; // // Pointer within ContainerAtlas->ConfigData
+ ImFontAtlas* ContainerAtlas; // // What we has been loaded into
+ float Ascent, Descent; // // Ascent: distance from top to bottom of e.g. 'A' [0..FontSize]
+ int MetricsTotalSurface;// // Total surface in pixels to get an idea of the font rasterization/texture cost (not exact, we approximate the cost of padding between glyphs)
+
+ // Methods
+ IMGUI_API ImFont();
+ IMGUI_API ~ImFont();
+ IMGUI_API void Clear();
+ IMGUI_API void BuildLookupTable();
+ IMGUI_API const Glyph* FindGlyph(ImWchar c) const;
+ IMGUI_API void SetFallbackChar(ImWchar c);
+ float GetCharAdvance(ImWchar c) const { return ((int)c < IndexXAdvance.Size) ? IndexXAdvance[(int)c] : FallbackXAdvance; }
+ bool IsLoaded() const { return ContainerAtlas != NULL; }
+
+ // 'max_width' stops rendering after a certain width (could be turned into a 2d size). FLT_MAX to disable.
+ // 'wrap_width' enable automatic word-wrapping across multiple lines to fit into given width. 0.0f to disable.
+ IMGUI_API ImVec2 CalcTextSizeA(float size, float max_width, float wrap_width, const char* text_begin, const char* text_end = NULL, const char** remaining = NULL) const; // utf8
+ IMGUI_API const char* CalcWordWrapPositionA(float scale, const char* text, const char* text_end, float wrap_width) const;
+ IMGUI_API void RenderChar(ImDrawList* draw_list, float size, ImVec2 pos, ImU32 col, unsigned short c) const;
+ IMGUI_API void RenderText(ImDrawList* draw_list, float size, ImVec2 pos, ImU32 col, const ImVec4& clip_rect, const char* text_begin, const char* text_end, float wrap_width = 0.0f, bool cpu_fine_clip = false) const;
+
+ // Private
+ IMGUI_API void GrowIndex(int new_size);
+ IMGUI_API void AddRemapChar(ImWchar dst, ImWchar src, bool overwrite_dst = true); // Makes 'dst' character/glyph points to 'src' character/glyph. Currently needs to be called AFTER fonts have been built.
+};
+
+#if defined(__clang__)
+#pragma clang diagnostic pop
+#endif
+
+// Include imgui_user.h at the end of imgui.h (convenient for user to only explicitly include vanilla imgui.h)
+#ifdef IMGUI_INCLUDE_IMGUI_USER_H
+#include "imgui_user.h"
+#endif
diff --git a/depedencies/include/imgui_internal.h b/depedencies/include/imgui_internal.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..7feaa17
--- /dev/null
+++ b/depedencies/include/imgui_internal.h
@@ -0,0 +1,829 @@
+// dear imgui, v1.52 WIP
+// (internals)
+
+// You may use this file to debug, understand or extend ImGui features but we don't provide any guarantee of forward compatibility!
+// Implement maths operators for ImVec2 (disabled by default to not collide with using IM_VEC2_CLASS_EXTRA along with your own math types+operators)
+// #define IMGUI_DEFINE_MATH_OPERATORS
+// Define IM_PLACEMENT_NEW() macro helper.
+// #define IMGUI_DEFINE_PLACEMENT_NEW
+
+#pragma once
+
+#ifndef IMGUI_VERSION
+#error Must include imgui.h before imgui_internal.h
+#endif
+
+#include <stdio.h> // FILE*
+#include <math.h> // sqrtf, fabsf, fmodf, powf, floorf, ceilf, cosf, sinf
+
+#ifdef _MSC_VER
+#pragma warning (push)
+#pragma warning (disable: 4251) // class 'xxx' needs to have dll-interface to be used by clients of struct 'xxx' // when IMGUI_API is set to__declspec(dllexport)
+#endif
+
+#ifdef __clang__
+#pragma clang diagnostic push
+#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wunused-function" // for stb_textedit.h
+#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wmissing-prototypes" // for stb_textedit.h
+#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wold-style-cast"
+#endif
+
+//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+// Forward Declarations
+//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+struct ImRect;
+struct ImGuiColMod;
+struct ImGuiStyleMod;
+struct ImGuiGroupData;
+struct ImGuiSimpleColumns;
+struct ImGuiDrawContext;
+struct ImGuiTextEditState;
+struct ImGuiIniData;
+struct ImGuiMouseCursorData;
+struct ImGuiPopupRef;
+struct ImGuiWindow;
+
+typedef int ImGuiLayoutType; // enum ImGuiLayoutType_
+typedef int ImGuiButtonFlags; // enum ImGuiButtonFlags_
+typedef int ImGuiTreeNodeFlags; // enum ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_
+typedef int ImGuiSliderFlags; // enum ImGuiSliderFlags_
+
+//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
+// STB libraries
+//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+namespace ImGuiStb
+{
+
+#undef STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING
+#undef STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE
+#define STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING ImGuiTextEditState
+#define STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE ImWchar
+#define STB_TEXTEDIT_GETWIDTH_NEWLINE -1.0f
+#include "stb_textedit.h"
+
+} // namespace ImGuiStb
+
+//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+// Context
+//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+#ifndef GImGui
+extern IMGUI_API ImGuiContext* GImGui; // Current implicit ImGui context pointer
+#endif
+
+//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+// Helpers
+//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+#define IM_ARRAYSIZE(_ARR) ((int)(sizeof(_ARR)/sizeof(*_ARR)))
+#define IM_PI 3.14159265358979323846f
+#define IM_OFFSETOF(_TYPE,_ELM) ((size_t)&(((_TYPE*)0)->_ELM))
+
+// Helpers: UTF-8 <> wchar
+IMGUI_API int ImTextStrToUtf8(char* buf, int buf_size, const ImWchar* in_text, const ImWchar* in_text_end); // return output UTF-8 bytes count
+IMGUI_API int ImTextCharFromUtf8(unsigned int* out_char, const char* in_text, const char* in_text_end); // return input UTF-8 bytes count
+IMGUI_API int ImTextStrFromUtf8(ImWchar* buf, int buf_size, const char* in_text, const char* in_text_end, const char** in_remaining = NULL); // return input UTF-8 bytes count
+IMGUI_API int ImTextCountCharsFromUtf8(const char* in_text, const char* in_text_end); // return number of UTF-8 code-points (NOT bytes count)
+IMGUI_API int ImTextCountUtf8BytesFromStr(const ImWchar* in_text, const ImWchar* in_text_end); // return number of bytes to express string as UTF-8 code-points
+
+// Helpers: Misc
+IMGUI_API ImU32 ImHash(const void* data, int data_size, ImU32 seed = 0); // Pass data_size==0 for zero-terminated strings
+IMGUI_API void* ImFileLoadToMemory(const char* filename, const char* file_open_mode, int* out_file_size = NULL, int padding_bytes = 0);
+IMGUI_API FILE* ImFileOpen(const char* filename, const char* file_open_mode);
+static inline bool ImCharIsSpace(int c) { return c == ' ' || c == '\t' || c == 0x3000; }
+static inline bool ImIsPowerOfTwo(int v) { return v != 0 && (v & (v - 1)) == 0; }
+static inline int ImUpperPowerOfTwo(int v) { v--; v |= v >> 1; v |= v >> 2; v |= v >> 4; v |= v >> 8; v |= v >> 16; v++; return v; }
+
+// Helpers: Geometry
+IMGUI_API ImVec2 ImLineClosestPoint(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& p);
+IMGUI_API bool ImTriangleContainsPoint(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& c, const ImVec2& p);
+IMGUI_API ImVec2 ImTriangleClosestPoint(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& c, const ImVec2& p);
+IMGUI_API void ImTriangleBarycentricCoords(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& c, const ImVec2& p, float& out_u, float& out_v, float& out_w);
+
+// Helpers: String
+IMGUI_API int ImStricmp(const char* str1, const char* str2);
+IMGUI_API int ImStrnicmp(const char* str1, const char* str2, int count);
+IMGUI_API char* ImStrdup(const char* str);
+IMGUI_API int ImStrlenW(const ImWchar* str);
+IMGUI_API const ImWchar*ImStrbolW(const ImWchar* buf_mid_line, const ImWchar* buf_begin); // Find beginning-of-line
+IMGUI_API const char* ImStristr(const char* haystack, const char* haystack_end, const char* needle, const char* needle_end);
+IMGUI_API int ImFormatString(char* buf, int buf_size, const char* fmt, ...) IM_FMTARGS(3);
+IMGUI_API int ImFormatStringV(char* buf, int buf_size, const char* fmt, va_list args) IM_FMTLIST(3);
+
+// Helpers: Math
+// We are keeping those not leaking to the user by default, in the case the user has implicit cast operators between ImVec2 and its own types (when IM_VEC2_CLASS_EXTRA is defined)
+#ifdef IMGUI_DEFINE_MATH_OPERATORS
+static inline ImVec2 operator*(const ImVec2& lhs, const float rhs) { return ImVec2(lhs.x*rhs, lhs.y*rhs); }
+static inline ImVec2 operator/(const ImVec2& lhs, const float rhs) { return ImVec2(lhs.x/rhs, lhs.y/rhs); }
+static inline ImVec2 operator+(const ImVec2& lhs, const ImVec2& rhs) { return ImVec2(lhs.x+rhs.x, lhs.y+rhs.y); }
+static inline ImVec2 operator-(const ImVec2& lhs, const ImVec2& rhs) { return ImVec2(lhs.x-rhs.x, lhs.y-rhs.y); }
+static inline ImVec2 operator*(const ImVec2& lhs, const ImVec2& rhs) { return ImVec2(lhs.x*rhs.x, lhs.y*rhs.y); }
+static inline ImVec2 operator/(const ImVec2& lhs, const ImVec2& rhs) { return ImVec2(lhs.x/rhs.x, lhs.y/rhs.y); }
+static inline ImVec2& operator+=(ImVec2& lhs, const ImVec2& rhs) { lhs.x += rhs.x; lhs.y += rhs.y; return lhs; }
+static inline ImVec2& operator-=(ImVec2& lhs, const ImVec2& rhs) { lhs.x -= rhs.x; lhs.y -= rhs.y; return lhs; }
+static inline ImVec2& operator*=(ImVec2& lhs, const float rhs) { lhs.x *= rhs; lhs.y *= rhs; return lhs; }
+static inline ImVec2& operator/=(ImVec2& lhs, const float rhs) { lhs.x /= rhs; lhs.y /= rhs; return lhs; }
+static inline ImVec4 operator-(const ImVec4& lhs, const ImVec4& rhs) { return ImVec4(lhs.x-rhs.x, lhs.y-rhs.y, lhs.z-rhs.z, lhs.w-rhs.w); }
+#endif
+
+static inline int ImMin(int lhs, int rhs) { return lhs < rhs ? lhs : rhs; }
+static inline int ImMax(int lhs, int rhs) { return lhs >= rhs ? lhs : rhs; }
+static inline float ImMin(float lhs, float rhs) { return lhs < rhs ? lhs : rhs; }
+static inline float ImMax(float lhs, float rhs) { return lhs >= rhs ? lhs : rhs; }
+static inline ImVec2 ImMin(const ImVec2& lhs, const ImVec2& rhs) { return ImVec2(ImMin(lhs.x,rhs.x), ImMin(lhs.y,rhs.y)); }
+static inline ImVec2 ImMax(const ImVec2& lhs, const ImVec2& rhs) { return ImVec2(ImMax(lhs.x,rhs.x), ImMax(lhs.y,rhs.y)); }
+static inline int ImClamp(int v, int mn, int mx) { return (v < mn) ? mn : (v > mx) ? mx : v; }
+static inline float ImClamp(float v, float mn, float mx) { return (v < mn) ? mn : (v > mx) ? mx : v; }
+static inline ImVec2 ImClamp(const ImVec2& f, const ImVec2& mn, ImVec2 mx) { return ImVec2(ImClamp(f.x,mn.x,mx.x), ImClamp(f.y,mn.y,mx.y)); }
+static inline float ImSaturate(float f) { return (f < 0.0f) ? 0.0f : (f > 1.0f) ? 1.0f : f; }
+static inline int ImLerp(int a, int b, float t) { return (int)(a + (b - a) * t); }
+static inline float ImLerp(float a, float b, float t) { return a + (b - a) * t; }
+static inline ImVec2 ImLerp(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, float t) { return ImVec2(a.x + (b.x - a.x) * t, a.y + (b.y - a.y) * t); }
+static inline ImVec2 ImLerp(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& t) { return ImVec2(a.x + (b.x - a.x) * t.x, a.y + (b.y - a.y) * t.y); }
+static inline float ImLengthSqr(const ImVec2& lhs) { return lhs.x*lhs.x + lhs.y*lhs.y; }
+static inline float ImLengthSqr(const ImVec4& lhs) { return lhs.x*lhs.x + lhs.y*lhs.y + lhs.z*lhs.z + lhs.w*lhs.w; }
+static inline float ImInvLength(const ImVec2& lhs, float fail_value) { float d = lhs.x*lhs.x + lhs.y*lhs.y; if (d > 0.0f) return 1.0f / sqrtf(d); return fail_value; }
+static inline float ImFloor(float f) { return (float)(int)f; }
+static inline ImVec2 ImFloor(const ImVec2& v) { return ImVec2((float)(int)v.x, (float)(int)v.y); }
+static inline float ImDot(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b) { return a.x * b.x + a.y * b.y; }
+static inline ImVec2 ImRotate(const ImVec2& v, float cos_a, float sin_a) { return ImVec2(v.x * cos_a - v.y * sin_a, v.x * sin_a + v.y * cos_a); }
+
+// We call C++ constructor on own allocated memory via the placement "new(ptr) Type()" syntax.
+// Defining a custom placement new() with a dummy parameter allows us to bypass including <new> which on some platforms complains when user has disabled exceptions.
+#ifdef IMGUI_DEFINE_PLACEMENT_NEW
+struct ImPlacementNewDummy {};
+inline void* operator new(size_t, ImPlacementNewDummy, void* ptr) { return ptr; }
+inline void operator delete(void*, ImPlacementNewDummy, void*) {}
+#define IM_PLACEMENT_NEW(_PTR) new(ImPlacementNewDummy(), _PTR)
+#endif
+
+//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+// Types
+//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+enum ImGuiButtonFlags_
+{
+ ImGuiButtonFlags_Repeat = 1 << 0, // hold to repeat
+ ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClickRelease = 1 << 1, // (default) return pressed on click+release on same item (default if no PressedOn** flag is set)
+ ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClick = 1 << 2, // return pressed on click (default requires click+release)
+ ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnRelease = 1 << 3, // return pressed on release (default requires click+release)
+ ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnDoubleClick = 1 << 4, // return pressed on double-click (default requires click+release)
+ ImGuiButtonFlags_FlattenChilds = 1 << 5, // allow interaction even if a child window is overlapping
+ ImGuiButtonFlags_DontClosePopups = 1 << 6, // disable automatically closing parent popup on press
+ ImGuiButtonFlags_Disabled = 1 << 7, // disable interaction
+ ImGuiButtonFlags_AlignTextBaseLine = 1 << 8, // vertically align button to match text baseline - ButtonEx() only
+ ImGuiButtonFlags_NoKeyModifiers = 1 << 9, // disable interaction if a key modifier is held
+ ImGuiButtonFlags_AllowOverlapMode = 1 << 10 // require previous frame HoveredId to either match id or be null before being usable
+};
+
+enum ImGuiSliderFlags_
+{
+ ImGuiSliderFlags_Vertical = 1 << 0
+};
+
+enum ImGuiColumnsFlags_
+{
+ // Default: 0
+ ImGuiColumnsFlags_NoBorder = 1 << 0, // Disable column dividers
+ ImGuiColumnsFlags_NoResize = 1 << 1, // Disable resizing columns when clicking on the dividers
+ ImGuiColumnsFlags_NoPreserveWidths = 1 << 2, // Disable column width preservation when adjusting columns
+ ImGuiColumnsFlags_NoForceWithinWindow = 1 << 3 // Disable forcing columns to fit within window
+};
+
+enum ImGuiSelectableFlagsPrivate_
+{
+ // NB: need to be in sync with last value of ImGuiSelectableFlags_
+ ImGuiSelectableFlags_Menu = 1 << 3,
+ ImGuiSelectableFlags_MenuItem = 1 << 4,
+ ImGuiSelectableFlags_Disabled = 1 << 5,
+ ImGuiSelectableFlags_DrawFillAvailWidth = 1 << 6
+};
+
+// FIXME: this is in development, not exposed/functional as a generic feature yet.
+enum ImGuiLayoutType_
+{
+ ImGuiLayoutType_Vertical,
+ ImGuiLayoutType_Horizontal
+};
+
+enum ImGuiPlotType
+{
+ ImGuiPlotType_Lines,
+ ImGuiPlotType_Histogram
+};
+
+enum ImGuiDataType
+{
+ ImGuiDataType_Int,
+ ImGuiDataType_Float,
+ ImGuiDataType_Float2,
+};
+
+enum ImGuiDir
+{
+ ImGuiDir_None = -1,
+ ImGuiDir_Left = 0,
+ ImGuiDir_Right = 1,
+ ImGuiDir_Up = 2,
+ ImGuiDir_Down = 3,
+};
+
+enum ImGuiCorner
+{
+ ImGuiCorner_TopLeft = 1 << 0, // 1
+ ImGuiCorner_TopRight = 1 << 1, // 2
+ ImGuiCorner_BottomRight = 1 << 2, // 4
+ ImGuiCorner_BottomLeft = 1 << 3, // 8
+ ImGuiCorner_All = 0x0F
+};
+
+// 2D axis aligned bounding-box
+// NB: we can't rely on ImVec2 math operators being available here
+struct IMGUI_API ImRect
+{
+ ImVec2 Min; // Upper-left
+ ImVec2 Max; // Lower-right
+
+ ImRect() : Min(FLT_MAX,FLT_MAX), Max(-FLT_MAX,-FLT_MAX) {}
+ ImRect(const ImVec2& min, const ImVec2& max) : Min(min), Max(max) {}
+ ImRect(const ImVec4& v) : Min(v.x, v.y), Max(v.z, v.w) {}
+ ImRect(float x1, float y1, float x2, float y2) : Min(x1, y1), Max(x2, y2) {}
+
+ ImVec2 GetCenter() const { return ImVec2((Min.x+Max.x)*0.5f, (Min.y+Max.y)*0.5f); }
+ ImVec2 GetSize() const { return ImVec2(Max.x-Min.x, Max.y-Min.y); }
+ float GetWidth() const { return Max.x-Min.x; }
+ float GetHeight() const { return Max.y-Min.y; }
+ ImVec2 GetTL() const { return Min; } // Top-left
+ ImVec2 GetTR() const { return ImVec2(Max.x, Min.y); } // Top-right
+ ImVec2 GetBL() const { return ImVec2(Min.x, Max.y); } // Bottom-left
+ ImVec2 GetBR() const { return Max; } // Bottom-right
+ bool Contains(const ImVec2& p) const { return p.x >= Min.x && p.y >= Min.y && p.x < Max.x && p.y < Max.y; }
+ bool Contains(const ImRect& r) const { return r.Min.x >= Min.x && r.Min.y >= Min.y && r.Max.x < Max.x && r.Max.y < Max.y; }
+ bool Overlaps(const ImRect& r) const { return r.Min.y < Max.y && r.Max.y > Min.y && r.Min.x < Max.x && r.Max.x > Min.x; }
+ void Add(const ImVec2& rhs) { if (Min.x > rhs.x) Min.x = rhs.x; if (Min.y > rhs.y) Min.y = rhs.y; if (Max.x < rhs.x) Max.x = rhs.x; if (Max.y < rhs.y) Max.y = rhs.y; }
+ void Add(const ImRect& rhs) { if (Min.x > rhs.Min.x) Min.x = rhs.Min.x; if (Min.y > rhs.Min.y) Min.y = rhs.Min.y; if (Max.x < rhs.Max.x) Max.x = rhs.Max.x; if (Max.y < rhs.Max.y) Max.y = rhs.Max.y; }
+ void Expand(const float amount) { Min.x -= amount; Min.y -= amount; Max.x += amount; Max.y += amount; }
+ void Expand(const ImVec2& amount) { Min.x -= amount.x; Min.y -= amount.y; Max.x += amount.x; Max.y += amount.y; }
+ void Translate(const ImVec2& v) { Min.x += v.x; Min.y += v.y; Max.x += v.x; Max.y += v.y; }
+ void ClipWith(const ImRect& clip) { if (Min.x < clip.Min.x) Min.x = clip.Min.x; if (Min.y < clip.Min.y) Min.y = clip.Min.y; if (Max.x > clip.Max.x) Max.x = clip.Max.x; if (Max.y > clip.Max.y) Max.y = clip.Max.y; }
+ void Floor() { Min.x = (float)(int)Min.x; Min.y = (float)(int)Min.y; Max.x = (float)(int)Max.x; Max.y = (float)(int)Max.y; }
+ ImVec2 GetClosestPoint(ImVec2 p, bool on_edge) const
+ {
+ if (!on_edge && Contains(p))
+ return p;
+ if (p.x > Max.x) p.x = Max.x;
+ else if (p.x < Min.x) p.x = Min.x;
+ if (p.y > Max.y) p.y = Max.y;
+ else if (p.y < Min.y) p.y = Min.y;
+ return p;
+ }
+};
+
+// Stacked color modifier, backup of modified data so we can restore it
+struct ImGuiColMod
+{
+ ImGuiCol Col;
+ ImVec4 BackupValue;
+};
+
+// Stacked style modifier, backup of modified data so we can restore it. Data type inferred from the variable.
+struct ImGuiStyleMod
+{
+ ImGuiStyleVar VarIdx;
+ union { int BackupInt[2]; float BackupFloat[2]; };
+ ImGuiStyleMod(ImGuiStyleVar idx, int v) { VarIdx = idx; BackupInt[0] = v; }
+ ImGuiStyleMod(ImGuiStyleVar idx, float v) { VarIdx = idx; BackupFloat[0] = v; }
+ ImGuiStyleMod(ImGuiStyleVar idx, ImVec2 v) { VarIdx = idx; BackupFloat[0] = v.x; BackupFloat[1] = v.y; }
+};
+
+// Stacked data for BeginGroup()/EndGroup()
+struct ImGuiGroupData
+{
+ ImVec2 BackupCursorPos;
+ ImVec2 BackupCursorMaxPos;
+ float BackupIndentX;
+ float BackupGroupOffsetX;
+ float BackupCurrentLineHeight;
+ float BackupCurrentLineTextBaseOffset;
+ float BackupLogLinePosY;
+ bool BackupActiveIdIsAlive;
+ bool AdvanceCursor;
+};
+
+// Per column data for Columns()
+struct ImGuiColumnData
+{
+ float OffsetNorm; // Column start offset, normalized 0.0 (far left) -> 1.0 (far right)
+ ImRect ClipRect;
+ //float IndentX;
+};
+
+// Simple column measurement currently used for MenuItem() only. This is very short-sighted/throw-away code and NOT a generic helper.
+struct IMGUI_API ImGuiSimpleColumns
+{
+ int Count;
+ float Spacing;
+ float Width, NextWidth;
+ float Pos[8], NextWidths[8];
+
+ ImGuiSimpleColumns();
+ void Update(int count, float spacing, bool clear);
+ float DeclColumns(float w0, float w1, float w2);
+ float CalcExtraSpace(float avail_w);
+};
+
+// Internal state of the currently focused/edited text input box
+struct IMGUI_API ImGuiTextEditState
+{
+ ImGuiID Id; // widget id owning the text state
+ ImVector<ImWchar> Text; // edit buffer, we need to persist but can't guarantee the persistence of the user-provided buffer. so we copy into own buffer.
+ ImVector<char> InitialText; // backup of end-user buffer at the time of focus (in UTF-8, unaltered)
+ ImVector<char> TempTextBuffer;
+ int CurLenA, CurLenW; // we need to maintain our buffer length in both UTF-8 and wchar format.
+ int BufSizeA; // end-user buffer size
+ float ScrollX;
+ ImGuiStb::STB_TexteditState StbState;
+ float CursorAnim;
+ bool CursorFollow;
+ bool SelectedAllMouseLock;
+
+ ImGuiTextEditState() { memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); }
+ void CursorAnimReset() { CursorAnim = -0.30f; } // After a user-input the cursor stays on for a while without blinking
+ void CursorClamp() { StbState.cursor = ImMin(StbState.cursor, CurLenW); StbState.select_start = ImMin(StbState.select_start, CurLenW); StbState.select_end = ImMin(StbState.select_end, CurLenW); }
+ bool HasSelection() const { return StbState.select_start != StbState.select_end; }
+ void ClearSelection() { StbState.select_start = StbState.select_end = StbState.cursor; }
+ void SelectAll() { StbState.select_start = 0; StbState.select_end = CurLenW; StbState.cursor = StbState.select_end; StbState.has_preferred_x = false; }
+ void OnKeyPressed(int key);
+};
+
+// Data saved in imgui.ini file
+struct ImGuiIniData
+{
+ char* Name;
+ ImGuiID Id;
+ ImVec2 Pos;
+ ImVec2 Size;
+ bool Collapsed;
+};
+
+// Mouse cursor data (used when io.MouseDrawCursor is set)
+struct ImGuiMouseCursorData
+{
+ ImGuiMouseCursor Type;
+ ImVec2 HotOffset;
+ ImVec2 Size;
+ ImVec2 TexUvMin[2];
+ ImVec2 TexUvMax[2];
+};
+
+// Storage for current popup stack
+struct ImGuiPopupRef
+{
+ ImGuiID PopupId; // Set on OpenPopup()
+ ImGuiWindow* Window; // Resolved on BeginPopup() - may stay unresolved if user never calls OpenPopup()
+ ImGuiWindow* ParentWindow; // Set on OpenPopup()
+ ImGuiID ParentMenuSet; // Set on OpenPopup()
+ ImVec2 MousePosOnOpen; // Copy of mouse position at the time of opening popup
+
+ ImGuiPopupRef(ImGuiID id, ImGuiWindow* parent_window, ImGuiID parent_menu_set, const ImVec2& mouse_pos) { PopupId = id; Window = NULL; ParentWindow = parent_window; ParentMenuSet = parent_menu_set; MousePosOnOpen = mouse_pos; }
+};
+
+// Main state for ImGui
+struct ImGuiContext
+{
+ bool Initialized;
+ ImGuiIO IO;
+ ImGuiStyle Style;
+ ImFont* Font; // (Shortcut) == FontStack.empty() ? IO.Font : FontStack.back()
+ float FontSize; // (Shortcut) == FontBaseSize * g.CurrentWindow->FontWindowScale == window->FontSize(). Text height for current window.
+ float FontBaseSize; // (Shortcut) == IO.FontGlobalScale * Font->Scale * Font->FontSize. Base text height.
+ ImVec2 FontTexUvWhitePixel; // (Shortcut) == Font->TexUvWhitePixel
+
+ float Time;
+ int FrameCount;
+ int FrameCountEnded;
+ int FrameCountRendered;
+ ImVector<ImGuiWindow*> Windows;
+ ImVector<ImGuiWindow*> WindowsSortBuffer;
+ ImVector<ImGuiWindow*> CurrentWindowStack;
+ ImGuiWindow* CurrentWindow; // Being drawn into
+ ImGuiWindow* NavWindow; // Nav/focused window for navigation
+ ImGuiWindow* HoveredWindow; // Will catch mouse inputs
+ ImGuiWindow* HoveredRootWindow; // Will catch mouse inputs (for focus/move only)
+ ImGuiID HoveredId; // Hovered widget
+ bool HoveredIdAllowOverlap;
+ ImGuiID HoveredIdPreviousFrame;
+ ImGuiID ActiveId; // Active widget
+ ImGuiID ActiveIdPreviousFrame;
+ bool ActiveIdIsAlive; // Active widget has been seen this frame
+ bool ActiveIdIsJustActivated; // Set at the time of activation for one frame
+ bool ActiveIdAllowOverlap; // Active widget allows another widget to steal active id (generally for overlapping widgets, but not always)
+
+ ImVec2 ActiveIdClickOffset; // Clicked offset from upper-left corner, if applicable (currently only set by ButtonBehavior)
+ ImGuiWindow* ActiveIdWindow;
+ ImGuiWindow* MovedWindow; // Track the child window we clicked on to move a window.
+ ImGuiID MovedWindowMoveId; // == MovedWindow->RootWindow->MoveId
+ ImVector<ImGuiIniData> Settings; // .ini Settings
+ float SettingsDirtyTimer; // Save .ini Settings on disk when time reaches zero
+ ImVector<ImGuiColMod> ColorModifiers; // Stack for PushStyleColor()/PopStyleColor()
+ ImVector<ImGuiStyleMod> StyleModifiers; // Stack for PushStyleVar()/PopStyleVar()
+ ImVector<ImFont*> FontStack; // Stack for PushFont()/PopFont()
+ ImVector<ImGuiPopupRef> OpenPopupStack; // Which popups are open (persistent)
+ ImVector<ImGuiPopupRef> CurrentPopupStack; // Which level of BeginPopup() we are in (reset every frame)
+
+ // Storage for SetNexWindow** and SetNextTreeNode*** functions
+ ImVec2 SetNextWindowPosVal;
+ ImVec2 SetNextWindowSizeVal;
+ ImVec2 SetNextWindowContentSizeVal;
+ bool SetNextWindowCollapsedVal;
+ ImGuiCond SetNextWindowPosCond;
+ ImGuiCond SetNextWindowSizeCond;
+ ImGuiCond SetNextWindowContentSizeCond;
+ ImGuiCond SetNextWindowCollapsedCond;
+ ImRect SetNextWindowSizeConstraintRect; // Valid if 'SetNextWindowSizeConstraint' is true
+ ImGuiSizeConstraintCallback SetNextWindowSizeConstraintCallback;
+ void* SetNextWindowSizeConstraintCallbackUserData;
+ bool SetNextWindowSizeConstraint;
+ bool SetNextWindowFocus;
+ bool SetNextTreeNodeOpenVal;
+ ImGuiCond SetNextTreeNodeOpenCond;
+
+ // Render
+ ImDrawData RenderDrawData; // Main ImDrawData instance to pass render information to the user
+ ImVector<ImDrawList*> RenderDrawLists[3];
+ float ModalWindowDarkeningRatio;
+ ImDrawList OverlayDrawList; // Optional software render of mouse cursors, if io.MouseDrawCursor is set + a few debug overlays
+ ImGuiMouseCursor MouseCursor;
+ ImGuiMouseCursorData MouseCursorData[ImGuiMouseCursor_Count_];
+
+ // Widget state
+ ImGuiTextEditState InputTextState;
+ ImFont InputTextPasswordFont;
+ ImGuiID ScalarAsInputTextId; // Temporary text input when CTRL+clicking on a slider, etc.
+ ImGuiColorEditFlags ColorEditOptions; // Store user options for color edit widgets
+ ImVec4 ColorPickerRef;
+ float DragCurrentValue; // Currently dragged value, always float, not rounded by end-user precision settings
+ ImVec2 DragLastMouseDelta;
+ float DragSpeedDefaultRatio; // If speed == 0.0f, uses (max-min) * DragSpeedDefaultRatio
+ float DragSpeedScaleSlow;
+ float DragSpeedScaleFast;
+ ImVec2 ScrollbarClickDeltaToGrabCenter; // Distance between mouse and center of grab box, normalized in parent space. Use storage?
+ int TooltipOverrideCount;
+ ImVector<char> PrivateClipboard; // If no custom clipboard handler is defined
+ ImVec2 OsImePosRequest, OsImePosSet; // Cursor position request & last passed to the OS Input Method Editor
+
+ // Logging
+ bool LogEnabled;
+ FILE* LogFile; // If != NULL log to stdout/ file
+ ImGuiTextBuffer* LogClipboard; // Else log to clipboard. This is pointer so our GImGui static constructor doesn't call heap allocators.
+ int LogStartDepth;
+ int LogAutoExpandMaxDepth;
+
+ // Misc
+ float FramerateSecPerFrame[120]; // calculate estimate of framerate for user
+ int FramerateSecPerFrameIdx;
+ float FramerateSecPerFrameAccum;
+ int CaptureMouseNextFrame; // explicit capture via CaptureInputs() sets those flags
+ int CaptureKeyboardNextFrame;
+ char TempBuffer[1024*3+1]; // temporary text buffer
+
+ ImGuiContext()
+ {
+ Initialized = false;
+ Font = NULL;
+ FontSize = FontBaseSize = 0.0f;
+ FontTexUvWhitePixel = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f);
+
+ Time = 0.0f;
+ FrameCount = 0;
+ FrameCountEnded = FrameCountRendered = -1;
+ CurrentWindow = NULL;
+ NavWindow = NULL;
+ HoveredWindow = NULL;
+ HoveredRootWindow = NULL;
+ HoveredId = 0;
+ HoveredIdAllowOverlap = false;
+ HoveredIdPreviousFrame = 0;
+ ActiveId = 0;
+ ActiveIdPreviousFrame = 0;
+ ActiveIdIsAlive = false;
+ ActiveIdIsJustActivated = false;
+ ActiveIdAllowOverlap = false;
+ ActiveIdClickOffset = ImVec2(-1,-1);
+ ActiveIdWindow = NULL;
+ MovedWindow = NULL;
+ MovedWindowMoveId = 0;
+ SettingsDirtyTimer = 0.0f;
+
+ SetNextWindowPosVal = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f);
+ SetNextWindowSizeVal = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f);
+ SetNextWindowCollapsedVal = false;
+ SetNextWindowPosCond = 0;
+ SetNextWindowSizeCond = 0;
+ SetNextWindowContentSizeCond = 0;
+ SetNextWindowCollapsedCond = 0;
+ SetNextWindowSizeConstraintRect = ImRect();
+ SetNextWindowSizeConstraintCallback = NULL;
+ SetNextWindowSizeConstraintCallbackUserData = NULL;
+ SetNextWindowSizeConstraint = false;
+ SetNextWindowFocus = false;
+ SetNextTreeNodeOpenVal = false;
+ SetNextTreeNodeOpenCond = 0;
+
+ ScalarAsInputTextId = 0;
+ ColorEditOptions = ImGuiColorEditFlags__OptionsDefault;
+ DragCurrentValue = 0.0f;
+ DragLastMouseDelta = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f);
+ DragSpeedDefaultRatio = 1.0f / 100.0f;
+ DragSpeedScaleSlow = 0.01f;
+ DragSpeedScaleFast = 10.0f;
+ ScrollbarClickDeltaToGrabCenter = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f);
+ TooltipOverrideCount = 0;
+ OsImePosRequest = OsImePosSet = ImVec2(-1.0f, -1.0f);
+
+ ModalWindowDarkeningRatio = 0.0f;
+ OverlayDrawList._OwnerName = "##Overlay"; // Give it a name for debugging
+ MouseCursor = ImGuiMouseCursor_Arrow;
+ memset(MouseCursorData, 0, sizeof(MouseCursorData));
+
+ LogEnabled = false;
+ LogFile = NULL;
+ LogClipboard = NULL;
+ LogStartDepth = 0;
+ LogAutoExpandMaxDepth = 2;
+
+ memset(FramerateSecPerFrame, 0, sizeof(FramerateSecPerFrame));
+ FramerateSecPerFrameIdx = 0;
+ FramerateSecPerFrameAccum = 0.0f;
+ CaptureMouseNextFrame = CaptureKeyboardNextFrame = -1;
+ memset(TempBuffer, 0, sizeof(TempBuffer));
+ }
+};
+
+// Transient per-window data, reset at the beginning of the frame
+// FIXME: That's theory, in practice the delimitation between ImGuiWindow and ImGuiDrawContext is quite tenuous and could be reconsidered.
+struct IMGUI_API ImGuiDrawContext
+{
+ ImVec2 CursorPos;
+ ImVec2 CursorPosPrevLine;
+ ImVec2 CursorStartPos;
+ ImVec2 CursorMaxPos; // Implicitly calculate the size of our contents, always extending. Saved into window->SizeContents at the end of the frame
+ float CurrentLineHeight;
+ float CurrentLineTextBaseOffset;
+ float PrevLineHeight;
+ float PrevLineTextBaseOffset;
+ float LogLinePosY;
+ int TreeDepth;
+ ImGuiID LastItemId;
+ ImRect LastItemRect;
+ bool LastItemHoveredAndUsable; // Item rectangle is hovered, and its window is currently interactable with (not blocked by a popup preventing access to the window)
+ bool LastItemHoveredRect; // Item rectangle is hovered, but its window may or not be currently interactable with (might be blocked by a popup preventing access to the window)
+ bool MenuBarAppending;
+ float MenuBarOffsetX;
+ ImVector<ImGuiWindow*> ChildWindows;
+ ImGuiStorage* StateStorage;
+ ImGuiLayoutType LayoutType;
+
+ // We store the current settings outside of the vectors to increase memory locality (reduce cache misses). The vectors are rarely modified. Also it allows us to not heap allocate for short-lived windows which are not using those settings.
+ float ItemWidth; // == ItemWidthStack.back(). 0.0: default, >0.0: width in pixels, <0.0: align xx pixels to the right of window
+ float TextWrapPos; // == TextWrapPosStack.back() [empty == -1.0f]
+ bool AllowKeyboardFocus; // == AllowKeyboardFocusStack.back() [empty == true]
+ bool ButtonRepeat; // == ButtonRepeatStack.back() [empty == false]
+ ImVector<float> ItemWidthStack;
+ ImVector<float> TextWrapPosStack;
+ ImVector<bool> AllowKeyboardFocusStack;
+ ImVector<bool> ButtonRepeatStack;
+ ImVector<ImGuiGroupData>GroupStack;
+ int StackSizesBackup[6]; // Store size of various stacks for asserting
+
+ float IndentX; // Indentation / start position from left of window (increased by TreePush/TreePop, etc.)
+ float GroupOffsetX;
+ float ColumnsOffsetX; // Offset to the current column (if ColumnsCurrent > 0). FIXME: This and the above should be a stack to allow use cases like Tree->Column->Tree. Need revamp columns API.
+ int ColumnsCurrent;
+ int ColumnsCount;
+ float ColumnsMinX;
+ float ColumnsMaxX;
+ float ColumnsStartPosY;
+ float ColumnsStartMaxPosX; // Backup of CursorMaxPos
+ float ColumnsCellMinY;
+ float ColumnsCellMaxY;
+ ImGuiColumnsFlags ColumnsFlags;
+ ImGuiID ColumnsSetId;
+ ImVector<ImGuiColumnData> ColumnsData;
+
+ ImGuiDrawContext()
+ {
+ CursorPos = CursorPosPrevLine = CursorStartPos = CursorMaxPos = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f);
+ CurrentLineHeight = PrevLineHeight = 0.0f;
+ CurrentLineTextBaseOffset = PrevLineTextBaseOffset = 0.0f;
+ LogLinePosY = -1.0f;
+ TreeDepth = 0;
+ LastItemId = 0;
+ LastItemRect = ImRect(0.0f,0.0f,0.0f,0.0f);
+ LastItemHoveredAndUsable = LastItemHoveredRect = false;
+ MenuBarAppending = false;
+ MenuBarOffsetX = 0.0f;
+ StateStorage = NULL;
+ LayoutType = ImGuiLayoutType_Vertical;
+ ItemWidth = 0.0f;
+ ButtonRepeat = false;
+ AllowKeyboardFocus = true;
+ TextWrapPos = -1.0f;
+ memset(StackSizesBackup, 0, sizeof(StackSizesBackup));
+
+ IndentX = 0.0f;
+ GroupOffsetX = 0.0f;
+ ColumnsOffsetX = 0.0f;
+ ColumnsCurrent = 0;
+ ColumnsCount = 1;
+ ColumnsMinX = ColumnsMaxX = 0.0f;
+ ColumnsStartPosY = 0.0f;
+ ColumnsStartMaxPosX = 0.0f;
+ ColumnsCellMinY = ColumnsCellMaxY = 0.0f;
+ ColumnsFlags = 0;
+ ColumnsSetId = 0;
+ }
+};
+
+// Windows data
+struct IMGUI_API ImGuiWindow
+{
+ char* Name;
+ ImGuiID ID; // == ImHash(Name)
+ ImGuiWindowFlags Flags; // See enum ImGuiWindowFlags_
+ int OrderWithinParent; // Order within immediate parent window, if we are a child window. Otherwise 0.
+ ImVec2 PosFloat;
+ ImVec2 Pos; // Position rounded-up to nearest pixel
+ ImVec2 Size; // Current size (==SizeFull or collapsed title bar size)
+ ImVec2 SizeFull; // Size when non collapsed
+ ImVec2 SizeContents; // Size of contents (== extents reach of the drawing cursor) from previous frame
+ ImVec2 SizeContentsExplicit; // Size of contents explicitly set by the user via SetNextWindowContentSize()
+ ImRect ContentsRegionRect; // Maximum visible content position in window coordinates. ~~ (SizeContentsExplicit ? SizeContentsExplicit : Size - ScrollbarSizes) - CursorStartPos, per axis
+ ImVec2 WindowPadding; // Window padding at the time of begin. We need to lock it, in particular manipulation of the ShowBorder would have an effect
+ ImGuiID MoveId; // == window->GetID("#MOVE")
+ ImVec2 Scroll;
+ ImVec2 ScrollTarget; // target scroll position. stored as cursor position with scrolling canceled out, so the highest point is always 0.0f. (FLT_MAX for no change)
+ ImVec2 ScrollTargetCenterRatio; // 0.0f = scroll so that target position is at top, 0.5f = scroll so that target position is centered
+ bool ScrollbarX, ScrollbarY;
+ ImVec2 ScrollbarSizes;
+ float BorderSize;
+ bool Active; // Set to true on Begin()
+ bool WasActive;
+ bool Accessed; // Set to true when any widget access the current window
+ bool Collapsed; // Set when collapsing window to become only title-bar
+ bool SkipItems; // == Visible && !Collapsed
+ int BeginCount; // Number of Begin() during the current frame (generally 0 or 1, 1+ if appending via multiple Begin/End pairs)
+ ImGuiID PopupId; // ID in the popup stack when this window is used as a popup/menu (because we use generic Name/ID for recycling)
+ int AutoFitFramesX, AutoFitFramesY;
+ bool AutoFitOnlyGrows;
+ int AutoFitChildAxises;
+ int AutoPosLastDirection;
+ int HiddenFrames;
+ ImGuiCond SetWindowPosAllowFlags; // store condition flags for next SetWindowPos() call.
+ ImGuiCond SetWindowSizeAllowFlags; // store condition flags for next SetWindowSize() call.
+ ImGuiCond SetWindowCollapsedAllowFlags; // store condition flags for next SetWindowCollapsed() call.
+ bool SetWindowPosCenterWanted;
+
+ ImGuiDrawContext DC; // Temporary per-window data, reset at the beginning of the frame
+ ImVector<ImGuiID> IDStack; // ID stack. ID are hashes seeded with the value at the top of the stack
+ ImRect ClipRect; // = DrawList->clip_rect_stack.back(). Scissoring / clipping rectangle. x1, y1, x2, y2.
+ ImRect WindowRectClipped; // = WindowRect just after setup in Begin(). == window->Rect() for root window.
+ int LastFrameActive;
+ float ItemWidthDefault;
+ ImGuiSimpleColumns MenuColumns; // Simplified columns storage for menu items
+ ImGuiStorage StateStorage;
+ float FontWindowScale; // Scale multiplier per-window
+ ImDrawList* DrawList;
+ ImGuiWindow* RootWindow; // If we are a child window, this is pointing to the first non-child parent window. Else point to ourself.
+ ImGuiWindow* RootNonPopupWindow; // If we are a child window, this is pointing to the first non-child non-popup parent window. Else point to ourself.
+ ImGuiWindow* ParentWindow; // If we are a child window, this is pointing to our parent window. Else point to NULL.
+
+ // Navigation / Focus
+ int FocusIdxAllCounter; // Start at -1 and increase as assigned via FocusItemRegister()
+ int FocusIdxTabCounter; // (same, but only count widgets which you can Tab through)
+ int FocusIdxAllRequestCurrent; // Item being requested for focus
+ int FocusIdxTabRequestCurrent; // Tab-able item being requested for focus
+ int FocusIdxAllRequestNext; // Item being requested for focus, for next update (relies on layout to be stable between the frame pressing TAB and the next frame)
+ int FocusIdxTabRequestNext; // "
+
+public:
+ ImGuiWindow(const char* name);
+ ~ImGuiWindow();
+
+ ImGuiID GetID(const char* str, const char* str_end = NULL);
+ ImGuiID GetID(const void* ptr);
+ ImGuiID GetIDNoKeepAlive(const char* str, const char* str_end = NULL);
+
+ ImRect Rect() const { return ImRect(Pos.x, Pos.y, Pos.x+Size.x, Pos.y+Size.y); }
+ float CalcFontSize() const { return GImGui->FontBaseSize * FontWindowScale; }
+ float TitleBarHeight() const { return (Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar) ? 0.0f : CalcFontSize() + GImGui->Style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f; }
+ ImRect TitleBarRect() const { return ImRect(Pos, ImVec2(Pos.x + SizeFull.x, Pos.y + TitleBarHeight())); }
+ float MenuBarHeight() const { return (Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar) ? CalcFontSize() + GImGui->Style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f : 0.0f; }
+ ImRect MenuBarRect() const { float y1 = Pos.y + TitleBarHeight(); return ImRect(Pos.x, y1, Pos.x + SizeFull.x, y1 + MenuBarHeight()); }
+};
+
+//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+// Internal API
+// No guarantee of forward compatibility here.
+//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+namespace ImGui
+{
+ // We should always have a CurrentWindow in the stack (there is an implicit "Debug" window)
+ // If this ever crash because g.CurrentWindow is NULL it means that either
+ // - ImGui::NewFrame() has never been called, which is illegal.
+ // - You are calling ImGui functions after ImGui::Render() and before the next ImGui::NewFrame(), which is also illegal.
+ inline ImGuiWindow* GetCurrentWindowRead() { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; return g.CurrentWindow; }
+ inline ImGuiWindow* GetCurrentWindow() { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; g.CurrentWindow->Accessed = true; return g.CurrentWindow; }
+ IMGUI_API ImGuiWindow* GetParentWindow();
+ IMGUI_API ImGuiWindow* FindWindowByName(const char* name);
+ IMGUI_API void FocusWindow(ImGuiWindow* window);
+
+ IMGUI_API void Initialize();
+ IMGUI_API void EndFrame(); // Ends the ImGui frame. Automatically called by Render()! you most likely don't need to ever call that yourself directly. If you don't need to render you can call EndFrame() but you'll have wasted CPU already. If you don't need to render, don't create any windows instead!
+
+ IMGUI_API void SetActiveID(ImGuiID id, ImGuiWindow* window);
+ IMGUI_API void ClearActiveID();
+ IMGUI_API void SetHoveredID(ImGuiID id);
+ IMGUI_API void KeepAliveID(ImGuiID id);
+
+ IMGUI_API void ItemSize(const ImVec2& size, float text_offset_y = 0.0f);
+ IMGUI_API void ItemSize(const ImRect& bb, float text_offset_y = 0.0f);
+ IMGUI_API bool ItemAdd(const ImRect& bb, const ImGuiID* id);
+ IMGUI_API bool IsClippedEx(const ImRect& bb, const ImGuiID* id, bool clip_even_when_logged);
+ IMGUI_API bool IsHovered(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, bool flatten_childs = false);
+ IMGUI_API bool FocusableItemRegister(ImGuiWindow* window, bool is_active, bool tab_stop = true); // Return true if focus is requested
+ IMGUI_API void FocusableItemUnregister(ImGuiWindow* window);
+ IMGUI_API ImVec2 CalcItemSize(ImVec2 size, float default_x, float default_y);
+ IMGUI_API float CalcWrapWidthForPos(const ImVec2& pos, float wrap_pos_x);
+
+ IMGUI_API void OpenPopupEx(ImGuiID id, bool reopen_existing);
+ IMGUI_API bool IsPopupOpen(ImGuiID id);
+
+ // New Columns API
+ IMGUI_API void BeginColumns(const char* id, int count, ImGuiColumnsFlags flags = 0); // setup number of columns. use an identifier to distinguish multiple column sets. close with EndColumns().
+ IMGUI_API void EndColumns(); // close columns
+ IMGUI_API void PushColumnClipRect(int column_index = -1);
+
+ // NB: All position are in absolute pixels coordinates (never using window coordinates internally)
+ // AVOID USING OUTSIDE OF IMGUI.CPP! NOT FOR PUBLIC CONSUMPTION. THOSE FUNCTIONS ARE A MESS. THEIR SIGNATURE AND BEHAVIOR WILL CHANGE, THEY NEED TO BE REFACTORED INTO SOMETHING DECENT.
+ IMGUI_API void RenderText(ImVec2 pos, const char* text, const char* text_end = NULL, bool hide_text_after_hash = true);
+ IMGUI_API void RenderTextWrapped(ImVec2 pos, const char* text, const char* text_end, float wrap_width);
+ IMGUI_API void RenderTextClipped(const ImVec2& pos_min, const ImVec2& pos_max, const char* text, const char* text_end, const ImVec2* text_size_if_known, const ImVec2& align = ImVec2(0,0), const ImRect* clip_rect = NULL);
+ IMGUI_API void RenderFrame(ImVec2 p_min, ImVec2 p_max, ImU32 fill_col, bool border = true, float rounding = 0.0f);
+ IMGUI_API void RenderFrameBorder(ImVec2 p_min, ImVec2 p_max, float rounding = 0.0f);
+ IMGUI_API void RenderColorRectWithAlphaCheckerboard(ImVec2 p_min, ImVec2 p_max, ImU32 fill_col, float grid_step, ImVec2 grid_off, float rounding = 0.0f, int rounding_corners_flags = ~0);
+ IMGUI_API void RenderCollapseTriangle(ImVec2 pos, bool is_open, float scale = 1.0f);
+ IMGUI_API void RenderBullet(ImVec2 pos);
+ IMGUI_API void RenderCheckMark(ImVec2 pos, ImU32 col);
+ IMGUI_API const char* FindRenderedTextEnd(const char* text, const char* text_end = NULL); // Find the optional ## from which we stop displaying text.
+
+ IMGUI_API bool ButtonBehavior(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, bool* out_hovered, bool* out_held, ImGuiButtonFlags flags = 0);
+ IMGUI_API bool ButtonEx(const char* label, const ImVec2& size_arg = ImVec2(0,0), ImGuiButtonFlags flags = 0);
+ IMGUI_API bool CloseButton(ImGuiID id, const ImVec2& pos, float radius);
+
+ IMGUI_API bool SliderBehavior(const ImRect& frame_bb, ImGuiID id, float* v, float v_min, float v_max, float power, int decimal_precision, ImGuiSliderFlags flags = 0);
+ IMGUI_API bool SliderFloatN(const char* label, float* v, int components, float v_min, float v_max, const char* display_format, float power);
+ IMGUI_API bool SliderIntN(const char* label, int* v, int components, int v_min, int v_max, const char* display_format);
+
+ IMGUI_API bool DragBehavior(const ImRect& frame_bb, ImGuiID id, float* v, float v_speed, float v_min, float v_max, int decimal_precision, float power);
+ IMGUI_API bool DragFloatN(const char* label, float* v, int components, float v_speed, float v_min, float v_max, const char* display_format, float power);
+ IMGUI_API bool DragIntN(const char* label, int* v, int components, float v_speed, int v_min, int v_max, const char* display_format);
+
+ IMGUI_API bool InputTextEx(const char* label, char* buf, int buf_size, const ImVec2& size_arg, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags, ImGuiTextEditCallback callback = NULL, void* user_data = NULL);
+ IMGUI_API bool InputFloatN(const char* label, float* v, int components, int decimal_precision, ImGuiInputTextFlags extra_flags);
+ IMGUI_API bool InputIntN(const char* label, int* v, int components, ImGuiInputTextFlags extra_flags);
+ IMGUI_API bool InputScalarEx(const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* data_ptr, void* step_ptr, void* step_fast_ptr, const char* scalar_format, ImGuiInputTextFlags extra_flags);
+ IMGUI_API bool InputScalarAsWidgetReplacement(const ImRect& aabb, const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* data_ptr, ImGuiID id, int decimal_precision);
+
+ IMGUI_API void ColorTooltip(const char* text, const float col[4], ImGuiColorEditFlags flags);
+
+ IMGUI_API bool TreeNodeBehavior(ImGuiID id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* label, const char* label_end = NULL);
+ IMGUI_API bool TreeNodeBehaviorIsOpen(ImGuiID id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags = 0); // Consume previous SetNextTreeNodeOpened() data, if any. May return true when logging
+ IMGUI_API void TreePushRawID(ImGuiID id);
+
+ IMGUI_API void PlotEx(ImGuiPlotType plot_type, const char* label, float (*values_getter)(void* data, int idx), void* data, int values_count, int values_offset, const char* overlay_text, float scale_min, float scale_max, ImVec2 graph_size);
+
+ IMGUI_API int ParseFormatPrecision(const char* fmt, int default_value);
+ IMGUI_API float RoundScalar(float value, int decimal_precision);
+
+} // namespace ImGui
+
+// ImFontAtlas internals
+IMGUI_API bool ImFontAtlasBuildWithStbTruetype(ImFontAtlas* atlas);
+IMGUI_API void ImFontAtlasBuildRegisterDefaultCustomRects(ImFontAtlas* atlas);
+IMGUI_API void ImFontAtlasBuildSetupFont(ImFontAtlas* atlas, ImFont* font, ImFontConfig* font_config, float ascent, float descent);
+IMGUI_API void ImFontAtlasBuildPackCustomRects(ImFontAtlas* atlas, void* spc);
+IMGUI_API void ImFontAtlasBuildRenderDefaultTexData(ImFontAtlas* atlas);
+IMGUI_API void ImFontAtlasBuildMultiplyCalcLookupTable(unsigned char out_table[256], float in_multiply_factor);
+IMGUI_API void ImFontAtlasBuildMultiplyRectAlpha8(const unsigned char table[256], unsigned char* pixels, int x, int y, int w, int h, int stride);
+
+#ifdef __clang__
+#pragma clang diagnostic pop
+#endif
+
+#ifdef _MSC_VER
+#pragma warning (pop)
+#endif
diff --git a/depedencies/include/stb_rect_pack.h b/depedencies/include/stb_rect_pack.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..c75527d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/depedencies/include/stb_rect_pack.h
@@ -0,0 +1,583 @@
+// stb_rect_pack.h - v0.10 - public domain - rectangle packing
+// Sean Barrett 2014
+//
+// Useful for e.g. packing rectangular textures into an atlas.
+// Does not do rotation.
+//
+// Not necessarily the awesomest packing method, but better than
+// the totally naive one in stb_truetype (which is primarily what
+// this is meant to replace).
+//
+// Has only had a few tests run, may have issues.
+//
+// More docs to come.
+//
+// No memory allocations; uses qsort() and assert() from stdlib.
+// Can override those by defining STBRP_SORT and STBRP_ASSERT.
+//
+// This library currently uses the Skyline Bottom-Left algorithm.
+//
+// Please note: better rectangle packers are welcome! Please
+// implement them to the same API, but with a different init
+// function.
+//
+// Credits
+//
+// Library
+// Sean Barrett
+// Minor features
+// Martins Mozeiko
+// Bugfixes / warning fixes
+// Jeremy Jaussaud
+//
+// Version history:
+//
+// 0.10 (2016-10-25) remove cast-away-const to avoid warnings
+// 0.09 (2016-08-27) fix compiler warnings
+// 0.08 (2015-09-13) really fix bug with empty rects (w=0 or h=0)
+// 0.07 (2015-09-13) fix bug with empty rects (w=0 or h=0)
+// 0.06 (2015-04-15) added STBRP_SORT to allow replacing qsort
+// 0.05: added STBRP_ASSERT to allow replacing assert
+// 0.04: fixed minor bug in STBRP_LARGE_RECTS support
+// 0.01: initial release
+//
+// LICENSE
+//
+// This software is dual-licensed to the public domain and under the following
+// license: you are granted a perpetual, irrevocable license to copy, modify,
+// publish, and distribute this file as you see fit.
+
+//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+//
+// INCLUDE SECTION
+//
+
+#ifndef STB_INCLUDE_STB_RECT_PACK_H
+#define STB_INCLUDE_STB_RECT_PACK_H
+
+#define STB_RECT_PACK_VERSION 1
+
+#ifdef STBRP_STATIC
+#define STBRP_DEF static
+#else
+#define STBRP_DEF extern
+#endif
+
+#ifdef __cplusplus
+extern "C" {
+#endif
+
+typedef struct stbrp_context stbrp_context;
+typedef struct stbrp_node stbrp_node;
+typedef struct stbrp_rect stbrp_rect;
+
+#ifdef STBRP_LARGE_RECTS
+typedef int stbrp_coord;
+#else
+typedef unsigned short stbrp_coord;
+#endif
+
+STBRP_DEF void stbrp_pack_rects (stbrp_context *context, stbrp_rect *rects, int num_rects);
+// Assign packed locations to rectangles. The rectangles are of type
+// 'stbrp_rect' defined below, stored in the array 'rects', and there
+// are 'num_rects' many of them.
+//
+// Rectangles which are successfully packed have the 'was_packed' flag
+// set to a non-zero value and 'x' and 'y' store the minimum location
+// on each axis (i.e. bottom-left in cartesian coordinates, top-left
+// if you imagine y increasing downwards). Rectangles which do not fit
+// have the 'was_packed' flag set to 0.
+//
+// You should not try to access the 'rects' array from another thread
+// while this function is running, as the function temporarily reorders
+// the array while it executes.
+//
+// To pack into another rectangle, you need to call stbrp_init_target
+// again. To continue packing into the same rectangle, you can call
+// this function again. Calling this multiple times with multiple rect
+// arrays will probably produce worse packing results than calling it
+// a single time with the full rectangle array, but the option is
+// available.
+
+struct stbrp_rect
+{
+ // reserved for your use:
+ int id;
+
+ // input:
+ stbrp_coord w, h;
+
+ // output:
+ stbrp_coord x, y;
+ int was_packed; // non-zero if valid packing
+
+}; // 16 bytes, nominally
+
+
+STBRP_DEF void stbrp_init_target (stbrp_context *context, int width, int height, stbrp_node *nodes, int num_nodes);
+// Initialize a rectangle packer to:
+// pack a rectangle that is 'width' by 'height' in dimensions
+// using temporary storage provided by the array 'nodes', which is 'num_nodes' long
+//
+// You must call this function every time you start packing into a new target.
+//
+// There is no "shutdown" function. The 'nodes' memory must stay valid for
+// the following stbrp_pack_rects() call (or calls), but can be freed after
+// the call (or calls) finish.
+//
+// Note: to guarantee best results, either:
+// 1. make sure 'num_nodes' >= 'width'
+// or 2. call stbrp_allow_out_of_mem() defined below with 'allow_out_of_mem = 1'
+//
+// If you don't do either of the above things, widths will be quantized to multiples
+// of small integers to guarantee the algorithm doesn't run out of temporary storage.
+//
+// If you do #2, then the non-quantized algorithm will be used, but the algorithm
+// may run out of temporary storage and be unable to pack some rectangles.
+
+STBRP_DEF void stbrp_setup_allow_out_of_mem (stbrp_context *context, int allow_out_of_mem);
+// Optionally call this function after init but before doing any packing to
+// change the handling of the out-of-temp-memory scenario, described above.
+// If you call init again, this will be reset to the default (false).
+
+
+STBRP_DEF void stbrp_setup_heuristic (stbrp_context *context, int heuristic);
+// Optionally select which packing heuristic the library should use. Different
+// heuristics will produce better/worse results for different data sets.
+// If you call init again, this will be reset to the default.
+
+enum
+{
+ STBRP_HEURISTIC_Skyline_default=0,
+ STBRP_HEURISTIC_Skyline_BL_sortHeight = STBRP_HEURISTIC_Skyline_default,
+ STBRP_HEURISTIC_Skyline_BF_sortHeight
+};
+
+
+//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+//
+// the details of the following structures don't matter to you, but they must
+// be visible so you can handle the memory allocations for them
+
+struct stbrp_node
+{
+ stbrp_coord x,y;
+ stbrp_node *next;
+};
+
+struct stbrp_context
+{
+ int width;
+ int height;
+ int align;
+ int init_mode;
+ int heuristic;
+ int num_nodes;
+ stbrp_node *active_head;
+ stbrp_node *free_head;
+ stbrp_node extra[2]; // we allocate two extra nodes so optimal user-node-count is 'width' not 'width+2'
+};
+
+#ifdef __cplusplus
+}
+#endif
+
+#endif
+
+//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+//
+// IMPLEMENTATION SECTION
+//
+
+#ifdef STB_RECT_PACK_IMPLEMENTATION
+#ifndef STBRP_SORT
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#define STBRP_SORT qsort
+#endif
+
+#ifndef STBRP_ASSERT
+#include <assert.h>
+#define STBRP_ASSERT assert
+#endif
+
+#ifdef _MSC_VER
+#define STBRP__NOTUSED(v) (void)(v)
+#else
+#define STBRP__NOTUSED(v) (void)sizeof(v)
+#endif
+
+enum
+{
+ STBRP__INIT_skyline = 1
+};
+
+STBRP_DEF void stbrp_setup_heuristic(stbrp_context *context, int heuristic)
+{
+ switch (context->init_mode) {
+ case STBRP__INIT_skyline:
+ STBRP_ASSERT(heuristic == STBRP_HEURISTIC_Skyline_BL_sortHeight || heuristic == STBRP_HEURISTIC_Skyline_BF_sortHeight);
+ context->heuristic = heuristic;
+ break;
+ default:
+ STBRP_ASSERT(0);
+ }
+}
+
+STBRP_DEF void stbrp_setup_allow_out_of_mem(stbrp_context *context, int allow_out_of_mem)
+{
+ if (allow_out_of_mem)
+ // if it's ok to run out of memory, then don't bother aligning them;
+ // this gives better packing, but may fail due to OOM (even though
+ // the rectangles easily fit). @TODO a smarter approach would be to only
+ // quantize once we've hit OOM, then we could get rid of this parameter.
+ context->align = 1;
+ else {
+ // if it's not ok to run out of memory, then quantize the widths
+ // so that num_nodes is always enough nodes.
+ //
+ // I.e. num_nodes * align >= width
+ // align >= width / num_nodes
+ // align = ceil(width/num_nodes)
+
+ context->align = (context->width + context->num_nodes-1) / context->num_nodes;
+ }
+}
+
+STBRP_DEF void stbrp_init_target(stbrp_context *context, int width, int height, stbrp_node *nodes, int num_nodes)
+{
+ int i;
+#ifndef STBRP_LARGE_RECTS
+ STBRP_ASSERT(width <= 0xffff && height <= 0xffff);
+#endif
+
+ for (i=0; i < num_nodes-1; ++i)
+ nodes[i].next = &nodes[i+1];
+ nodes[i].next = NULL;
+ context->init_mode = STBRP__INIT_skyline;
+ context->heuristic = STBRP_HEURISTIC_Skyline_default;
+ context->free_head = &nodes[0];
+ context->active_head = &context->extra[0];
+ context->width = width;
+ context->height = height;
+ context->num_nodes = num_nodes;
+ stbrp_setup_allow_out_of_mem(context, 0);
+
+ // node 0 is the full width, node 1 is the sentinel (lets us not store width explicitly)
+ context->extra[0].x = 0;
+ context->extra[0].y = 0;
+ context->extra[0].next = &context->extra[1];
+ context->extra[1].x = (stbrp_coord) width;
+#ifdef STBRP_LARGE_RECTS
+ context->extra[1].y = (1<<30);
+#else
+ context->extra[1].y = 65535;
+#endif
+ context->extra[1].next = NULL;
+}
+
+// find minimum y position if it starts at x1
+static int stbrp__skyline_find_min_y(stbrp_context *c, stbrp_node *first, int x0, int width, int *pwaste)
+{
+ stbrp_node *node = first;
+ int x1 = x0 + width;
+ int min_y, visited_width, waste_area;
+
+ STBRP__NOTUSED(c);
+
+ STBRP_ASSERT(first->x <= x0);
+
+ #if 0
+ // skip in case we're past the node
+ while (node->next->x <= x0)
+ ++node;
+ #else
+ STBRP_ASSERT(node->next->x > x0); // we ended up handling this in the caller for efficiency
+ #endif
+
+ STBRP_ASSERT(node->x <= x0);
+
+ min_y = 0;
+ waste_area = 0;
+ visited_width = 0;
+ while (node->x < x1) {
+ if (node->y > min_y) {
+ // raise min_y higher.
+ // we've accounted for all waste up to min_y,
+ // but we'll now add more waste for everything we've visted
+ waste_area += visited_width * (node->y - min_y);
+ min_y = node->y;
+ // the first time through, visited_width might be reduced
+ if (node->x < x0)
+ visited_width += node->next->x - x0;
+ else
+ visited_width += node->next->x - node->x;
+ } else {
+ // add waste area
+ int under_width = node->next->x - node->x;
+ if (under_width + visited_width > width)
+ under_width = width - visited_width;
+ waste_area += under_width * (min_y - node->y);
+ visited_width += under_width;
+ }
+ node = node->next;
+ }
+
+ *pwaste = waste_area;
+ return min_y;
+}
+
+typedef struct
+{
+ int x,y;
+ stbrp_node **prev_link;
+} stbrp__findresult;
+
+static stbrp__findresult stbrp__skyline_find_best_pos(stbrp_context *c, int width, int height)
+{
+ int best_waste = (1<<30), best_x, best_y = (1 << 30);
+ stbrp__findresult fr;
+ stbrp_node **prev, *node, *tail, **best = NULL;
+
+ // align to multiple of c->align
+ width = (width + c->align - 1);
+ width -= width % c->align;
+ STBRP_ASSERT(width % c->align == 0);
+
+ node = c->active_head;
+ prev = &c->active_head;
+ while (node->x + width <= c->width) {
+ int y,waste;
+ y = stbrp__skyline_find_min_y(c, node, node->x, width, &waste);
+ if (c->heuristic == STBRP_HEURISTIC_Skyline_BL_sortHeight) { // actually just want to test BL
+ // bottom left
+ if (y < best_y) {
+ best_y = y;
+ best = prev;
+ }
+ } else {
+ // best-fit
+ if (y + height <= c->height) {
+ // can only use it if it first vertically
+ if (y < best_y || (y == best_y && waste < best_waste)) {
+ best_y = y;
+ best_waste = waste;
+ best = prev;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ prev = &node->next;
+ node = node->next;
+ }
+
+ best_x = (best == NULL) ? 0 : (*best)->x;
+
+ // if doing best-fit (BF), we also have to try aligning right edge to each node position
+ //
+ // e.g, if fitting
+ //
+ // ____________________
+ // |____________________|
+ //
+ // into
+ //
+ // | |
+ // | ____________|
+ // |____________|
+ //
+ // then right-aligned reduces waste, but bottom-left BL is always chooses left-aligned
+ //
+ // This makes BF take about 2x the time
+
+ if (c->heuristic == STBRP_HEURISTIC_Skyline_BF_sortHeight) {
+ tail = c->active_head;
+ node = c->active_head;
+ prev = &c->active_head;
+ // find first node that's admissible
+ while (tail->x < width)
+ tail = tail->next;
+ while (tail) {
+ int xpos = tail->x - width;
+ int y,waste;
+ STBRP_ASSERT(xpos >= 0);
+ // find the left position that matches this
+ while (node->next->x <= xpos) {
+ prev = &node->next;
+ node = node->next;
+ }
+ STBRP_ASSERT(node->next->x > xpos && node->x <= xpos);
+ y = stbrp__skyline_find_min_y(c, node, xpos, width, &waste);
+ if (y + height < c->height) {
+ if (y <= best_y) {
+ if (y < best_y || waste < best_waste || (waste==best_waste && xpos < best_x)) {
+ best_x = xpos;
+ STBRP_ASSERT(y <= best_y);
+ best_y = y;
+ best_waste = waste;
+ best = prev;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ tail = tail->next;
+ }
+ }
+
+ fr.prev_link = best;
+ fr.x = best_x;
+ fr.y = best_y;
+ return fr;
+}
+
+static stbrp__findresult stbrp__skyline_pack_rectangle(stbrp_context *context, int width, int height)
+{
+ // find best position according to heuristic
+ stbrp__findresult res = stbrp__skyline_find_best_pos(context, width, height);
+ stbrp_node *node, *cur;
+
+ // bail if:
+ // 1. it failed
+ // 2. the best node doesn't fit (we don't always check this)
+ // 3. we're out of memory
+ if (res.prev_link == NULL || res.y + height > context->height || context->free_head == NULL) {
+ res.prev_link = NULL;
+ return res;
+ }
+
+ // on success, create new node
+ node = context->free_head;
+ node->x = (stbrp_coord) res.x;
+ node->y = (stbrp_coord) (res.y + height);
+
+ context->free_head = node->next;
+
+ // insert the new node into the right starting point, and
+ // let 'cur' point to the remaining nodes needing to be
+ // stiched back in
+
+ cur = *res.prev_link;
+ if (cur->x < res.x) {
+ // preserve the existing one, so start testing with the next one
+ stbrp_node *next = cur->next;
+ cur->next = node;
+ cur = next;
+ } else {
+ *res.prev_link = node;
+ }
+
+ // from here, traverse cur and free the nodes, until we get to one
+ // that shouldn't be freed
+ while (cur->next && cur->next->x <= res.x + width) {
+ stbrp_node *next = cur->next;
+ // move the current node to the free list
+ cur->next = context->free_head;
+ context->free_head = cur;
+ cur = next;
+ }
+
+ // stitch the list back in
+ node->next = cur;
+
+ if (cur->x < res.x + width)
+ cur->x = (stbrp_coord) (res.x + width);
+
+#ifdef _DEBUG
+ cur = context->active_head;
+ while (cur->x < context->width) {
+ STBRP_ASSERT(cur->x < cur->next->x);
+ cur = cur->next;
+ }
+ STBRP_ASSERT(cur->next == NULL);
+
+ {
+ stbrp_node *L1 = NULL, *L2 = NULL;
+ int count=0;
+ cur = context->active_head;
+ while (cur) {
+ L1 = cur;
+ cur = cur->next;
+ ++count;
+ }
+ cur = context->free_head;
+ while (cur) {
+ L2 = cur;
+ cur = cur->next;
+ ++count;
+ }
+ STBRP_ASSERT(count == context->num_nodes+2);
+ }
+#endif
+
+ return res;
+}
+
+static int rect_height_compare(const void *a, const void *b)
+{
+ const stbrp_rect *p = (const stbrp_rect *) a;
+ const stbrp_rect *q = (const stbrp_rect *) b;
+ if (p->h > q->h)
+ return -1;
+ if (p->h < q->h)
+ return 1;
+ return (p->w > q->w) ? -1 : (p->w < q->w);
+}
+
+static int rect_width_compare(const void *a, const void *b)
+{
+ const stbrp_rect *p = (const stbrp_rect *) a;
+ const stbrp_rect *q = (const stbrp_rect *) b;
+ if (p->w > q->w)
+ return -1;
+ if (p->w < q->w)
+ return 1;
+ return (p->h > q->h) ? -1 : (p->h < q->h);
+}
+
+static int rect_original_order(const void *a, const void *b)
+{
+ const stbrp_rect *p = (const stbrp_rect *) a;
+ const stbrp_rect *q = (const stbrp_rect *) b;
+ return (p->was_packed < q->was_packed) ? -1 : (p->was_packed > q->was_packed);
+}
+
+#ifdef STBRP_LARGE_RECTS
+#define STBRP__MAXVAL 0xffffffff
+#else
+#define STBRP__MAXVAL 0xffff
+#endif
+
+STBRP_DEF void stbrp_pack_rects(stbrp_context *context, stbrp_rect *rects, int num_rects)
+{
+ int i;
+
+ // we use the 'was_packed' field internally to allow sorting/unsorting
+ for (i=0; i < num_rects; ++i) {
+ rects[i].was_packed = i;
+ #ifndef STBRP_LARGE_RECTS
+ STBRP_ASSERT(rects[i].w <= 0xffff && rects[i].h <= 0xffff);
+ #endif
+ }
+
+ // sort according to heuristic
+ STBRP_SORT(rects, num_rects, sizeof(rects[0]), rect_height_compare);
+
+ for (i=0; i < num_rects; ++i) {
+ if (rects[i].w == 0 || rects[i].h == 0) {
+ rects[i].x = rects[i].y = 0; // empty rect needs no space
+ } else {
+ stbrp__findresult fr = stbrp__skyline_pack_rectangle(context, rects[i].w, rects[i].h);
+ if (fr.prev_link) {
+ rects[i].x = (stbrp_coord) fr.x;
+ rects[i].y = (stbrp_coord) fr.y;
+ } else {
+ rects[i].x = rects[i].y = STBRP__MAXVAL;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+
+ // unsort
+ STBRP_SORT(rects, num_rects, sizeof(rects[0]), rect_original_order);
+
+ // set was_packed flags
+ for (i=0; i < num_rects; ++i)
+ rects[i].was_packed = !(rects[i].x == STBRP__MAXVAL && rects[i].y == STBRP__MAXVAL);
+}
+#endif
diff --git a/depedencies/include/stb_textedit.h b/depedencies/include/stb_textedit.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..4b731a0
--- /dev/null
+++ b/depedencies/include/stb_textedit.h
@@ -0,0 +1,1322 @@
+// [ImGui] this is a slightly modified version of stb_truetype.h 1.9. Those changes would need to be pushed into nothings/sb
+// [ImGui] - fixed linestart handler when over last character of multi-line buffer + simplified existing code (#588, #815)
+// [ImGui] - fixed a state corruption/crash bug in stb_text_redo and stb_textedit_discard_redo (#715)
+// [ImGui] - fixed a crash bug in stb_textedit_discard_redo (#681)
+// [ImGui] - fixed some minor warnings
+
+// stb_textedit.h - v1.9 - public domain - Sean Barrett
+// Development of this library was sponsored by RAD Game Tools
+//
+// This C header file implements the guts of a multi-line text-editing
+// widget; you implement display, word-wrapping, and low-level string
+// insertion/deletion, and stb_textedit will map user inputs into
+// insertions & deletions, plus updates to the cursor position,
+// selection state, and undo state.
+//
+// It is intended for use in games and other systems that need to build
+// their own custom widgets and which do not have heavy text-editing
+// requirements (this library is not recommended for use for editing large
+// texts, as its performance does not scale and it has limited undo).
+//
+// Non-trivial behaviors are modelled after Windows text controls.
+//
+//
+// LICENSE
+//
+// This software is dual-licensed to the public domain and under the following
+// license: you are granted a perpetual, irrevocable license to copy, modify,
+// publish, and distribute this file as you see fit.
+//
+//
+// DEPENDENCIES
+//
+// Uses the C runtime function 'memmove', which you can override
+// by defining STB_TEXTEDIT_memmove before the implementation.
+// Uses no other functions. Performs no runtime allocations.
+//
+//
+// VERSION HISTORY
+//
+// 1.9 (2016-08-27) customizable move-by-word
+// 1.8 (2016-04-02) better keyboard handling when mouse button is down
+// 1.7 (2015-09-13) change y range handling in case baseline is non-0
+// 1.6 (2015-04-15) allow STB_TEXTEDIT_memmove
+// 1.5 (2014-09-10) add support for secondary keys for OS X
+// 1.4 (2014-08-17) fix signed/unsigned warnings
+// 1.3 (2014-06-19) fix mouse clicking to round to nearest char boundary
+// 1.2 (2014-05-27) fix some RAD types that had crept into the new code
+// 1.1 (2013-12-15) move-by-word (requires STB_TEXTEDIT_IS_SPACE )
+// 1.0 (2012-07-26) improve documentation, initial public release
+// 0.3 (2012-02-24) bugfixes, single-line mode; insert mode
+// 0.2 (2011-11-28) fixes to undo/redo
+// 0.1 (2010-07-08) initial version
+//
+// ADDITIONAL CONTRIBUTORS
+//
+// Ulf Winklemann: move-by-word in 1.1
+// Fabian Giesen: secondary key inputs in 1.5
+// Martins Mozeiko: STB_TEXTEDIT_memmove
+//
+// Bugfixes:
+// Scott Graham
+// Daniel Keller
+// Omar Cornut
+//
+// USAGE
+//
+// This file behaves differently depending on what symbols you define
+// before including it.
+//
+//
+// Header-file mode:
+//
+// If you do not define STB_TEXTEDIT_IMPLEMENTATION before including this,
+// it will operate in "header file" mode. In this mode, it declares a
+// single public symbol, STB_TexteditState, which encapsulates the current
+// state of a text widget (except for the string, which you will store
+// separately).
+//
+// To compile in this mode, you must define STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE to a
+// primitive type that defines a single character (e.g. char, wchar_t, etc).
+//
+// To save space or increase undo-ability, you can optionally define the
+// following things that are used by the undo system:
+//
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_POSITIONTYPE small int type encoding a valid cursor position
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOSTATECOUNT the number of undo states to allow
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOCHARCOUNT the number of characters to store in the undo buffer
+//
+// If you don't define these, they are set to permissive types and
+// moderate sizes. The undo system does no memory allocations, so
+// it grows STB_TexteditState by the worst-case storage which is (in bytes):
+//
+// [4 + sizeof(STB_TEXTEDIT_POSITIONTYPE)] * STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOSTATE_COUNT
+// + sizeof(STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE) * STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOCHAR_COUNT
+//
+//
+// Implementation mode:
+//
+// If you define STB_TEXTEDIT_IMPLEMENTATION before including this, it
+// will compile the implementation of the text edit widget, depending
+// on a large number of symbols which must be defined before the include.
+//
+// The implementation is defined only as static functions. You will then
+// need to provide your own APIs in the same file which will access the
+// static functions.
+//
+// The basic concept is that you provide a "string" object which
+// behaves like an array of characters. stb_textedit uses indices to
+// refer to positions in the string, implicitly representing positions
+// in the displayed textedit. This is true for both plain text and
+// rich text; even with rich text stb_truetype interacts with your
+// code as if there was an array of all the displayed characters.
+//
+// Symbols that must be the same in header-file and implementation mode:
+//
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE the character type
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_POSITIONTYPE small type that a valid cursor position
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOSTATECOUNT the number of undo states to allow
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOCHARCOUNT the number of characters to store in the undo buffer
+//
+// Symbols you must define for implementation mode:
+//
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING the type of object representing a string being edited,
+// typically this is a wrapper object with other data you need
+//
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_STRINGLEN(obj) the length of the string (ideally O(1))
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_LAYOUTROW(&r,obj,n) returns the results of laying out a line of characters
+// starting from character #n (see discussion below)
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_GETWIDTH(obj,n,i) returns the pixel delta from the xpos of the i'th character
+// to the xpos of the i+1'th char for a line of characters
+// starting at character #n (i.e. accounts for kerning
+// with previous char)
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_KEYTOTEXT(k) maps a keyboard input to an insertable character
+// (return type is int, -1 means not valid to insert)
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_GETCHAR(obj,i) returns the i'th character of obj, 0-based
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_NEWLINE the character returned by _GETCHAR() we recognize
+// as manually wordwrapping for end-of-line positioning
+//
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_DELETECHARS(obj,i,n) delete n characters starting at i
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_INSERTCHARS(obj,i,c*,n) insert n characters at i (pointed to by STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE*)
+//
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT a power of two that is or'd in to a keyboard input to represent the shift key
+//
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LEFT keyboard input to move cursor left
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_RIGHT keyboard input to move cursor right
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_UP keyboard input to move cursor up
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_DOWN keyboard input to move cursor down
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINESTART keyboard input to move cursor to start of line // e.g. HOME
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINEEND keyboard input to move cursor to end of line // e.g. END
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTSTART keyboard input to move cursor to start of text // e.g. ctrl-HOME
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTEND keyboard input to move cursor to end of text // e.g. ctrl-END
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_DELETE keyboard input to delete selection or character under cursor
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_BACKSPACE keyboard input to delete selection or character left of cursor
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_UNDO keyboard input to perform undo
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_REDO keyboard input to perform redo
+//
+// Optional:
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_INSERT keyboard input to toggle insert mode
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_IS_SPACE(ch) true if character is whitespace (e.g. 'isspace'),
+// required for default WORDLEFT/WORDRIGHT handlers
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDLEFT(obj,i) custom handler for WORDLEFT, returns index to move cursor to
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDRIGHT(obj,i) custom handler for WORDRIGHT, returns index to move cursor to
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDLEFT keyboard input to move cursor left one word // e.g. ctrl-LEFT
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDRIGHT keyboard input to move cursor right one word // e.g. ctrl-RIGHT
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINESTART2 secondary keyboard input to move cursor to start of line
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINEEND2 secondary keyboard input to move cursor to end of line
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTSTART2 secondary keyboard input to move cursor to start of text
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTEND2 secondary keyboard input to move cursor to end of text
+//
+// Todo:
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_PGUP keyboard input to move cursor up a page
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_PGDOWN keyboard input to move cursor down a page
+//
+// Keyboard input must be encoded as a single integer value; e.g. a character code
+// and some bitflags that represent shift states. to simplify the interface, SHIFT must
+// be a bitflag, so we can test the shifted state of cursor movements to allow selection,
+// i.e. (STB_TEXTED_K_RIGHT|STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT) should be shifted right-arrow.
+//
+// You can encode other things, such as CONTROL or ALT, in additional bits, and
+// then test for their presence in e.g. STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDLEFT. For example,
+// my Windows implementations add an additional CONTROL bit, and an additional KEYDOWN
+// bit. Then all of the STB_TEXTEDIT_K_ values bitwise-or in the KEYDOWN bit,
+// and I pass both WM_KEYDOWN and WM_CHAR events to the "key" function in the
+// API below. The control keys will only match WM_KEYDOWN events because of the
+// keydown bit I add, and STB_TEXTEDIT_KEYTOTEXT only tests for the KEYDOWN
+// bit so it only decodes WM_CHAR events.
+//
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_LAYOUTROW returns information about the shape of one displayed
+// row of characters assuming they start on the i'th character--the width and
+// the height and the number of characters consumed. This allows this library
+// to traverse the entire layout incrementally. You need to compute word-wrapping
+// here.
+//
+// Each textfield keeps its own insert mode state, which is not how normal
+// applications work. To keep an app-wide insert mode, update/copy the
+// "insert_mode" field of STB_TexteditState before/after calling API functions.
+//
+// API
+//
+// void stb_textedit_initialize_state(STB_TexteditState *state, int is_single_line)
+//
+// void stb_textedit_click(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state, float x, float y)
+// void stb_textedit_drag(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state, float x, float y)
+// int stb_textedit_cut(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state)
+// int stb_textedit_paste(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state, STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE *text, int len)
+// void stb_textedit_key(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state, int key)
+//
+// Each of these functions potentially updates the string and updates the
+// state.
+//
+// initialize_state:
+// set the textedit state to a known good default state when initially
+// constructing the textedit.
+//
+// click:
+// call this with the mouse x,y on a mouse down; it will update the cursor
+// and reset the selection start/end to the cursor point. the x,y must
+// be relative to the text widget, with (0,0) being the top left.
+//
+// drag:
+// call this with the mouse x,y on a mouse drag/up; it will update the
+// cursor and the selection end point
+//
+// cut:
+// call this to delete the current selection; returns true if there was
+// one. you should FIRST copy the current selection to the system paste buffer.
+// (To copy, just copy the current selection out of the string yourself.)
+//
+// paste:
+// call this to paste text at the current cursor point or over the current
+// selection if there is one.
+//
+// key:
+// call this for keyboard inputs sent to the textfield. you can use it
+// for "key down" events or for "translated" key events. if you need to
+// do both (as in Win32), or distinguish Unicode characters from control
+// inputs, set a high bit to distinguish the two; then you can define the
+// various definitions like STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LEFT have the is-key-event bit
+// set, and make STB_TEXTEDIT_KEYTOCHAR check that the is-key-event bit is
+// clear.
+//
+// When rendering, you can read the cursor position and selection state from
+// the STB_TexteditState.
+//
+//
+// Notes:
+//
+// This is designed to be usable in IMGUI, so it allows for the possibility of
+// running in an IMGUI that has NOT cached the multi-line layout. For this
+// reason, it provides an interface that is compatible with computing the
+// layout incrementally--we try to make sure we make as few passes through
+// as possible. (For example, to locate the mouse pointer in the text, we
+// could define functions that return the X and Y positions of characters
+// and binary search Y and then X, but if we're doing dynamic layout this
+// will run the layout algorithm many times, so instead we manually search
+// forward in one pass. Similar logic applies to e.g. up-arrow and
+// down-arrow movement.)
+//
+// If it's run in a widget that *has* cached the layout, then this is less
+// efficient, but it's not horrible on modern computers. But you wouldn't
+// want to edit million-line files with it.
+
+
+////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+////
+//// Header-file mode
+////
+////
+
+#ifndef INCLUDE_STB_TEXTEDIT_H
+#define INCLUDE_STB_TEXTEDIT_H
+
+////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+//
+// STB_TexteditState
+//
+// Definition of STB_TexteditState which you should store
+// per-textfield; it includes cursor position, selection state,
+// and undo state.
+//
+
+#ifndef STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOSTATECOUNT
+#define STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOSTATECOUNT 99
+#endif
+#ifndef STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOCHARCOUNT
+#define STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOCHARCOUNT 999
+#endif
+#ifndef STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE
+#define STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE int
+#endif
+#ifndef STB_TEXTEDIT_POSITIONTYPE
+#define STB_TEXTEDIT_POSITIONTYPE int
+#endif
+
+typedef struct
+{
+ // private data
+ STB_TEXTEDIT_POSITIONTYPE where;
+ short insert_length;
+ short delete_length;
+ short char_storage;
+} StbUndoRecord;
+
+typedef struct
+{
+ // private data
+ StbUndoRecord undo_rec [STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOSTATECOUNT];
+ STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE undo_char[STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOCHARCOUNT];
+ short undo_point, redo_point;
+ short undo_char_point, redo_char_point;
+} StbUndoState;
+
+typedef struct
+{
+ /////////////////////
+ //
+ // public data
+ //
+
+ int cursor;
+ // position of the text cursor within the string
+
+ int select_start; // selection start point
+ int select_end;
+ // selection start and end point in characters; if equal, no selection.
+ // note that start may be less than or greater than end (e.g. when
+ // dragging the mouse, start is where the initial click was, and you
+ // can drag in either direction)
+
+ unsigned char insert_mode;
+ // each textfield keeps its own insert mode state. to keep an app-wide
+ // insert mode, copy this value in/out of the app state
+
+ /////////////////////
+ //
+ // private data
+ //
+ unsigned char cursor_at_end_of_line; // not implemented yet
+ unsigned char initialized;
+ unsigned char has_preferred_x;
+ unsigned char single_line;
+ unsigned char padding1, padding2, padding3;
+ float preferred_x; // this determines where the cursor up/down tries to seek to along x
+ StbUndoState undostate;
+} STB_TexteditState;
+
+
+////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+//
+// StbTexteditRow
+//
+// Result of layout query, used by stb_textedit to determine where
+// the text in each row is.
+
+// result of layout query
+typedef struct
+{
+ float x0,x1; // starting x location, end x location (allows for align=right, etc)
+ float baseline_y_delta; // position of baseline relative to previous row's baseline
+ float ymin,ymax; // height of row above and below baseline
+ int num_chars;
+} StbTexteditRow;
+#endif //INCLUDE_STB_TEXTEDIT_H
+
+
+////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+////
+//// Implementation mode
+////
+////
+
+
+// implementation isn't include-guarded, since it might have indirectly
+// included just the "header" portion
+#ifdef STB_TEXTEDIT_IMPLEMENTATION
+
+#ifndef STB_TEXTEDIT_memmove
+#include <string.h>
+#define STB_TEXTEDIT_memmove memmove
+#endif
+
+
+/////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+//
+// Mouse input handling
+//
+
+// traverse the layout to locate the nearest character to a display position
+static int stb_text_locate_coord(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, float x, float y)
+{
+ StbTexteditRow r;
+ int n = STB_TEXTEDIT_STRINGLEN(str);
+ float base_y = 0, prev_x;
+ int i=0, k;
+
+ r.x0 = r.x1 = 0;
+ r.ymin = r.ymax = 0;
+ r.num_chars = 0;
+
+ // search rows to find one that straddles 'y'
+ while (i < n) {
+ STB_TEXTEDIT_LAYOUTROW(&r, str, i);
+ if (r.num_chars <= 0)
+ return n;
+
+ if (i==0 && y < base_y + r.ymin)
+ return 0;
+
+ if (y < base_y + r.ymax)
+ break;
+
+ i += r.num_chars;
+ base_y += r.baseline_y_delta;
+ }
+
+ // below all text, return 'after' last character
+ if (i >= n)
+ return n;
+
+ // check if it's before the beginning of the line
+ if (x < r.x0)
+ return i;
+
+ // check if it's before the end of the line
+ if (x < r.x1) {
+ // search characters in row for one that straddles 'x'
+ prev_x = r.x0;
+ for (k=0; k < r.num_chars; ++k) {
+ float w = STB_TEXTEDIT_GETWIDTH(str, i, k);
+ if (x < prev_x+w) {
+ if (x < prev_x+w/2)
+ return k+i;
+ else
+ return k+i+1;
+ }
+ prev_x += w;
+ }
+ // shouldn't happen, but if it does, fall through to end-of-line case
+ }
+
+ // if the last character is a newline, return that. otherwise return 'after' the last character
+ if (STB_TEXTEDIT_GETCHAR(str, i+r.num_chars-1) == STB_TEXTEDIT_NEWLINE)
+ return i+r.num_chars-1;
+ else
+ return i+r.num_chars;
+}
+
+// API click: on mouse down, move the cursor to the clicked location, and reset the selection
+static void stb_textedit_click(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state, float x, float y)
+{
+ state->cursor = stb_text_locate_coord(str, x, y);
+ state->select_start = state->cursor;
+ state->select_end = state->cursor;
+ state->has_preferred_x = 0;
+}
+
+// API drag: on mouse drag, move the cursor and selection endpoint to the clicked location
+static void stb_textedit_drag(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state, float x, float y)
+{
+ int p = stb_text_locate_coord(str, x, y);
+ if (state->select_start == state->select_end)
+ state->select_start = state->cursor;
+ state->cursor = state->select_end = p;
+}
+
+/////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+//
+// Keyboard input handling
+//
+
+// forward declarations
+static void stb_text_undo(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state);
+static void stb_text_redo(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state);
+static void stb_text_makeundo_delete(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state, int where, int length);
+static void stb_text_makeundo_insert(STB_TexteditState *state, int where, int length);
+static void stb_text_makeundo_replace(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state, int where, int old_length, int new_length);
+
+typedef struct
+{
+ float x,y; // position of n'th character
+ float height; // height of line
+ int first_char, length; // first char of row, and length
+ int prev_first; // first char of previous row
+} StbFindState;
+
+// find the x/y location of a character, and remember info about the previous row in
+// case we get a move-up event (for page up, we'll have to rescan)
+static void stb_textedit_find_charpos(StbFindState *find, STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, int n, int single_line)
+{
+ StbTexteditRow r;
+ int prev_start = 0;
+ int z = STB_TEXTEDIT_STRINGLEN(str);
+ int i=0, first;
+
+ if (n == z) {
+ // if it's at the end, then find the last line -- simpler than trying to
+ // explicitly handle this case in the regular code
+ if (single_line) {
+ STB_TEXTEDIT_LAYOUTROW(&r, str, 0);
+ find->y = 0;
+ find->first_char = 0;
+ find->length = z;
+ find->height = r.ymax - r.ymin;
+ find->x = r.x1;
+ } else {
+ find->y = 0;
+ find->x = 0;
+ find->height = 1;
+ while (i < z) {
+ STB_TEXTEDIT_LAYOUTROW(&r, str, i);
+ prev_start = i;
+ i += r.num_chars;
+ }
+ find->first_char = i;
+ find->length = 0;
+ find->prev_first = prev_start;
+ }
+ return;
+ }
+
+ // search rows to find the one that straddles character n
+ find->y = 0;
+
+ for(;;) {
+ STB_TEXTEDIT_LAYOUTROW(&r, str, i);
+ if (n < i + r.num_chars)
+ break;
+ prev_start = i;
+ i += r.num_chars;
+ find->y += r.baseline_y_delta;
+ }
+
+ find->first_char = first = i;
+ find->length = r.num_chars;
+ find->height = r.ymax - r.ymin;
+ find->prev_first = prev_start;
+
+ // now scan to find xpos
+ find->x = r.x0;
+ i = 0;
+ for (i=0; first+i < n; ++i)
+ find->x += STB_TEXTEDIT_GETWIDTH(str, first, i);
+}
+
+#define STB_TEXT_HAS_SELECTION(s) ((s)->select_start != (s)->select_end)
+
+// make the selection/cursor state valid if client altered the string
+static void stb_textedit_clamp(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state)
+{
+ int n = STB_TEXTEDIT_STRINGLEN(str);
+ if (STB_TEXT_HAS_SELECTION(state)) {
+ if (state->select_start > n) state->select_start = n;
+ if (state->select_end > n) state->select_end = n;
+ // if clamping forced them to be equal, move the cursor to match
+ if (state->select_start == state->select_end)
+ state->cursor = state->select_start;
+ }
+ if (state->cursor > n) state->cursor = n;
+}
+
+// delete characters while updating undo
+static void stb_textedit_delete(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state, int where, int len)
+{
+ stb_text_makeundo_delete(str, state, where, len);
+ STB_TEXTEDIT_DELETECHARS(str, where, len);
+ state->has_preferred_x = 0;
+}
+
+// delete the section
+static void stb_textedit_delete_selection(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state)
+{
+ stb_textedit_clamp(str, state);
+ if (STB_TEXT_HAS_SELECTION(state)) {
+ if (state->select_start < state->select_end) {
+ stb_textedit_delete(str, state, state->select_start, state->select_end - state->select_start);
+ state->select_end = state->cursor = state->select_start;
+ } else {
+ stb_textedit_delete(str, state, state->select_end, state->select_start - state->select_end);
+ state->select_start = state->cursor = state->select_end;
+ }
+ state->has_preferred_x = 0;
+ }
+}
+
+// canoncialize the selection so start <= end
+static void stb_textedit_sortselection(STB_TexteditState *state)
+{
+ if (state->select_end < state->select_start) {
+ int temp = state->select_end;
+ state->select_end = state->select_start;
+ state->select_start = temp;
+ }
+}
+
+// move cursor to first character of selection
+static void stb_textedit_move_to_first(STB_TexteditState *state)
+{
+ if (STB_TEXT_HAS_SELECTION(state)) {
+ stb_textedit_sortselection(state);
+ state->cursor = state->select_start;
+ state->select_end = state->select_start;
+ state->has_preferred_x = 0;
+ }
+}
+
+// move cursor to last character of selection
+static void stb_textedit_move_to_last(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state)
+{
+ if (STB_TEXT_HAS_SELECTION(state)) {
+ stb_textedit_sortselection(state);
+ stb_textedit_clamp(str, state);
+ state->cursor = state->select_end;
+ state->select_start = state->select_end;
+ state->has_preferred_x = 0;
+ }
+}
+
+#ifdef STB_TEXTEDIT_IS_SPACE
+static int is_word_boundary( STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, int idx )
+{
+ return idx > 0 ? (STB_TEXTEDIT_IS_SPACE( STB_TEXTEDIT_GETCHAR(str,idx-1) ) && !STB_TEXTEDIT_IS_SPACE( STB_TEXTEDIT_GETCHAR(str, idx) ) ) : 1;
+}
+
+#ifndef STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDLEFT
+static int stb_textedit_move_to_word_previous( STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, int c )
+{
+ --c; // always move at least one character
+ while( c >= 0 && !is_word_boundary( str, c ) )
+ --c;
+
+ if( c < 0 )
+ c = 0;
+
+ return c;
+}
+#define STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDLEFT stb_textedit_move_to_word_previous
+#endif
+
+#ifndef STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDRIGHT
+static int stb_textedit_move_to_word_next( STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, int c )
+{
+ const int len = STB_TEXTEDIT_STRINGLEN(str);
+ ++c; // always move at least one character
+ while( c < len && !is_word_boundary( str, c ) )
+ ++c;
+
+ if( c > len )
+ c = len;
+
+ return c;
+}
+#define STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDRIGHT stb_textedit_move_to_word_next
+#endif
+
+#endif
+
+// update selection and cursor to match each other
+static void stb_textedit_prep_selection_at_cursor(STB_TexteditState *state)
+{
+ if (!STB_TEXT_HAS_SELECTION(state))
+ state->select_start = state->select_end = state->cursor;
+ else
+ state->cursor = state->select_end;
+}
+
+// API cut: delete selection
+static int stb_textedit_cut(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state)
+{
+ if (STB_TEXT_HAS_SELECTION(state)) {
+ stb_textedit_delete_selection(str,state); // implicity clamps
+ state->has_preferred_x = 0;
+ return 1;
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+// API paste: replace existing selection with passed-in text
+static int stb_textedit_paste(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state, STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE const *ctext, int len)
+{
+ STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE *text = (STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE *) ctext;
+ // if there's a selection, the paste should delete it
+ stb_textedit_clamp(str, state);
+ stb_textedit_delete_selection(str,state);
+ // try to insert the characters
+ if (STB_TEXTEDIT_INSERTCHARS(str, state->cursor, text, len)) {
+ stb_text_makeundo_insert(state, state->cursor, len);
+ state->cursor += len;
+ state->has_preferred_x = 0;
+ return 1;
+ }
+ // remove the undo since we didn't actually insert the characters
+ if (state->undostate.undo_point)
+ --state->undostate.undo_point;
+ return 0;
+}
+
+// API key: process a keyboard input
+static void stb_textedit_key(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state, int key)
+{
+retry:
+ switch (key) {
+ default: {
+ int c = STB_TEXTEDIT_KEYTOTEXT(key);
+ if (c > 0) {
+ STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE ch = (STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE) c;
+
+ // can't add newline in single-line mode
+ if (c == '\n' && state->single_line)
+ break;
+
+ if (state->insert_mode && !STB_TEXT_HAS_SELECTION(state) && state->cursor < STB_TEXTEDIT_STRINGLEN(str)) {
+ stb_text_makeundo_replace(str, state, state->cursor, 1, 1);
+ STB_TEXTEDIT_DELETECHARS(str, state->cursor, 1);
+ if (STB_TEXTEDIT_INSERTCHARS(str, state->cursor, &ch, 1)) {
+ ++state->cursor;
+ state->has_preferred_x = 0;
+ }
+ } else {
+ stb_textedit_delete_selection(str,state); // implicity clamps
+ if (STB_TEXTEDIT_INSERTCHARS(str, state->cursor, &ch, 1)) {
+ stb_text_makeundo_insert(state, state->cursor, 1);
+ ++state->cursor;
+ state->has_preferred_x = 0;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+
+#ifdef STB_TEXTEDIT_K_INSERT
+ case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_INSERT:
+ state->insert_mode = !state->insert_mode;
+ break;
+#endif
+
+ case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_UNDO:
+ stb_text_undo(str, state);
+ state->has_preferred_x = 0;
+ break;
+
+ case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_REDO:
+ stb_text_redo(str, state);
+ state->has_preferred_x = 0;
+ break;
+
+ case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LEFT:
+ // if currently there's a selection, move cursor to start of selection
+ if (STB_TEXT_HAS_SELECTION(state))
+ stb_textedit_move_to_first(state);
+ else
+ if (state->cursor > 0)
+ --state->cursor;
+ state->has_preferred_x = 0;
+ break;
+
+ case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_RIGHT:
+ // if currently there's a selection, move cursor to end of selection
+ if (STB_TEXT_HAS_SELECTION(state))
+ stb_textedit_move_to_last(str, state);
+ else
+ ++state->cursor;
+ stb_textedit_clamp(str, state);
+ state->has_preferred_x = 0;
+ break;
+
+ case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LEFT | STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT:
+ stb_textedit_clamp(str, state);
+ stb_textedit_prep_selection_at_cursor(state);
+ // move selection left
+ if (state->select_end > 0)
+ --state->select_end;
+ state->cursor = state->select_end;
+ state->has_preferred_x = 0;
+ break;
+
+#ifdef STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDLEFT
+ case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDLEFT:
+ if (STB_TEXT_HAS_SELECTION(state))
+ stb_textedit_move_to_first(state);
+ else {
+ state->cursor = STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDLEFT(str, state->cursor);
+ stb_textedit_clamp( str, state );
+ }
+ break;
+
+ case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDLEFT | STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT:
+ if( !STB_TEXT_HAS_SELECTION( state ) )
+ stb_textedit_prep_selection_at_cursor(state);
+
+ state->cursor = STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDLEFT(str, state->cursor);
+ state->select_end = state->cursor;
+
+ stb_textedit_clamp( str, state );
+ break;
+#endif
+
+#ifdef STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDRIGHT
+ case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDRIGHT:
+ if (STB_TEXT_HAS_SELECTION(state))
+ stb_textedit_move_to_last(str, state);
+ else {
+ state->cursor = STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDRIGHT(str, state->cursor);
+ stb_textedit_clamp( str, state );
+ }
+ break;
+
+ case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDRIGHT | STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT:
+ if( !STB_TEXT_HAS_SELECTION( state ) )
+ stb_textedit_prep_selection_at_cursor(state);
+
+ state->cursor = STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDRIGHT(str, state->cursor);
+ state->select_end = state->cursor;
+
+ stb_textedit_clamp( str, state );
+ break;
+#endif
+
+ case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_RIGHT | STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT:
+ stb_textedit_prep_selection_at_cursor(state);
+ // move selection right
+ ++state->select_end;
+ stb_textedit_clamp(str, state);
+ state->cursor = state->select_end;
+ state->has_preferred_x = 0;
+ break;
+
+ case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_DOWN:
+ case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_DOWN | STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT: {
+ StbFindState find;
+ StbTexteditRow row;
+ int i, sel = (key & STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT) != 0;
+
+ if (state->single_line) {
+ // on windows, up&down in single-line behave like left&right
+ key = STB_TEXTEDIT_K_RIGHT | (key & STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT);
+ goto retry;
+ }
+
+ if (sel)
+ stb_textedit_prep_selection_at_cursor(state);
+ else if (STB_TEXT_HAS_SELECTION(state))
+ stb_textedit_move_to_last(str,state);
+
+ // compute current position of cursor point
+ stb_textedit_clamp(str, state);
+ stb_textedit_find_charpos(&find, str, state->cursor, state->single_line);
+
+ // now find character position down a row
+ if (find.length) {
+ float goal_x = state->has_preferred_x ? state->preferred_x : find.x;
+ float x;
+ int start = find.first_char + find.length;
+ state->cursor = start;
+ STB_TEXTEDIT_LAYOUTROW(&row, str, state->cursor);
+ x = row.x0;
+ for (i=0; i < row.num_chars; ++i) {
+ float dx = STB_TEXTEDIT_GETWIDTH(str, start, i);
+ #ifdef STB_TEXTEDIT_GETWIDTH_NEWLINE
+ if (dx == STB_TEXTEDIT_GETWIDTH_NEWLINE)
+ break;
+ #endif
+ x += dx;
+ if (x > goal_x)
+ break;
+ ++state->cursor;
+ }
+ stb_textedit_clamp(str, state);
+
+ state->has_preferred_x = 1;
+ state->preferred_x = goal_x;
+
+ if (sel)
+ state->select_end = state->cursor;
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+
+ case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_UP:
+ case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_UP | STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT: {
+ StbFindState find;
+ StbTexteditRow row;
+ int i, sel = (key & STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT) != 0;
+
+ if (state->single_line) {
+ // on windows, up&down become left&right
+ key = STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LEFT | (key & STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT);
+ goto retry;
+ }
+
+ if (sel)
+ stb_textedit_prep_selection_at_cursor(state);
+ else if (STB_TEXT_HAS_SELECTION(state))
+ stb_textedit_move_to_first(state);
+
+ // compute current position of cursor point
+ stb_textedit_clamp(str, state);
+ stb_textedit_find_charpos(&find, str, state->cursor, state->single_line);
+
+ // can only go up if there's a previous row
+ if (find.prev_first != find.first_char) {
+ // now find character position up a row
+ float goal_x = state->has_preferred_x ? state->preferred_x : find.x;
+ float x;
+ state->cursor = find.prev_first;
+ STB_TEXTEDIT_LAYOUTROW(&row, str, state->cursor);
+ x = row.x0;
+ for (i=0; i < row.num_chars; ++i) {
+ float dx = STB_TEXTEDIT_GETWIDTH(str, find.prev_first, i);
+ #ifdef STB_TEXTEDIT_GETWIDTH_NEWLINE
+ if (dx == STB_TEXTEDIT_GETWIDTH_NEWLINE)
+ break;
+ #endif
+ x += dx;
+ if (x > goal_x)
+ break;
+ ++state->cursor;
+ }
+ stb_textedit_clamp(str, state);
+
+ state->has_preferred_x = 1;
+ state->preferred_x = goal_x;
+
+ if (sel)
+ state->select_end = state->cursor;
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+
+ case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_DELETE:
+ case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_DELETE | STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT:
+ if (STB_TEXT_HAS_SELECTION(state))
+ stb_textedit_delete_selection(str, state);
+ else {
+ int n = STB_TEXTEDIT_STRINGLEN(str);
+ if (state->cursor < n)
+ stb_textedit_delete(str, state, state->cursor, 1);
+ }
+ state->has_preferred_x = 0;
+ break;
+
+ case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_BACKSPACE:
+ case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_BACKSPACE | STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT:
+ if (STB_TEXT_HAS_SELECTION(state))
+ stb_textedit_delete_selection(str, state);
+ else {
+ stb_textedit_clamp(str, state);
+ if (state->cursor > 0) {
+ stb_textedit_delete(str, state, state->cursor-1, 1);
+ --state->cursor;
+ }
+ }
+ state->has_preferred_x = 0;
+ break;
+
+#ifdef STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTSTART2
+ case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTSTART2:
+#endif
+ case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTSTART:
+ state->cursor = state->select_start = state->select_end = 0;
+ state->has_preferred_x = 0;
+ break;
+
+#ifdef STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTEND2
+ case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTEND2:
+#endif
+ case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTEND:
+ state->cursor = STB_TEXTEDIT_STRINGLEN(str);
+ state->select_start = state->select_end = 0;
+ state->has_preferred_x = 0;
+ break;
+
+#ifdef STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTSTART2
+ case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTSTART2 | STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT:
+#endif
+ case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTSTART | STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT:
+ stb_textedit_prep_selection_at_cursor(state);
+ state->cursor = state->select_end = 0;
+ state->has_preferred_x = 0;
+ break;
+
+#ifdef STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTEND2
+ case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTEND2 | STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT:
+#endif
+ case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTEND | STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT:
+ stb_textedit_prep_selection_at_cursor(state);
+ state->cursor = state->select_end = STB_TEXTEDIT_STRINGLEN(str);
+ state->has_preferred_x = 0;
+ break;
+
+
+#ifdef STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINESTART2
+ case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINESTART2:
+#endif
+ case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINESTART:
+ stb_textedit_clamp(str, state);
+ stb_textedit_move_to_first(state);
+ if (state->single_line)
+ state->cursor = 0;
+ else while (state->cursor > 0 && STB_TEXTEDIT_GETCHAR(str, state->cursor-1) != STB_TEXTEDIT_NEWLINE)
+ --state->cursor;
+ state->has_preferred_x = 0;
+ break;
+
+#ifdef STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINEEND2
+ case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINEEND2:
+#endif
+ case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINEEND: {
+ int n = STB_TEXTEDIT_STRINGLEN(str);
+ stb_textedit_clamp(str, state);
+ stb_textedit_move_to_first(state);
+ if (state->single_line)
+ state->cursor = n;
+ else while (state->cursor < n && STB_TEXTEDIT_GETCHAR(str, state->cursor) != STB_TEXTEDIT_NEWLINE)
+ ++state->cursor;
+ state->has_preferred_x = 0;
+ break;
+ }
+
+#ifdef STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINESTART2
+ case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINESTART2 | STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT:
+#endif
+ case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINESTART | STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT:
+ stb_textedit_clamp(str, state);
+ stb_textedit_prep_selection_at_cursor(state);
+ if (state->single_line)
+ state->cursor = 0;
+ else while (state->cursor > 0 && STB_TEXTEDIT_GETCHAR(str, state->cursor-1) != STB_TEXTEDIT_NEWLINE)
+ --state->cursor;
+ state->select_end = state->cursor;
+ state->has_preferred_x = 0;
+ break;
+
+#ifdef STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINEEND2
+ case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINEEND2 | STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT:
+#endif
+ case STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINEEND | STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT: {
+ int n = STB_TEXTEDIT_STRINGLEN(str);
+ stb_textedit_clamp(str, state);
+ stb_textedit_prep_selection_at_cursor(state);
+ if (state->single_line)
+ state->cursor = n;
+ else while (state->cursor < n && STB_TEXTEDIT_GETCHAR(str, state->cursor) != STB_TEXTEDIT_NEWLINE)
+ ++state->cursor;
+ state->select_end = state->cursor;
+ state->has_preferred_x = 0;
+ break;
+ }
+
+// @TODO:
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_PGUP - move cursor up a page
+// STB_TEXTEDIT_K_PGDOWN - move cursor down a page
+ }
+}
+
+/////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+//
+// Undo processing
+//
+// @OPTIMIZE: the undo/redo buffer should be circular
+
+static void stb_textedit_flush_redo(StbUndoState *state)
+{
+ state->redo_point = STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOSTATECOUNT;
+ state->redo_char_point = STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOCHARCOUNT;
+}
+
+// discard the oldest entry in the undo list
+static void stb_textedit_discard_undo(StbUndoState *state)
+{
+ if (state->undo_point > 0) {
+ // if the 0th undo state has characters, clean those up
+ if (state->undo_rec[0].char_storage >= 0) {
+ int n = state->undo_rec[0].insert_length, i;
+ // delete n characters from all other records
+ state->undo_char_point = state->undo_char_point - (short) n; // vsnet05
+ STB_TEXTEDIT_memmove(state->undo_char, state->undo_char + n, (size_t) ((size_t)state->undo_char_point*sizeof(STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE)));
+ for (i=0; i < state->undo_point; ++i)
+ if (state->undo_rec[i].char_storage >= 0)
+ state->undo_rec[i].char_storage = state->undo_rec[i].char_storage - (short) n; // vsnet05 // @OPTIMIZE: get rid of char_storage and infer it
+ }
+ --state->undo_point;
+ STB_TEXTEDIT_memmove(state->undo_rec, state->undo_rec+1, (size_t) ((size_t)state->undo_point*sizeof(state->undo_rec[0])));
+ }
+}
+
+// discard the oldest entry in the redo list--it's bad if this
+// ever happens, but because undo & redo have to store the actual
+// characters in different cases, the redo character buffer can
+// fill up even though the undo buffer didn't
+static void stb_textedit_discard_redo(StbUndoState *state)
+{
+ int k = STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOSTATECOUNT-1;
+
+ if (state->redo_point <= k) {
+ // if the k'th undo state has characters, clean those up
+ if (state->undo_rec[k].char_storage >= 0) {
+ int n = state->undo_rec[k].insert_length, i;
+ // delete n characters from all other records
+ state->redo_char_point = state->redo_char_point + (short) n; // vsnet05
+ STB_TEXTEDIT_memmove(state->undo_char + state->redo_char_point, state->undo_char + state->redo_char_point-n, (size_t) ((size_t)(STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOCHARCOUNT - state->redo_char_point)*sizeof(STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE)));
+ for (i=state->redo_point; i < k; ++i)
+ if (state->undo_rec[i].char_storage >= 0)
+ state->undo_rec[i].char_storage = state->undo_rec[i].char_storage + (short) n; // vsnet05
+ }
+ STB_TEXTEDIT_memmove(state->undo_rec + state->redo_point, state->undo_rec + state->redo_point-1, (size_t) ((size_t)(STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOSTATECOUNT - state->redo_point)*sizeof(state->undo_rec[0])));
+ ++state->redo_point;
+ }
+}
+
+static StbUndoRecord *stb_text_create_undo_record(StbUndoState *state, int numchars)
+{
+ // any time we create a new undo record, we discard redo
+ stb_textedit_flush_redo(state);
+
+ // if we have no free records, we have to make room, by sliding the
+ // existing records down
+ if (state->undo_point == STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOSTATECOUNT)
+ stb_textedit_discard_undo(state);
+
+ // if the characters to store won't possibly fit in the buffer, we can't undo
+ if (numchars > STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOCHARCOUNT) {
+ state->undo_point = 0;
+ state->undo_char_point = 0;
+ return NULL;
+ }
+
+ // if we don't have enough free characters in the buffer, we have to make room
+ while (state->undo_char_point + numchars > STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOCHARCOUNT)
+ stb_textedit_discard_undo(state);
+
+ return &state->undo_rec[state->undo_point++];
+}
+
+static STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE *stb_text_createundo(StbUndoState *state, int pos, int insert_len, int delete_len)
+{
+ StbUndoRecord *r = stb_text_create_undo_record(state, insert_len);
+ if (r == NULL)
+ return NULL;
+
+ r->where = pos;
+ r->insert_length = (short) insert_len;
+ r->delete_length = (short) delete_len;
+
+ if (insert_len == 0) {
+ r->char_storage = -1;
+ return NULL;
+ } else {
+ r->char_storage = state->undo_char_point;
+ state->undo_char_point = state->undo_char_point + (short) insert_len;
+ return &state->undo_char[r->char_storage];
+ }
+}
+
+static void stb_text_undo(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state)
+{
+ StbUndoState *s = &state->undostate;
+ StbUndoRecord u, *r;
+ if (s->undo_point == 0)
+ return;
+
+ // we need to do two things: apply the undo record, and create a redo record
+ u = s->undo_rec[s->undo_point-1];
+ r = &s->undo_rec[s->redo_point-1];
+ r->char_storage = -1;
+
+ r->insert_length = u.delete_length;
+ r->delete_length = u.insert_length;
+ r->where = u.where;
+
+ if (u.delete_length) {
+ // if the undo record says to delete characters, then the redo record will
+ // need to re-insert the characters that get deleted, so we need to store
+ // them.
+
+ // there are three cases:
+ // there's enough room to store the characters
+ // characters stored for *redoing* don't leave room for redo
+ // characters stored for *undoing* don't leave room for redo
+ // if the last is true, we have to bail
+
+ if (s->undo_char_point + u.delete_length >= STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOCHARCOUNT) {
+ // the undo records take up too much character space; there's no space to store the redo characters
+ r->insert_length = 0;
+ } else {
+ int i;
+
+ // there's definitely room to store the characters eventually
+ while (s->undo_char_point + u.delete_length > s->redo_char_point) {
+ // there's currently not enough room, so discard a redo record
+ stb_textedit_discard_redo(s);
+ // should never happen:
+ if (s->redo_point == STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOSTATECOUNT)
+ return;
+ }
+ r = &s->undo_rec[s->redo_point-1];
+
+ r->char_storage = s->redo_char_point - u.delete_length;
+ s->redo_char_point = s->redo_char_point - (short) u.delete_length;
+
+ // now save the characters
+ for (i=0; i < u.delete_length; ++i)
+ s->undo_char[r->char_storage + i] = STB_TEXTEDIT_GETCHAR(str, u.where + i);
+ }
+
+ // now we can carry out the deletion
+ STB_TEXTEDIT_DELETECHARS(str, u.where, u.delete_length);
+ }
+
+ // check type of recorded action:
+ if (u.insert_length) {
+ // easy case: was a deletion, so we need to insert n characters
+ STB_TEXTEDIT_INSERTCHARS(str, u.where, &s->undo_char[u.char_storage], u.insert_length);
+ s->undo_char_point -= u.insert_length;
+ }
+
+ state->cursor = u.where + u.insert_length;
+
+ s->undo_point--;
+ s->redo_point--;
+}
+
+static void stb_text_redo(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state)
+{
+ StbUndoState *s = &state->undostate;
+ StbUndoRecord *u, r;
+ if (s->redo_point == STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOSTATECOUNT)
+ return;
+
+ // we need to do two things: apply the redo record, and create an undo record
+ u = &s->undo_rec[s->undo_point];
+ r = s->undo_rec[s->redo_point];
+
+ // we KNOW there must be room for the undo record, because the redo record
+ // was derived from an undo record
+
+ u->delete_length = r.insert_length;
+ u->insert_length = r.delete_length;
+ u->where = r.where;
+ u->char_storage = -1;
+
+ if (r.delete_length) {
+ // the redo record requires us to delete characters, so the undo record
+ // needs to store the characters
+
+ if (s->undo_char_point + u->insert_length > s->redo_char_point) {
+ u->insert_length = 0;
+ u->delete_length = 0;
+ } else {
+ int i;
+ u->char_storage = s->undo_char_point;
+ s->undo_char_point = s->undo_char_point + u->insert_length;
+
+ // now save the characters
+ for (i=0; i < u->insert_length; ++i)
+ s->undo_char[u->char_storage + i] = STB_TEXTEDIT_GETCHAR(str, u->where + i);
+ }
+
+ STB_TEXTEDIT_DELETECHARS(str, r.where, r.delete_length);
+ }
+
+ if (r.insert_length) {
+ // easy case: need to insert n characters
+ STB_TEXTEDIT_INSERTCHARS(str, r.where, &s->undo_char[r.char_storage], r.insert_length);
+ s->redo_char_point += r.insert_length;
+ }
+
+ state->cursor = r.where + r.insert_length;
+
+ s->undo_point++;
+ s->redo_point++;
+}
+
+static void stb_text_makeundo_insert(STB_TexteditState *state, int where, int length)
+{
+ stb_text_createundo(&state->undostate, where, 0, length);
+}
+
+static void stb_text_makeundo_delete(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state, int where, int length)
+{
+ int i;
+ STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE *p = stb_text_createundo(&state->undostate, where, length, 0);
+ if (p) {
+ for (i=0; i < length; ++i)
+ p[i] = STB_TEXTEDIT_GETCHAR(str, where+i);
+ }
+}
+
+static void stb_text_makeundo_replace(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING *str, STB_TexteditState *state, int where, int old_length, int new_length)
+{
+ int i;
+ STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE *p = stb_text_createundo(&state->undostate, where, old_length, new_length);
+ if (p) {
+ for (i=0; i < old_length; ++i)
+ p[i] = STB_TEXTEDIT_GETCHAR(str, where+i);
+ }
+}
+
+// reset the state to default
+static void stb_textedit_clear_state(STB_TexteditState *state, int is_single_line)
+{
+ state->undostate.undo_point = 0;
+ state->undostate.undo_char_point = 0;
+ state->undostate.redo_point = STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOSTATECOUNT;
+ state->undostate.redo_char_point = STB_TEXTEDIT_UNDOCHARCOUNT;
+ state->select_end = state->select_start = 0;
+ state->cursor = 0;
+ state->has_preferred_x = 0;
+ state->preferred_x = 0;
+ state->cursor_at_end_of_line = 0;
+ state->initialized = 1;
+ state->single_line = (unsigned char) is_single_line;
+ state->insert_mode = 0;
+}
+
+// API initialize
+static void stb_textedit_initialize_state(STB_TexteditState *state, int is_single_line)
+{
+ stb_textedit_clear_state(state, is_single_line);
+}
+#endif//STB_TEXTEDIT_IMPLEMENTATION
diff --git a/depedencies/include/stb_truetype.h b/depedencies/include/stb_truetype.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..92b9a87
--- /dev/null
+++ b/depedencies/include/stb_truetype.h
@@ -0,0 +1,4018 @@
+// stb_truetype.h - v1.14 - public domain
+// authored from 2009-2016 by Sean Barrett / RAD Game Tools
+//
+// This library processes TrueType files:
+// parse files
+// extract glyph metrics
+// extract glyph shapes
+// render glyphs to one-channel bitmaps with antialiasing (box filter)
+//
+// Todo:
+// non-MS cmaps
+// crashproof on bad data
+// hinting? (no longer patented)
+// cleartype-style AA?
+// optimize: use simple memory allocator for intermediates
+// optimize: build edge-list directly from curves
+// optimize: rasterize directly from curves?
+//
+// ADDITIONAL CONTRIBUTORS
+//
+// Mikko Mononen: compound shape support, more cmap formats
+// Tor Andersson: kerning, subpixel rendering
+// Dougall Johnson: OpenType / Type 2 font handling
+//
+// Misc other:
+// Ryan Gordon
+// Simon Glass
+// github:IntellectualKitty
+//
+// Bug/warning reports/fixes:
+// "Zer" on mollyrocket (with fix)
+// Cass Everitt
+// stoiko (Haemimont Games)
+// Brian Hook
+// Walter van Niftrik
+// David Gow
+// David Given
+// Ivan-Assen Ivanov
+// Anthony Pesch
+// Johan Duparc
+// Hou Qiming
+// Fabian "ryg" Giesen
+// Martins Mozeiko
+// Cap Petschulat
+// Omar Cornut
+// github:aloucks
+// Peter LaValle
+// Sergey Popov
+// Giumo X. Clanjor
+// Higor Euripedes
+// Thomas Fields
+// Derek Vinyard
+//
+// VERSION HISTORY
+//
+// 1.13 (2017-01-02) support OpenType fonts, certain Apple fonts, num-fonts-in-TTC function
+// 1.12 (2016-10-25) suppress warnings about casting away const with -Wcast-qual
+// 1.11 (2016-04-02) fix unused-variable warning
+// 1.10 (2016-04-02) user-defined fabs(); rare memory leak; remove duplicate typedef
+// 1.09 (2016-01-16) warning fix; avoid crash on outofmem; use allocation userdata properly
+// 1.08 (2015-09-13) document stbtt_Rasterize(); fixes for vertical & horizontal edges
+// 1.07 (2015-08-01) allow PackFontRanges to accept arrays of sparse codepoints;
+// variant PackFontRanges to pack and render in separate phases;
+// fix stbtt_GetFontOFfsetForIndex (never worked for non-0 input?);
+// fixed an assert() bug in the new rasterizer
+// replace assert() with STBTT_assert() in new rasterizer
+//
+// Full history can be found at the end of this file.
+//
+// LICENSE
+//
+// This software is dual-licensed to the public domain and under the following
+// license: you are granted a perpetual, irrevocable license to copy, modify,
+// publish, and distribute this file as you see fit.
+//
+// USAGE
+//
+// Include this file in whatever places neeed to refer to it. In ONE C/C++
+// file, write:
+// #define STB_TRUETYPE_IMPLEMENTATION
+// before the #include of this file. This expands out the actual
+// implementation into that C/C++ file.
+//
+// To make the implementation private to the file that generates the implementation,
+// #define STBTT_STATIC
+//
+// Simple 3D API (don't ship this, but it's fine for tools and quick start)
+// stbtt_BakeFontBitmap() -- bake a font to a bitmap for use as texture
+// stbtt_GetBakedQuad() -- compute quad to draw for a given char
+//
+// Improved 3D API (more shippable):
+// #include "stb_rect_pack.h" -- optional, but you really want it
+// stbtt_PackBegin()
+// stbtt_PackSetOversample() -- for improved quality on small fonts
+// stbtt_PackFontRanges() -- pack and renders
+// stbtt_PackEnd()
+// stbtt_GetPackedQuad()
+//
+// "Load" a font file from a memory buffer (you have to keep the buffer loaded)
+// stbtt_InitFont()
+// stbtt_GetFontOffsetForIndex() -- indexing for TTC font collections
+// stbtt_GetNumberOfFonts() -- number of fonts for TTC font collections
+//
+// Render a unicode codepoint to a bitmap
+// stbtt_GetCodepointBitmap() -- allocates and returns a bitmap
+// stbtt_MakeCodepointBitmap() -- renders into bitmap you provide
+// stbtt_GetCodepointBitmapBox() -- how big the bitmap must be
+//
+// Character advance/positioning
+// stbtt_GetCodepointHMetrics()
+// stbtt_GetFontVMetrics()
+// stbtt_GetCodepointKernAdvance()
+//
+// Starting with version 1.06, the rasterizer was replaced with a new,
+// faster and generally-more-precise rasterizer. The new rasterizer more
+// accurately measures pixel coverage for anti-aliasing, except in the case
+// where multiple shapes overlap, in which case it overestimates the AA pixel
+// coverage. Thus, anti-aliasing of intersecting shapes may look wrong. If
+// this turns out to be a problem, you can re-enable the old rasterizer with
+// #define STBTT_RASTERIZER_VERSION 1
+// which will incur about a 15% speed hit.
+//
+// ADDITIONAL DOCUMENTATION
+//
+// Immediately after this block comment are a series of sample programs.
+//
+// After the sample programs is the "header file" section. This section
+// includes documentation for each API function.
+//
+// Some important concepts to understand to use this library:
+//
+// Codepoint
+// Characters are defined by unicode codepoints, e.g. 65 is
+// uppercase A, 231 is lowercase c with a cedilla, 0x7e30 is
+// the hiragana for "ma".
+//
+// Glyph
+// A visual character shape (every codepoint is rendered as
+// some glyph)
+//
+// Glyph index
+// A font-specific integer ID representing a glyph
+//
+// Baseline
+// Glyph shapes are defined relative to a baseline, which is the
+// bottom of uppercase characters. Characters extend both above
+// and below the baseline.
+//
+// Current Point
+// As you draw text to the screen, you keep track of a "current point"
+// which is the origin of each character. The current point's vertical
+// position is the baseline. Even "baked fonts" use this model.
+//
+// Vertical Font Metrics
+// The vertical qualities of the font, used to vertically position
+// and space the characters. See docs for stbtt_GetFontVMetrics.
+//
+// Font Size in Pixels or Points
+// The preferred interface for specifying font sizes in stb_truetype
+// is to specify how tall the font's vertical extent should be in pixels.
+// If that sounds good enough, skip the next paragraph.
+//
+// Most font APIs instead use "points", which are a common typographic
+// measurement for describing font size, defined as 72 points per inch.
+// stb_truetype provides a point API for compatibility. However, true
+// "per inch" conventions don't make much sense on computer displays
+// since they different monitors have different number of pixels per
+// inch. For example, Windows traditionally uses a convention that
+// there are 96 pixels per inch, thus making 'inch' measurements have
+// nothing to do with inches, and thus effectively defining a point to
+// be 1.333 pixels. Additionally, the TrueType font data provides
+// an explicit scale factor to scale a given font's glyphs to points,
+// but the author has observed that this scale factor is often wrong
+// for non-commercial fonts, thus making fonts scaled in points
+// according to the TrueType spec incoherently sized in practice.
+//
+// ADVANCED USAGE
+//
+// Quality:
+//
+// - Use the functions with Subpixel at the end to allow your characters
+// to have subpixel positioning. Since the font is anti-aliased, not
+// hinted, this is very import for quality. (This is not possible with
+// baked fonts.)
+//
+// - Kerning is now supported, and if you're supporting subpixel rendering
+// then kerning is worth using to give your text a polished look.
+//
+// Performance:
+//
+// - Convert Unicode codepoints to glyph indexes and operate on the glyphs;
+// if you don't do this, stb_truetype is forced to do the conversion on
+// every call.
+//
+// - There are a lot of memory allocations. We should modify it to take
+// a temp buffer and allocate from the temp buffer (without freeing),
+// should help performance a lot.
+//
+// NOTES
+//
+// The system uses the raw data found in the .ttf file without changing it
+// and without building auxiliary data structures. This is a bit inefficient
+// on little-endian systems (the data is big-endian), but assuming you're
+// caching the bitmaps or glyph shapes this shouldn't be a big deal.
+//
+// It appears to be very hard to programmatically determine what font a
+// given file is in a general way. I provide an API for this, but I don't
+// recommend it.
+//
+//
+// SOURCE STATISTICS (based on v0.6c, 2050 LOC)
+//
+// Documentation & header file 520 LOC \___ 660 LOC documentation
+// Sample code 140 LOC /
+// Truetype parsing 620 LOC ---- 620 LOC TrueType
+// Software rasterization 240 LOC \ .
+// Curve tesselation 120 LOC \__ 550 LOC Bitmap creation
+// Bitmap management 100 LOC /
+// Baked bitmap interface 70 LOC /
+// Font name matching & access 150 LOC ---- 150
+// C runtime library abstraction 60 LOC ---- 60
+//
+//
+// PERFORMANCE MEASUREMENTS FOR 1.06:
+//
+// 32-bit 64-bit
+// Previous release: 8.83 s 7.68 s
+// Pool allocations: 7.72 s 6.34 s
+// Inline sort : 6.54 s 5.65 s
+// New rasterizer : 5.63 s 5.00 s
+
+//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+////
+//// SAMPLE PROGRAMS
+////
+//
+// Incomplete text-in-3d-api example, which draws quads properly aligned to be lossless
+//
+#if 0
+#define STB_TRUETYPE_IMPLEMENTATION // force following include to generate implementation
+#include "stb_truetype.h"
+
+unsigned char ttf_buffer[1<<20];
+unsigned char temp_bitmap[512*512];
+
+stbtt_bakedchar cdata[96]; // ASCII 32..126 is 95 glyphs
+GLuint ftex;
+
+void my_stbtt_initfont(void)
+{
+ fread(ttf_buffer, 1, 1<<20, fopen("c:/windows/fonts/times.ttf", "rb"));
+ stbtt_BakeFontBitmap(ttf_buffer,0, 32.0, temp_bitmap,512,512, 32,96, cdata); // no guarantee this fits!
+ // can free ttf_buffer at this point
+ glGenTextures(1, &ftex);
+ glBindTexture(GL_TEXTURE_2D, ftex);
+ glTexImage2D(GL_TEXTURE_2D, 0, GL_ALPHA, 512,512, 0, GL_ALPHA, GL_UNSIGNED_BYTE, temp_bitmap);
+ // can free temp_bitmap at this point
+ glTexParameteri(GL_TEXTURE_2D, GL_TEXTURE_MIN_FILTER, GL_LINEAR);
+}
+
+void my_stbtt_print(float x, float y, char *text)
+{
+ // assume orthographic projection with units = screen pixels, origin at top left
+ glEnable(GL_TEXTURE_2D);
+ glBindTexture(GL_TEXTURE_2D, ftex);
+ glBegin(GL_QUADS);
+ while (*text) {
+ if (*text >= 32 && *text < 128) {
+ stbtt_aligned_quad q;
+ stbtt_GetBakedQuad(cdata, 512,512, *text-32, &x,&y,&q,1);//1=opengl & d3d10+,0=d3d9
+ glTexCoord2f(q.s0,q.t1); glVertex2f(q.x0,q.y0);
+ glTexCoord2f(q.s1,q.t1); glVertex2f(q.x1,q.y0);
+ glTexCoord2f(q.s1,q.t0); glVertex2f(q.x1,q.y1);
+ glTexCoord2f(q.s0,q.t0); glVertex2f(q.x0,q.y1);
+ }
+ ++text;
+ }
+ glEnd();
+}
+#endif
+//
+//
+//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+//
+// Complete program (this compiles): get a single bitmap, print as ASCII art
+//
+#if 0
+#include <stdio.h>
+#define STB_TRUETYPE_IMPLEMENTATION // force following include to generate implementation
+#include "stb_truetype.h"
+
+char ttf_buffer[1<<25];
+
+int main(int argc, char **argv)
+{
+ stbtt_fontinfo font;
+ unsigned char *bitmap;
+ int w,h,i,j,c = (argc > 1 ? atoi(argv[1]) : 'a'), s = (argc > 2 ? atoi(argv[2]) : 20);
+
+ fread(ttf_buffer, 1, 1<<25, fopen(argc > 3 ? argv[3] : "c:/windows/fonts/arialbd.ttf", "rb"));
+
+ stbtt_InitFont(&font, ttf_buffer, stbtt_GetFontOffsetForIndex(ttf_buffer,0));
+ bitmap = stbtt_GetCodepointBitmap(&font, 0,stbtt_ScaleForPixelHeight(&font, s), c, &w, &h, 0,0);
+
+ for (j=0; j < h; ++j) {
+ for (i=0; i < w; ++i)
+ putchar(" .:ioVM@"[bitmap[j*w+i]>>5]);
+ putchar('\n');
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+#endif
+//
+// Output:
+//
+// .ii.
+// @@@@@@.
+// V@Mio@@o
+// :i. V@V
+// :oM@@M
+// :@@@MM@M
+// @@o o@M
+// :@@. M@M
+// @@@o@@@@
+// :M@@V:@@.
+//
+//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+//
+// Complete program: print "Hello World!" banner, with bugs
+//
+#if 0
+char buffer[24<<20];
+unsigned char screen[20][79];
+
+int main(int arg, char **argv)
+{
+ stbtt_fontinfo font;
+ int i,j,ascent,baseline,ch=0;
+ float scale, xpos=2; // leave a little padding in case the character extends left
+ char *text = "Heljo World!"; // intentionally misspelled to show 'lj' brokenness
+
+ fread(buffer, 1, 1000000, fopen("c:/windows/fonts/arialbd.ttf", "rb"));
+ stbtt_InitFont(&font, buffer, 0);
+
+ scale = stbtt_ScaleForPixelHeight(&font, 15);
+ stbtt_GetFontVMetrics(&font, &ascent,0,0);
+ baseline = (int) (ascent*scale);
+
+ while (text[ch]) {
+ int advance,lsb,x0,y0,x1,y1;
+ float x_shift = xpos - (float) floor(xpos);
+ stbtt_GetCodepointHMetrics(&font, text[ch], &advance, &lsb);
+ stbtt_GetCodepointBitmapBoxSubpixel(&font, text[ch], scale,scale,x_shift,0, &x0,&y0,&x1,&y1);
+ stbtt_MakeCodepointBitmapSubpixel(&font, &screen[baseline + y0][(int) xpos + x0], x1-x0,y1-y0, 79, scale,scale,x_shift,0, text[ch]);
+ // note that this stomps the old data, so where character boxes overlap (e.g. 'lj') it's wrong
+ // because this API is really for baking character bitmaps into textures. if you want to render
+ // a sequence of characters, you really need to render each bitmap to a temp buffer, then
+ // "alpha blend" that into the working buffer
+ xpos += (advance * scale);
+ if (text[ch+1])
+ xpos += scale*stbtt_GetCodepointKernAdvance(&font, text[ch],text[ch+1]);
+ ++ch;
+ }
+
+ for (j=0; j < 20; ++j) {
+ for (i=0; i < 78; ++i)
+ putchar(" .:ioVM@"[screen[j][i]>>5]);
+ putchar('\n');
+ }
+
+ return 0;
+}
+#endif
+
+
+//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+////
+//// INTEGRATION WITH YOUR CODEBASE
+////
+//// The following sections allow you to supply alternate definitions
+//// of C library functions used by stb_truetype.
+
+#ifdef STB_TRUETYPE_IMPLEMENTATION
+ // #define your own (u)stbtt_int8/16/32 before including to override this
+ #ifndef stbtt_uint8
+ typedef unsigned char stbtt_uint8;
+ typedef signed char stbtt_int8;
+ typedef unsigned short stbtt_uint16;
+ typedef signed short stbtt_int16;
+ typedef unsigned int stbtt_uint32;
+ typedef signed int stbtt_int32;
+ #endif
+
+ typedef char stbtt__check_size32[sizeof(stbtt_int32)==4 ? 1 : -1];
+ typedef char stbtt__check_size16[sizeof(stbtt_int16)==2 ? 1 : -1];
+
+ // #define your own STBTT_ifloor/STBTT_iceil() to avoid math.h
+ #ifndef STBTT_ifloor
+ #include <math.h>
+ #define STBTT_ifloor(x) ((int) floor(x))
+ #define STBTT_iceil(x) ((int) ceil(x))
+ #endif
+
+ #ifndef STBTT_sqrt
+ #include <math.h>
+ #define STBTT_sqrt(x) sqrt(x)
+ #endif
+
+ #ifndef STBTT_fabs
+ #include <math.h>
+ #define STBTT_fabs(x) fabs(x)
+ #endif
+
+ // #define your own functions "STBTT_malloc" / "STBTT_free" to avoid malloc.h
+ #ifndef STBTT_malloc
+ #include <stdlib.h>
+ #define STBTT_malloc(x,u) ((void)(u),malloc(x))
+ #define STBTT_free(x,u) ((void)(u),free(x))
+ #endif
+
+ #ifndef STBTT_assert
+ #include <assert.h>
+ #define STBTT_assert(x) assert(x)
+ #endif
+
+ #ifndef STBTT_strlen
+ #include <string.h>
+ #define STBTT_strlen(x) strlen(x)
+ #endif
+
+ #ifndef STBTT_memcpy
+ #include <memory.h>
+ #define STBTT_memcpy memcpy
+ #define STBTT_memset memset
+ #endif
+#endif
+
+///////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+///////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+////
+//// INTERFACE
+////
+////
+
+#ifndef __STB_INCLUDE_STB_TRUETYPE_H__
+#define __STB_INCLUDE_STB_TRUETYPE_H__
+
+#ifdef STBTT_STATIC
+#define STBTT_DEF static
+#else
+#define STBTT_DEF extern
+#endif
+
+#ifdef __cplusplus
+extern "C" {
+#endif
+
+// private structure
+typedef struct
+{
+ unsigned char *data;
+ int cursor;
+ int size;
+} stbtt__buf;
+
+//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+//
+// TEXTURE BAKING API
+//
+// If you use this API, you only have to call two functions ever.
+//
+
+typedef struct
+{
+ unsigned short x0,y0,x1,y1; // coordinates of bbox in bitmap
+ float xoff,yoff,xadvance;
+} stbtt_bakedchar;
+
+STBTT_DEF int stbtt_BakeFontBitmap(const unsigned char *data, int offset, // font location (use offset=0 for plain .ttf)
+ float pixel_height, // height of font in pixels
+ unsigned char *pixels, int pw, int ph, // bitmap to be filled in
+ int first_char, int num_chars, // characters to bake
+ stbtt_bakedchar *chardata); // you allocate this, it's num_chars long
+// if return is positive, the first unused row of the bitmap
+// if return is negative, returns the negative of the number of characters that fit
+// if return is 0, no characters fit and no rows were used
+// This uses a very crappy packing.
+
+typedef struct
+{
+ float x0,y0,s0,t0; // top-left
+ float x1,y1,s1,t1; // bottom-right
+} stbtt_aligned_quad;
+
+STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetBakedQuad(stbtt_bakedchar *chardata, int pw, int ph, // same data as above
+ int char_index, // character to display
+ float *xpos, float *ypos, // pointers to current position in screen pixel space
+ stbtt_aligned_quad *q, // output: quad to draw
+ int opengl_fillrule); // true if opengl fill rule; false if DX9 or earlier
+// Call GetBakedQuad with char_index = 'character - first_char', and it
+// creates the quad you need to draw and advances the current position.
+//
+// The coordinate system used assumes y increases downwards.
+//
+// Characters will extend both above and below the current position;
+// see discussion of "BASELINE" above.
+//
+// It's inefficient; you might want to c&p it and optimize it.
+
+
+
+//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+//
+// NEW TEXTURE BAKING API
+//
+// This provides options for packing multiple fonts into one atlas, not
+// perfectly but better than nothing.
+
+typedef struct
+{
+ unsigned short x0,y0,x1,y1; // coordinates of bbox in bitmap
+ float xoff,yoff,xadvance;
+ float xoff2,yoff2;
+} stbtt_packedchar;
+
+typedef struct stbtt_pack_context stbtt_pack_context;
+typedef struct stbtt_fontinfo stbtt_fontinfo;
+#ifndef STB_RECT_PACK_VERSION
+typedef struct stbrp_rect stbrp_rect;
+#endif
+
+STBTT_DEF int stbtt_PackBegin(stbtt_pack_context *spc, unsigned char *pixels, int width, int height, int stride_in_bytes, int padding, void *alloc_context);
+// Initializes a packing context stored in the passed-in stbtt_pack_context.
+// Future calls using this context will pack characters into the bitmap passed
+// in here: a 1-channel bitmap that is width * height. stride_in_bytes is
+// the distance from one row to the next (or 0 to mean they are packed tightly
+// together). "padding" is the amount of padding to leave between each
+// character (normally you want '1' for bitmaps you'll use as textures with
+// bilinear filtering).
+//
+// Returns 0 on failure, 1 on success.
+
+STBTT_DEF void stbtt_PackEnd (stbtt_pack_context *spc);
+// Cleans up the packing context and frees all memory.
+
+#define STBTT_POINT_SIZE(x) (-(x))
+
+STBTT_DEF int stbtt_PackFontRange(stbtt_pack_context *spc, unsigned char *fontdata, int font_index, float font_size,
+ int first_unicode_char_in_range, int num_chars_in_range, stbtt_packedchar *chardata_for_range);
+// Creates character bitmaps from the font_index'th font found in fontdata (use
+// font_index=0 if you don't know what that is). It creates num_chars_in_range
+// bitmaps for characters with unicode values starting at first_unicode_char_in_range
+// and increasing. Data for how to render them is stored in chardata_for_range;
+// pass these to stbtt_GetPackedQuad to get back renderable quads.
+//
+// font_size is the full height of the character from ascender to descender,
+// as computed by stbtt_ScaleForPixelHeight. To use a point size as computed
+// by stbtt_ScaleForMappingEmToPixels, wrap the point size in STBTT_POINT_SIZE()
+// and pass that result as 'font_size':
+// ..., 20 , ... // font max minus min y is 20 pixels tall
+// ..., STBTT_POINT_SIZE(20), ... // 'M' is 20 pixels tall
+
+typedef struct
+{
+ float font_size;
+ int first_unicode_codepoint_in_range; // if non-zero, then the chars are continuous, and this is the first codepoint
+ int *array_of_unicode_codepoints; // if non-zero, then this is an array of unicode codepoints
+ int num_chars;
+ stbtt_packedchar *chardata_for_range; // output
+ unsigned char h_oversample, v_oversample; // don't set these, they're used internally
+} stbtt_pack_range;
+
+STBTT_DEF int stbtt_PackFontRanges(stbtt_pack_context *spc, unsigned char *fontdata, int font_index, stbtt_pack_range *ranges, int num_ranges);
+// Creates character bitmaps from multiple ranges of characters stored in
+// ranges. This will usually create a better-packed bitmap than multiple
+// calls to stbtt_PackFontRange. Note that you can call this multiple
+// times within a single PackBegin/PackEnd.
+
+STBTT_DEF void stbtt_PackSetOversampling(stbtt_pack_context *spc, unsigned int h_oversample, unsigned int v_oversample);
+// Oversampling a font increases the quality by allowing higher-quality subpixel
+// positioning, and is especially valuable at smaller text sizes.
+//
+// This function sets the amount of oversampling for all following calls to
+// stbtt_PackFontRange(s) or stbtt_PackFontRangesGatherRects for a given
+// pack context. The default (no oversampling) is achieved by h_oversample=1
+// and v_oversample=1. The total number of pixels required is
+// h_oversample*v_oversample larger than the default; for example, 2x2
+// oversampling requires 4x the storage of 1x1. For best results, render
+// oversampled textures with bilinear filtering. Look at the readme in
+// stb/tests/oversample for information about oversampled fonts
+//
+// To use with PackFontRangesGather etc., you must set it before calls
+// call to PackFontRangesGatherRects.
+
+STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetPackedQuad(stbtt_packedchar *chardata, int pw, int ph, // same data as above
+ int char_index, // character to display
+ float *xpos, float *ypos, // pointers to current position in screen pixel space
+ stbtt_aligned_quad *q, // output: quad to draw
+ int align_to_integer);
+
+STBTT_DEF int stbtt_PackFontRangesGatherRects(stbtt_pack_context *spc, const stbtt_fontinfo *info, stbtt_pack_range *ranges, int num_ranges, stbrp_rect *rects);
+STBTT_DEF void stbtt_PackFontRangesPackRects(stbtt_pack_context *spc, stbrp_rect *rects, int num_rects);
+STBTT_DEF int stbtt_PackFontRangesRenderIntoRects(stbtt_pack_context *spc, const stbtt_fontinfo *info, stbtt_pack_range *ranges, int num_ranges, stbrp_rect *rects);
+// Calling these functions in sequence is roughly equivalent to calling
+// stbtt_PackFontRanges(). If you more control over the packing of multiple
+// fonts, or if you want to pack custom data into a font texture, take a look
+// at the source to of stbtt_PackFontRanges() and create a custom version
+// using these functions, e.g. call GatherRects multiple times,
+// building up a single array of rects, then call PackRects once,
+// then call RenderIntoRects repeatedly. This may result in a
+// better packing than calling PackFontRanges multiple times
+// (or it may not).
+
+// this is an opaque structure that you shouldn't mess with which holds
+// all the context needed from PackBegin to PackEnd.
+struct stbtt_pack_context {
+ void *user_allocator_context;
+ void *pack_info;
+ int width;
+ int height;
+ int stride_in_bytes;
+ int padding;
+ unsigned int h_oversample, v_oversample;
+ unsigned char *pixels;
+ void *nodes;
+};
+
+//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+//
+// FONT LOADING
+//
+//
+
+STBTT_DEF int stbtt_GetNumberOfFonts(const unsigned char *data);
+// This function will determine the number of fonts in a font file. TrueType
+// collection (.ttc) files may contain multiple fonts, while TrueType font
+// (.ttf) files only contain one font. The number of fonts can be used for
+// indexing with the previous function where the index is between zero and one
+// less than the total fonts. If an error occurs, -1 is returned.
+
+STBTT_DEF int stbtt_GetFontOffsetForIndex(const unsigned char *data, int index);
+// Each .ttf/.ttc file may have more than one font. Each font has a sequential
+// index number starting from 0. Call this function to get the font offset for
+// a given index; it returns -1 if the index is out of range. A regular .ttf
+// file will only define one font and it always be at offset 0, so it will
+// return '0' for index 0, and -1 for all other indices.
+
+// The following structure is defined publically so you can declare one on
+// the stack or as a global or etc, but you should treat it as opaque.
+struct stbtt_fontinfo
+{
+ void * userdata;
+ unsigned char * data; // pointer to .ttf file
+ int fontstart; // offset of start of font
+
+ int numGlyphs; // number of glyphs, needed for range checking
+
+ int loca,head,glyf,hhea,hmtx,kern; // table locations as offset from start of .ttf
+ int index_map; // a cmap mapping for our chosen character encoding
+ int indexToLocFormat; // format needed to map from glyph index to glyph
+
+ stbtt__buf cff; // cff font data
+ stbtt__buf charstrings; // the charstring index
+ stbtt__buf gsubrs; // global charstring subroutines index
+ stbtt__buf subrs; // private charstring subroutines index
+ stbtt__buf fontdicts; // array of font dicts
+ stbtt__buf fdselect; // map from glyph to fontdict
+};
+
+STBTT_DEF int stbtt_InitFont(stbtt_fontinfo *info, const unsigned char *data, int offset);
+// Given an offset into the file that defines a font, this function builds
+// the necessary cached info for the rest of the system. You must allocate
+// the stbtt_fontinfo yourself, and stbtt_InitFont will fill it out. You don't
+// need to do anything special to free it, because the contents are pure
+// value data with no additional data structures. Returns 0 on failure.
+
+
+//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+//
+// CHARACTER TO GLYPH-INDEX CONVERSIOn
+
+STBTT_DEF int stbtt_FindGlyphIndex(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int unicode_codepoint);
+// If you're going to perform multiple operations on the same character
+// and you want a speed-up, call this function with the character you're
+// going to process, then use glyph-based functions instead of the
+// codepoint-based functions.
+
+
+//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+//
+// CHARACTER PROPERTIES
+//
+
+STBTT_DEF float stbtt_ScaleForPixelHeight(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, float pixels);
+// computes a scale factor to produce a font whose "height" is 'pixels' tall.
+// Height is measured as the distance from the highest ascender to the lowest
+// descender; in other words, it's equivalent to calling stbtt_GetFontVMetrics
+// and computing:
+// scale = pixels / (ascent - descent)
+// so if you prefer to measure height by the ascent only, use a similar calculation.
+
+STBTT_DEF float stbtt_ScaleForMappingEmToPixels(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, float pixels);
+// computes a scale factor to produce a font whose EM size is mapped to
+// 'pixels' tall. This is probably what traditional APIs compute, but
+// I'm not positive.
+
+STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetFontVMetrics(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int *ascent, int *descent, int *lineGap);
+// ascent is the coordinate above the baseline the font extends; descent
+// is the coordinate below the baseline the font extends (i.e. it is typically negative)
+// lineGap is the spacing between one row's descent and the next row's ascent...
+// so you should advance the vertical position by "*ascent - *descent + *lineGap"
+// these are expressed in unscaled coordinates, so you must multiply by
+// the scale factor for a given size
+
+STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetFontBoundingBox(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int *x0, int *y0, int *x1, int *y1);
+// the bounding box around all possible characters
+
+STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetCodepointHMetrics(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int codepoint, int *advanceWidth, int *leftSideBearing);
+// leftSideBearing is the offset from the current horizontal position to the left edge of the character
+// advanceWidth is the offset from the current horizontal position to the next horizontal position
+// these are expressed in unscaled coordinates
+
+STBTT_DEF int stbtt_GetCodepointKernAdvance(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int ch1, int ch2);
+// an additional amount to add to the 'advance' value between ch1 and ch2
+
+STBTT_DEF int stbtt_GetCodepointBox(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int codepoint, int *x0, int *y0, int *x1, int *y1);
+// Gets the bounding box of the visible part of the glyph, in unscaled coordinates
+
+STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetGlyphHMetrics(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int glyph_index, int *advanceWidth, int *leftSideBearing);
+STBTT_DEF int stbtt_GetGlyphKernAdvance(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int glyph1, int glyph2);
+STBTT_DEF int stbtt_GetGlyphBox(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int glyph_index, int *x0, int *y0, int *x1, int *y1);
+// as above, but takes one or more glyph indices for greater efficiency
+
+
+//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+//
+// GLYPH SHAPES (you probably don't need these, but they have to go before
+// the bitmaps for C declaration-order reasons)
+//
+
+#ifndef STBTT_vmove // you can predefine these to use different values (but why?)
+ enum {
+ STBTT_vmove=1,
+ STBTT_vline,
+ STBTT_vcurve,
+ STBTT_vcubic
+ };
+#endif
+
+#ifndef stbtt_vertex // you can predefine this to use different values
+ // (we share this with other code at RAD)
+ #define stbtt_vertex_type short // can't use stbtt_int16 because that's not visible in the header file
+ typedef struct
+ {
+ stbtt_vertex_type x,y,cx,cy,cx1,cy1;
+ unsigned char type,padding;
+ } stbtt_vertex;
+#endif
+
+STBTT_DEF int stbtt_IsGlyphEmpty(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int glyph_index);
+// returns non-zero if nothing is drawn for this glyph
+
+STBTT_DEF int stbtt_GetCodepointShape(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int unicode_codepoint, stbtt_vertex **vertices);
+STBTT_DEF int stbtt_GetGlyphShape(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int glyph_index, stbtt_vertex **vertices);
+// returns # of vertices and fills *vertices with the pointer to them
+// these are expressed in "unscaled" coordinates
+//
+// The shape is a series of countours. Each one starts with
+// a STBTT_moveto, then consists of a series of mixed
+// STBTT_lineto and STBTT_curveto segments. A lineto
+// draws a line from previous endpoint to its x,y; a curveto
+// draws a quadratic bezier from previous endpoint to
+// its x,y, using cx,cy as the bezier control point.
+
+STBTT_DEF void stbtt_FreeShape(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, stbtt_vertex *vertices);
+// frees the data allocated above
+
+//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+//
+// BITMAP RENDERING
+//
+
+STBTT_DEF void stbtt_FreeBitmap(unsigned char *bitmap, void *userdata);
+// frees the bitmap allocated below
+
+STBTT_DEF unsigned char *stbtt_GetCodepointBitmap(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, float scale_x, float scale_y, int codepoint, int *width, int *height, int *xoff, int *yoff);
+// allocates a large-enough single-channel 8bpp bitmap and renders the
+// specified character/glyph at the specified scale into it, with
+// antialiasing. 0 is no coverage (transparent), 255 is fully covered (opaque).
+// *width & *height are filled out with the width & height of the bitmap,
+// which is stored left-to-right, top-to-bottom.
+//
+// xoff/yoff are the offset it pixel space from the glyph origin to the top-left of the bitmap
+
+STBTT_DEF unsigned char *stbtt_GetCodepointBitmapSubpixel(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, float scale_x, float scale_y, float shift_x, float shift_y, int codepoint, int *width, int *height, int *xoff, int *yoff);
+// the same as stbtt_GetCodepoitnBitmap, but you can specify a subpixel
+// shift for the character
+
+STBTT_DEF void stbtt_MakeCodepointBitmap(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, unsigned char *output, int out_w, int out_h, int out_stride, float scale_x, float scale_y, int codepoint);
+// the same as stbtt_GetCodepointBitmap, but you pass in storage for the bitmap
+// in the form of 'output', with row spacing of 'out_stride' bytes. the bitmap
+// is clipped to out_w/out_h bytes. Call stbtt_GetCodepointBitmapBox to get the
+// width and height and positioning info for it first.
+
+STBTT_DEF void stbtt_MakeCodepointBitmapSubpixel(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, unsigned char *output, int out_w, int out_h, int out_stride, float scale_x, float scale_y, float shift_x, float shift_y, int codepoint);
+// same as stbtt_MakeCodepointBitmap, but you can specify a subpixel
+// shift for the character
+
+STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetCodepointBitmapBox(const stbtt_fontinfo *font, int codepoint, float scale_x, float scale_y, int *ix0, int *iy0, int *ix1, int *iy1);
+// get the bbox of the bitmap centered around the glyph origin; so the
+// bitmap width is ix1-ix0, height is iy1-iy0, and location to place
+// the bitmap top left is (leftSideBearing*scale,iy0).
+// (Note that the bitmap uses y-increases-down, but the shape uses
+// y-increases-up, so CodepointBitmapBox and CodepointBox are inverted.)
+
+STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetCodepointBitmapBoxSubpixel(const stbtt_fontinfo *font, int codepoint, float scale_x, float scale_y, float shift_x, float shift_y, int *ix0, int *iy0, int *ix1, int *iy1);
+// same as stbtt_GetCodepointBitmapBox, but you can specify a subpixel
+// shift for the character
+
+// the following functions are equivalent to the above functions, but operate
+// on glyph indices instead of Unicode codepoints (for efficiency)
+STBTT_DEF unsigned char *stbtt_GetGlyphBitmap(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, float scale_x, float scale_y, int glyph, int *width, int *height, int *xoff, int *yoff);
+STBTT_DEF unsigned char *stbtt_GetGlyphBitmapSubpixel(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, float scale_x, float scale_y, float shift_x, float shift_y, int glyph, int *width, int *height, int *xoff, int *yoff);
+STBTT_DEF void stbtt_MakeGlyphBitmap(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, unsigned char *output, int out_w, int out_h, int out_stride, float scale_x, float scale_y, int glyph);
+STBTT_DEF void stbtt_MakeGlyphBitmapSubpixel(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, unsigned char *output, int out_w, int out_h, int out_stride, float scale_x, float scale_y, float shift_x, float shift_y, int glyph);
+STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetGlyphBitmapBox(const stbtt_fontinfo *font, int glyph, float scale_x, float scale_y, int *ix0, int *iy0, int *ix1, int *iy1);
+STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetGlyphBitmapBoxSubpixel(const stbtt_fontinfo *font, int glyph, float scale_x, float scale_y,float shift_x, float shift_y, int *ix0, int *iy0, int *ix1, int *iy1);
+
+
+// @TODO: don't expose this structure
+typedef struct
+{
+ int w,h,stride;
+ unsigned char *pixels;
+} stbtt__bitmap;
+
+// rasterize a shape with quadratic beziers into a bitmap
+STBTT_DEF void stbtt_Rasterize(stbtt__bitmap *result, // 1-channel bitmap to draw into
+ float flatness_in_pixels, // allowable error of curve in pixels
+ stbtt_vertex *vertices, // array of vertices defining shape
+ int num_verts, // number of vertices in above array
+ float scale_x, float scale_y, // scale applied to input vertices
+ float shift_x, float shift_y, // translation applied to input vertices
+ int x_off, int y_off, // another translation applied to input
+ int invert, // if non-zero, vertically flip shape
+ void *userdata); // context for to STBTT_MALLOC
+
+//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+//
+// Finding the right font...
+//
+// You should really just solve this offline, keep your own tables
+// of what font is what, and don't try to get it out of the .ttf file.
+// That's because getting it out of the .ttf file is really hard, because
+// the names in the file can appear in many possible encodings, in many
+// possible languages, and e.g. if you need a case-insensitive comparison,
+// the details of that depend on the encoding & language in a complex way
+// (actually underspecified in truetype, but also gigantic).
+//
+// But you can use the provided functions in two possible ways:
+// stbtt_FindMatchingFont() will use *case-sensitive* comparisons on
+// unicode-encoded names to try to find the font you want;
+// you can run this before calling stbtt_InitFont()
+//
+// stbtt_GetFontNameString() lets you get any of the various strings
+// from the file yourself and do your own comparisons on them.
+// You have to have called stbtt_InitFont() first.
+
+
+STBTT_DEF int stbtt_FindMatchingFont(const unsigned char *fontdata, const char *name, int flags);
+// returns the offset (not index) of the font that matches, or -1 if none
+// if you use STBTT_MACSTYLE_DONTCARE, use a font name like "Arial Bold".
+// if you use any other flag, use a font name like "Arial"; this checks
+// the 'macStyle' header field; i don't know if fonts set this consistently
+#define STBTT_MACSTYLE_DONTCARE 0
+#define STBTT_MACSTYLE_BOLD 1
+#define STBTT_MACSTYLE_ITALIC 2
+#define STBTT_MACSTYLE_UNDERSCORE 4
+#define STBTT_MACSTYLE_NONE 8 // <= not same as 0, this makes us check the bitfield is 0
+
+STBTT_DEF int stbtt_CompareUTF8toUTF16_bigendian(const char *s1, int len1, const char *s2, int len2);
+// returns 1/0 whether the first string interpreted as utf8 is identical to
+// the second string interpreted as big-endian utf16... useful for strings from next func
+
+STBTT_DEF const char *stbtt_GetFontNameString(const stbtt_fontinfo *font, int *length, int platformID, int encodingID, int languageID, int nameID);
+// returns the string (which may be big-endian double byte, e.g. for unicode)
+// and puts the length in bytes in *length.
+//
+// some of the values for the IDs are below; for more see the truetype spec:
+// http://developer.apple.com/textfonts/TTRefMan/RM06/Chap6name.html
+// http://www.microsoft.com/typography/otspec/name.htm
+
+enum { // platformID
+ STBTT_PLATFORM_ID_UNICODE =0,
+ STBTT_PLATFORM_ID_MAC =1,
+ STBTT_PLATFORM_ID_ISO =2,
+ STBTT_PLATFORM_ID_MICROSOFT =3
+};
+
+enum { // encodingID for STBTT_PLATFORM_ID_UNICODE
+ STBTT_UNICODE_EID_UNICODE_1_0 =0,
+ STBTT_UNICODE_EID_UNICODE_1_1 =1,
+ STBTT_UNICODE_EID_ISO_10646 =2,
+ STBTT_UNICODE_EID_UNICODE_2_0_BMP=3,
+ STBTT_UNICODE_EID_UNICODE_2_0_FULL=4
+};
+
+enum { // encodingID for STBTT_PLATFORM_ID_MICROSOFT
+ STBTT_MS_EID_SYMBOL =0,
+ STBTT_MS_EID_UNICODE_BMP =1,
+ STBTT_MS_EID_SHIFTJIS =2,
+ STBTT_MS_EID_UNICODE_FULL =10
+};
+
+enum { // encodingID for STBTT_PLATFORM_ID_MAC; same as Script Manager codes
+ STBTT_MAC_EID_ROMAN =0, STBTT_MAC_EID_ARABIC =4,
+ STBTT_MAC_EID_JAPANESE =1, STBTT_MAC_EID_HEBREW =5,
+ STBTT_MAC_EID_CHINESE_TRAD =2, STBTT_MAC_EID_GREEK =6,
+ STBTT_MAC_EID_KOREAN =3, STBTT_MAC_EID_RUSSIAN =7
+};
+
+enum { // languageID for STBTT_PLATFORM_ID_MICROSOFT; same as LCID...
+ // problematic because there are e.g. 16 english LCIDs and 16 arabic LCIDs
+ STBTT_MS_LANG_ENGLISH =0x0409, STBTT_MS_LANG_ITALIAN =0x0410,
+ STBTT_MS_LANG_CHINESE =0x0804, STBTT_MS_LANG_JAPANESE =0x0411,
+ STBTT_MS_LANG_DUTCH =0x0413, STBTT_MS_LANG_KOREAN =0x0412,
+ STBTT_MS_LANG_FRENCH =0x040c, STBTT_MS_LANG_RUSSIAN =0x0419,
+ STBTT_MS_LANG_GERMAN =0x0407, STBTT_MS_LANG_SPANISH =0x0409,
+ STBTT_MS_LANG_HEBREW =0x040d, STBTT_MS_LANG_SWEDISH =0x041D
+};
+
+enum { // languageID for STBTT_PLATFORM_ID_MAC
+ STBTT_MAC_LANG_ENGLISH =0 , STBTT_MAC_LANG_JAPANESE =11,
+ STBTT_MAC_LANG_ARABIC =12, STBTT_MAC_LANG_KOREAN =23,
+ STBTT_MAC_LANG_DUTCH =4 , STBTT_MAC_LANG_RUSSIAN =32,
+ STBTT_MAC_LANG_FRENCH =1 , STBTT_MAC_LANG_SPANISH =6 ,
+ STBTT_MAC_LANG_GERMAN =2 , STBTT_MAC_LANG_SWEDISH =5 ,
+ STBTT_MAC_LANG_HEBREW =10, STBTT_MAC_LANG_CHINESE_SIMPLIFIED =33,
+ STBTT_MAC_LANG_ITALIAN =3 , STBTT_MAC_LANG_CHINESE_TRAD =19
+};
+
+#ifdef __cplusplus
+}
+#endif
+
+#endif // __STB_INCLUDE_STB_TRUETYPE_H__
+
+///////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+///////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+////
+//// IMPLEMENTATION
+////
+////
+
+#ifdef STB_TRUETYPE_IMPLEMENTATION
+
+#ifndef STBTT_MAX_OVERSAMPLE
+#define STBTT_MAX_OVERSAMPLE 8
+#endif
+
+#if STBTT_MAX_OVERSAMPLE > 255
+#error "STBTT_MAX_OVERSAMPLE cannot be > 255"
+#endif
+
+typedef int stbtt__test_oversample_pow2[(STBTT_MAX_OVERSAMPLE & (STBTT_MAX_OVERSAMPLE-1)) == 0 ? 1 : -1];
+
+#ifndef STBTT_RASTERIZER_VERSION
+#define STBTT_RASTERIZER_VERSION 2
+#endif
+
+#ifdef _MSC_VER
+#define STBTT__NOTUSED(v) (void)(v)
+#else
+#define STBTT__NOTUSED(v) (void)sizeof(v)
+#endif
+
+//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+//
+// stbtt__buf helpers to parse data from file
+//
+
+static stbtt_uint8 stbtt__buf_get8(stbtt__buf *b)
+{
+ if (b->cursor >= b->size)
+ return 0;
+ return b->data[b->cursor++];
+}
+
+static stbtt_uint8 stbtt__buf_peek8(stbtt__buf *b)
+{
+ if (b->cursor >= b->size)
+ return 0;
+ return b->data[b->cursor];
+}
+
+static void stbtt__buf_seek(stbtt__buf *b, int o)
+{
+ STBTT_assert(!(o > b->size || o < 0));
+ b->cursor = (o > b->size || o < 0) ? b->size : o;
+}
+
+static void stbtt__buf_skip(stbtt__buf *b, int o)
+{
+ stbtt__buf_seek(b, b->cursor + o);
+}
+
+static stbtt_uint32 stbtt__buf_get(stbtt__buf *b, int n)
+{
+ stbtt_uint32 v = 0;
+ int i;
+ STBTT_assert(n >= 1 && n <= 4);
+ for (i = 0; i < n; i++)
+ v = (v << 8) | stbtt__buf_get8(b);
+ return v;
+}
+
+static stbtt__buf stbtt__new_buf(const void *p, size_t size)
+{
+ stbtt__buf r;
+ STBTT_assert(size < 0x40000000);
+ r.data = (stbtt_uint8*) p;
+ r.size = (int) size;
+ r.cursor = 0;
+ return r;
+}
+
+#define stbtt__buf_get16(b) stbtt__buf_get((b), 2)
+#define stbtt__buf_get32(b) stbtt__buf_get((b), 4)
+
+static stbtt__buf stbtt__buf_range(const stbtt__buf *b, int o, int s)
+{
+ stbtt__buf r = stbtt__new_buf(NULL, 0);
+ if (o < 0 || s < 0 || o > b->size || s > b->size - o) return r;
+ r.data = b->data + o;
+ r.size = s;
+ return r;
+}
+
+static stbtt__buf stbtt__cff_get_index(stbtt__buf *b)
+{
+ int count, start, offsize;
+ start = b->cursor;
+ count = stbtt__buf_get16(b);
+ if (count) {
+ offsize = stbtt__buf_get8(b);
+ STBTT_assert(offsize >= 1 && offsize <= 4);
+ stbtt__buf_skip(b, offsize * count);
+ stbtt__buf_skip(b, stbtt__buf_get(b, offsize) - 1);
+ }
+ return stbtt__buf_range(b, start, b->cursor - start);
+}
+
+static stbtt_uint32 stbtt__cff_int(stbtt__buf *b)
+{
+ int b0 = stbtt__buf_get8(b);
+ if (b0 >= 32 && b0 <= 246) return b0 - 139;
+ else if (b0 >= 247 && b0 <= 250) return (b0 - 247)*256 + stbtt__buf_get8(b) + 108;
+ else if (b0 >= 251 && b0 <= 254) return -(b0 - 251)*256 - stbtt__buf_get8(b) - 108;
+ else if (b0 == 28) return stbtt__buf_get16(b);
+ else if (b0 == 29) return stbtt__buf_get32(b);
+ STBTT_assert(0);
+ return 0;
+}
+
+static void stbtt__cff_skip_operand(stbtt__buf *b) {
+ int v, b0 = stbtt__buf_peek8(b);
+ STBTT_assert(b0 >= 28);
+ if (b0 == 30) {
+ stbtt__buf_skip(b, 1);
+ while (b->cursor < b->size) {
+ v = stbtt__buf_get8(b);
+ if ((v & 0xF) == 0xF || (v >> 4) == 0xF)
+ break;
+ }
+ } else {
+ stbtt__cff_int(b);
+ }
+}
+
+static stbtt__buf stbtt__dict_get(stbtt__buf *b, int key)
+{
+ stbtt__buf_seek(b, 0);
+ while (b->cursor < b->size) {
+ int start = b->cursor, end, op;
+ while (stbtt__buf_peek8(b) >= 28)
+ stbtt__cff_skip_operand(b);
+ end = b->cursor;
+ op = stbtt__buf_get8(b);
+ if (op == 12) op = stbtt__buf_get8(b) | 0x100;
+ if (op == key) return stbtt__buf_range(b, start, end-start);
+ }
+ return stbtt__buf_range(b, 0, 0);
+}
+
+static void stbtt__dict_get_ints(stbtt__buf *b, int key, int outcount, stbtt_uint32 *out)
+{
+ int i;
+ stbtt__buf operands = stbtt__dict_get(b, key);
+ for (i = 0; i < outcount && operands.cursor < operands.size; i++)
+ out[i] = stbtt__cff_int(&operands);
+}
+
+static int stbtt__cff_index_count(stbtt__buf *b)
+{
+ stbtt__buf_seek(b, 0);
+ return stbtt__buf_get16(b);
+}
+
+static stbtt__buf stbtt__cff_index_get(stbtt__buf b, int i)
+{
+ int count, offsize, start, end;
+ stbtt__buf_seek(&b, 0);
+ count = stbtt__buf_get16(&b);
+ offsize = stbtt__buf_get8(&b);
+ STBTT_assert(i >= 0 && i < count);
+ STBTT_assert(offsize >= 1 && offsize <= 4);
+ stbtt__buf_skip(&b, i*offsize);
+ start = stbtt__buf_get(&b, offsize);
+ end = stbtt__buf_get(&b, offsize);
+ return stbtt__buf_range(&b, 2+(count+1)*offsize+start, end - start);
+}
+
+//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+//
+// accessors to parse data from file
+//
+
+// on platforms that don't allow misaligned reads, if we want to allow
+// truetype fonts that aren't padded to alignment, define ALLOW_UNALIGNED_TRUETYPE
+
+#define ttBYTE(p) (* (stbtt_uint8 *) (p))
+#define ttCHAR(p) (* (stbtt_int8 *) (p))
+#define ttFixed(p) ttLONG(p)
+
+static stbtt_uint16 ttUSHORT(stbtt_uint8 *p) { return p[0]*256 + p[1]; }
+static stbtt_int16 ttSHORT(stbtt_uint8 *p) { return p[0]*256 + p[1]; }
+static stbtt_uint32 ttULONG(stbtt_uint8 *p) { return (p[0]<<24) + (p[1]<<16) + (p[2]<<8) + p[3]; }
+static stbtt_int32 ttLONG(stbtt_uint8 *p) { return (p[0]<<24) + (p[1]<<16) + (p[2]<<8) + p[3]; }
+
+#define stbtt_tag4(p,c0,c1,c2,c3) ((p)[0] == (c0) && (p)[1] == (c1) && (p)[2] == (c2) && (p)[3] == (c3))
+#define stbtt_tag(p,str) stbtt_tag4(p,str[0],str[1],str[2],str[3])
+
+static int stbtt__isfont(stbtt_uint8 *font)
+{
+ // check the version number
+ if (stbtt_tag4(font, '1',0,0,0)) return 1; // TrueType 1
+ if (stbtt_tag(font, "typ1")) return 1; // TrueType with type 1 font -- we don't support this!
+ if (stbtt_tag(font, "OTTO")) return 1; // OpenType with CFF
+ if (stbtt_tag4(font, 0,1,0,0)) return 1; // OpenType 1.0
+ if (stbtt_tag(font, "true")) return 1; // Apple specification for TrueType fonts
+ return 0;
+}
+
+// @OPTIMIZE: binary search
+static stbtt_uint32 stbtt__find_table(stbtt_uint8 *data, stbtt_uint32 fontstart, const char *tag)
+{
+ stbtt_int32 num_tables = ttUSHORT(data+fontstart+4);
+ stbtt_uint32 tabledir = fontstart + 12;
+ stbtt_int32 i;
+ for (i=0; i < num_tables; ++i) {
+ stbtt_uint32 loc = tabledir + 16*i;
+ if (stbtt_tag(data+loc+0, tag))
+ return ttULONG(data+loc+8);
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+static int stbtt_GetFontOffsetForIndex_internal(unsigned char *font_collection, int index)
+{
+ // if it's just a font, there's only one valid index
+ if (stbtt__isfont(font_collection))
+ return index == 0 ? 0 : -1;
+
+ // check if it's a TTC
+ if (stbtt_tag(font_collection, "ttcf")) {
+ // version 1?
+ if (ttULONG(font_collection+4) == 0x00010000 || ttULONG(font_collection+4) == 0x00020000) {
+ stbtt_int32 n = ttLONG(font_collection+8);
+ if (index >= n)
+ return -1;
+ return ttULONG(font_collection+12+index*4);
+ }
+ }
+ return -1;
+}
+
+static int stbtt_GetNumberOfFonts_internal(unsigned char *font_collection)
+{
+ // if it's just a font, there's only one valid font
+ if (stbtt__isfont(font_collection))
+ return 1;
+
+ // check if it's a TTC
+ if (stbtt_tag(font_collection, "ttcf")) {
+ // version 1?
+ if (ttULONG(font_collection+4) == 0x00010000 || ttULONG(font_collection+4) == 0x00020000) {
+ return ttLONG(font_collection+8);
+ }
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+static stbtt__buf stbtt__get_subrs(stbtt__buf cff, stbtt__buf fontdict)
+{
+ stbtt_uint32 subrsoff = 0, private_loc[2] = { 0, 0 };
+ stbtt__buf pdict;
+ stbtt__dict_get_ints(&fontdict, 18, 2, private_loc);
+ if (!private_loc[1] || !private_loc[0]) return stbtt__new_buf(NULL, 0);
+ pdict = stbtt__buf_range(&cff, private_loc[1], private_loc[0]);
+ stbtt__dict_get_ints(&pdict, 19, 1, &subrsoff);
+ if (!subrsoff) return stbtt__new_buf(NULL, 0);
+ stbtt__buf_seek(&cff, private_loc[1]+subrsoff);
+ return stbtt__cff_get_index(&cff);
+}
+
+static int stbtt_InitFont_internal(stbtt_fontinfo *info, unsigned char *data, int fontstart)
+{
+ stbtt_uint32 cmap, t;
+ stbtt_int32 i,numTables;
+
+ info->data = data;
+ info->fontstart = fontstart;
+ info->cff = stbtt__new_buf(NULL, 0);
+
+ cmap = stbtt__find_table(data, fontstart, "cmap"); // required
+ info->loca = stbtt__find_table(data, fontstart, "loca"); // required
+ info->head = stbtt__find_table(data, fontstart, "head"); // required
+ info->glyf = stbtt__find_table(data, fontstart, "glyf"); // required
+ info->hhea = stbtt__find_table(data, fontstart, "hhea"); // required
+ info->hmtx = stbtt__find_table(data, fontstart, "hmtx"); // required
+ info->kern = stbtt__find_table(data, fontstart, "kern"); // not required
+
+ if (!cmap || !info->head || !info->hhea || !info->hmtx)
+ return 0;
+ if (info->glyf) {
+ // required for truetype
+ if (!info->loca) return 0;
+ } else {
+ // initialization for CFF / Type2 fonts (OTF)
+ stbtt__buf b, topdict, topdictidx;
+ stbtt_uint32 cstype = 2, charstrings = 0, fdarrayoff = 0, fdselectoff = 0;
+ stbtt_uint32 cff;
+
+ cff = stbtt__find_table(data, fontstart, "CFF ");
+ if (!cff) return 0;
+
+ info->fontdicts = stbtt__new_buf(NULL, 0);
+ info->fdselect = stbtt__new_buf(NULL, 0);
+
+ // @TODO this should use size from table (not 512MB)
+ info->cff = stbtt__new_buf(data+cff, 512*1024*1024);
+ b = info->cff;
+
+ // read the header
+ stbtt__buf_skip(&b, 2);
+ stbtt__buf_seek(&b, stbtt__buf_get8(&b)); // hdrsize
+
+ // @TODO the name INDEX could list multiple fonts,
+ // but we just use the first one.
+ stbtt__cff_get_index(&b); // name INDEX
+ topdictidx = stbtt__cff_get_index(&b);
+ topdict = stbtt__cff_index_get(topdictidx, 0);
+ stbtt__cff_get_index(&b); // string INDEX
+ info->gsubrs = stbtt__cff_get_index(&b);
+
+ stbtt__dict_get_ints(&topdict, 17, 1, &charstrings);
+ stbtt__dict_get_ints(&topdict, 0x100 | 6, 1, &cstype);
+ stbtt__dict_get_ints(&topdict, 0x100 | 36, 1, &fdarrayoff);
+ stbtt__dict_get_ints(&topdict, 0x100 | 37, 1, &fdselectoff);
+ info->subrs = stbtt__get_subrs(b, topdict);
+
+ // we only support Type 2 charstrings
+ if (cstype != 2) return 0;
+ if (charstrings == 0) return 0;
+
+ if (fdarrayoff) {
+ // looks like a CID font
+ if (!fdselectoff) return 0;
+ stbtt__buf_seek(&b, fdarrayoff);
+ info->fontdicts = stbtt__cff_get_index(&b);
+ info->fdselect = stbtt__buf_range(&b, fdselectoff, b.size-fdselectoff);
+ }
+
+ stbtt__buf_seek(&b, charstrings);
+ info->charstrings = stbtt__cff_get_index(&b);
+ }
+
+ t = stbtt__find_table(data, fontstart, "maxp");
+ if (t)
+ info->numGlyphs = ttUSHORT(data+t+4);
+ else
+ info->numGlyphs = 0xffff;
+
+ // find a cmap encoding table we understand *now* to avoid searching
+ // later. (todo: could make this installable)
+ // the same regardless of glyph.
+ numTables = ttUSHORT(data + cmap + 2);
+ info->index_map = 0;
+ for (i=0; i < numTables; ++i) {
+ stbtt_uint32 encoding_record = cmap + 4 + 8 * i;
+ // find an encoding we understand:
+ switch(ttUSHORT(data+encoding_record)) {
+ case STBTT_PLATFORM_ID_MICROSOFT:
+ switch (ttUSHORT(data+encoding_record+2)) {
+ case STBTT_MS_EID_UNICODE_BMP:
+ case STBTT_MS_EID_UNICODE_FULL:
+ // MS/Unicode
+ info->index_map = cmap + ttULONG(data+encoding_record+4);
+ break;
+ }
+ break;
+ case STBTT_PLATFORM_ID_UNICODE:
+ // Mac/iOS has these
+ // all the encodingIDs are unicode, so we don't bother to check it
+ info->index_map = cmap + ttULONG(data+encoding_record+4);
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ if (info->index_map == 0)
+ return 0;
+
+ info->indexToLocFormat = ttUSHORT(data+info->head + 50);
+ return 1;
+}
+
+STBTT_DEF int stbtt_FindGlyphIndex(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int unicode_codepoint)
+{
+ stbtt_uint8 *data = info->data;
+ stbtt_uint32 index_map = info->index_map;
+
+ stbtt_uint16 format = ttUSHORT(data + index_map + 0);
+ if (format == 0) { // apple byte encoding
+ stbtt_int32 bytes = ttUSHORT(data + index_map + 2);
+ if (unicode_codepoint < bytes-6)
+ return ttBYTE(data + index_map + 6 + unicode_codepoint);
+ return 0;
+ } else if (format == 6) {
+ stbtt_uint32 first = ttUSHORT(data + index_map + 6);
+ stbtt_uint32 count = ttUSHORT(data + index_map + 8);
+ if ((stbtt_uint32) unicode_codepoint >= first && (stbtt_uint32) unicode_codepoint < first+count)
+ return ttUSHORT(data + index_map + 10 + (unicode_codepoint - first)*2);
+ return 0;
+ } else if (format == 2) {
+ STBTT_assert(0); // @TODO: high-byte mapping for japanese/chinese/korean
+ return 0;
+ } else if (format == 4) { // standard mapping for windows fonts: binary search collection of ranges
+ stbtt_uint16 segcount = ttUSHORT(data+index_map+6) >> 1;
+ stbtt_uint16 searchRange = ttUSHORT(data+index_map+8) >> 1;
+ stbtt_uint16 entrySelector = ttUSHORT(data+index_map+10);
+ stbtt_uint16 rangeShift = ttUSHORT(data+index_map+12) >> 1;
+
+ // do a binary search of the segments
+ stbtt_uint32 endCount = index_map + 14;
+ stbtt_uint32 search = endCount;
+
+ if (unicode_codepoint > 0xffff)
+ return 0;
+
+ // they lie from endCount .. endCount + segCount
+ // but searchRange is the nearest power of two, so...
+ if (unicode_codepoint >= ttUSHORT(data + search + rangeShift*2))
+ search += rangeShift*2;
+
+ // now decrement to bias correctly to find smallest
+ search -= 2;
+ while (entrySelector) {
+ stbtt_uint16 end;
+ searchRange >>= 1;
+ end = ttUSHORT(data + search + searchRange*2);
+ if (unicode_codepoint > end)
+ search += searchRange*2;
+ --entrySelector;
+ }
+ search += 2;
+
+ {
+ stbtt_uint16 offset, start;
+ stbtt_uint16 item = (stbtt_uint16) ((search - endCount) >> 1);
+
+ STBTT_assert(unicode_codepoint <= ttUSHORT(data + endCount + 2*item));
+ start = ttUSHORT(data + index_map + 14 + segcount*2 + 2 + 2*item);
+ if (unicode_codepoint < start)
+ return 0;
+
+ offset = ttUSHORT(data + index_map + 14 + segcount*6 + 2 + 2*item);
+ if (offset == 0)
+ return (stbtt_uint16) (unicode_codepoint + ttSHORT(data + index_map + 14 + segcount*4 + 2 + 2*item));
+
+ return ttUSHORT(data + offset + (unicode_codepoint-start)*2 + index_map + 14 + segcount*6 + 2 + 2*item);
+ }
+ } else if (format == 12 || format == 13) {
+ stbtt_uint32 ngroups = ttULONG(data+index_map+12);
+ stbtt_int32 low,high;
+ low = 0; high = (stbtt_int32)ngroups;
+ // Binary search the right group.
+ while (low < high) {
+ stbtt_int32 mid = low + ((high-low) >> 1); // rounds down, so low <= mid < high
+ stbtt_uint32 start_char = ttULONG(data+index_map+16+mid*12);
+ stbtt_uint32 end_char = ttULONG(data+index_map+16+mid*12+4);
+ if ((stbtt_uint32) unicode_codepoint < start_char)
+ high = mid;
+ else if ((stbtt_uint32) unicode_codepoint > end_char)
+ low = mid+1;
+ else {
+ stbtt_uint32 start_glyph = ttULONG(data+index_map+16+mid*12+8);
+ if (format == 12)
+ return start_glyph + unicode_codepoint-start_char;
+ else // format == 13
+ return start_glyph;
+ }
+ }
+ return 0; // not found
+ }
+ // @TODO
+ STBTT_assert(0);
+ return 0;
+}
+
+STBTT_DEF int stbtt_GetCodepointShape(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int unicode_codepoint, stbtt_vertex **vertices)
+{
+ return stbtt_GetGlyphShape(info, stbtt_FindGlyphIndex(info, unicode_codepoint), vertices);
+}
+
+static void stbtt_setvertex(stbtt_vertex *v, stbtt_uint8 type, stbtt_int32 x, stbtt_int32 y, stbtt_int32 cx, stbtt_int32 cy)
+{
+ v->type = type;
+ v->x = (stbtt_int16) x;
+ v->y = (stbtt_int16) y;
+ v->cx = (stbtt_int16) cx;
+ v->cy = (stbtt_int16) cy;
+}
+
+static int stbtt__GetGlyfOffset(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int glyph_index)
+{
+ int g1,g2;
+
+ STBTT_assert(!info->cff.size);
+
+ if (glyph_index >= info->numGlyphs) return -1; // glyph index out of range
+ if (info->indexToLocFormat >= 2) return -1; // unknown index->glyph map format
+
+ if (info->indexToLocFormat == 0) {
+ g1 = info->glyf + ttUSHORT(info->data + info->loca + glyph_index * 2) * 2;
+ g2 = info->glyf + ttUSHORT(info->data + info->loca + glyph_index * 2 + 2) * 2;
+ } else {
+ g1 = info->glyf + ttULONG (info->data + info->loca + glyph_index * 4);
+ g2 = info->glyf + ttULONG (info->data + info->loca + glyph_index * 4 + 4);
+ }
+
+ return g1==g2 ? -1 : g1; // if length is 0, return -1
+}
+
+static int stbtt__GetGlyphInfoT2(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int glyph_index, int *x0, int *y0, int *x1, int *y1);
+
+STBTT_DEF int stbtt_GetGlyphBox(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int glyph_index, int *x0, int *y0, int *x1, int *y1)
+{
+ if (info->cff.size) {
+ stbtt__GetGlyphInfoT2(info, glyph_index, x0, y0, x1, y1);
+ } else {
+ int g = stbtt__GetGlyfOffset(info, glyph_index);
+ if (g < 0) return 0;
+
+ if (x0) *x0 = ttSHORT(info->data + g + 2);
+ if (y0) *y0 = ttSHORT(info->data + g + 4);
+ if (x1) *x1 = ttSHORT(info->data + g + 6);
+ if (y1) *y1 = ttSHORT(info->data + g + 8);
+ }
+ return 1;
+}
+
+STBTT_DEF int stbtt_GetCodepointBox(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int codepoint, int *x0, int *y0, int *x1, int *y1)
+{
+ return stbtt_GetGlyphBox(info, stbtt_FindGlyphIndex(info,codepoint), x0,y0,x1,y1);
+}
+
+STBTT_DEF int stbtt_IsGlyphEmpty(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int glyph_index)
+{
+ stbtt_int16 numberOfContours;
+ int g;
+ if (info->cff.size)
+ return stbtt__GetGlyphInfoT2(info, glyph_index, NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL) == 0;
+ g = stbtt__GetGlyfOffset(info, glyph_index);
+ if (g < 0) return 1;
+ numberOfContours = ttSHORT(info->data + g);
+ return numberOfContours == 0;
+}
+
+static int stbtt__close_shape(stbtt_vertex *vertices, int num_vertices, int was_off, int start_off,
+ stbtt_int32 sx, stbtt_int32 sy, stbtt_int32 scx, stbtt_int32 scy, stbtt_int32 cx, stbtt_int32 cy)
+{
+ if (start_off) {
+ if (was_off)
+ stbtt_setvertex(&vertices[num_vertices++], STBTT_vcurve, (cx+scx)>>1, (cy+scy)>>1, cx,cy);
+ stbtt_setvertex(&vertices[num_vertices++], STBTT_vcurve, sx,sy,scx,scy);
+ } else {
+ if (was_off)
+ stbtt_setvertex(&vertices[num_vertices++], STBTT_vcurve,sx,sy,cx,cy);
+ else
+ stbtt_setvertex(&vertices[num_vertices++], STBTT_vline,sx,sy,0,0);
+ }
+ return num_vertices;
+}
+
+static int stbtt__GetGlyphShapeTT(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int glyph_index, stbtt_vertex **pvertices)
+{
+ stbtt_int16 numberOfContours;
+ stbtt_uint8 *endPtsOfContours;
+ stbtt_uint8 *data = info->data;
+ stbtt_vertex *vertices=0;
+ int num_vertices=0;
+ int g = stbtt__GetGlyfOffset(info, glyph_index);
+
+ *pvertices = NULL;
+
+ if (g < 0) return 0;
+
+ numberOfContours = ttSHORT(data + g);
+
+ if (numberOfContours > 0) {
+ stbtt_uint8 flags=0,flagcount;
+ stbtt_int32 ins, i,j=0,m,n, next_move, was_off=0, off, start_off=0;
+ stbtt_int32 x,y,cx,cy,sx,sy, scx,scy;
+ stbtt_uint8 *points;
+ endPtsOfContours = (data + g + 10);
+ ins = ttUSHORT(data + g + 10 + numberOfContours * 2);
+ points = data + g + 10 + numberOfContours * 2 + 2 + ins;
+
+ n = 1+ttUSHORT(endPtsOfContours + numberOfContours*2-2);
+
+ m = n + 2*numberOfContours; // a loose bound on how many vertices we might need
+ vertices = (stbtt_vertex *) STBTT_malloc(m * sizeof(vertices[0]), info->userdata);
+ if (vertices == 0)
+ return 0;
+
+ next_move = 0;
+ flagcount=0;
+
+ // in first pass, we load uninterpreted data into the allocated array
+ // above, shifted to the end of the array so we won't overwrite it when
+ // we create our final data starting from the front
+
+ off = m - n; // starting offset for uninterpreted data, regardless of how m ends up being calculated
+
+ // first load flags
+
+ for (i=0; i < n; ++i) {
+ if (flagcount == 0) {
+ flags = *points++;
+ if (flags & 8)
+ flagcount = *points++;
+ } else
+ --flagcount;
+ vertices[off+i].type = flags;
+ }
+
+ // now load x coordinates
+ x=0;
+ for (i=0; i < n; ++i) {
+ flags = vertices[off+i].type;
+ if (flags & 2) {
+ stbtt_int16 dx = *points++;
+ x += (flags & 16) ? dx : -dx; // ???
+ } else {
+ if (!(flags & 16)) {
+ x = x + (stbtt_int16) (points[0]*256 + points[1]);
+ points += 2;
+ }
+ }
+ vertices[off+i].x = (stbtt_int16) x;
+ }
+
+ // now load y coordinates
+ y=0;
+ for (i=0; i < n; ++i) {
+ flags = vertices[off+i].type;
+ if (flags & 4) {
+ stbtt_int16 dy = *points++;
+ y += (flags & 32) ? dy : -dy; // ???
+ } else {
+ if (!(flags & 32)) {
+ y = y + (stbtt_int16) (points[0]*256 + points[1]);
+ points += 2;
+ }
+ }
+ vertices[off+i].y = (stbtt_int16) y;
+ }
+
+ // now convert them to our format
+ num_vertices=0;
+ sx = sy = cx = cy = scx = scy = 0;
+ for (i=0; i < n; ++i) {
+ flags = vertices[off+i].type;
+ x = (stbtt_int16) vertices[off+i].x;
+ y = (stbtt_int16) vertices[off+i].y;
+
+ if (next_move == i) {
+ if (i != 0)
+ num_vertices = stbtt__close_shape(vertices, num_vertices, was_off, start_off, sx,sy,scx,scy,cx,cy);
+
+ // now start the new one
+ start_off = !(flags & 1);
+ if (start_off) {
+ // if we start off with an off-curve point, then when we need to find a point on the curve
+ // where we can start, and we need to save some state for when we wraparound.
+ scx = x;
+ scy = y;
+ if (!(vertices[off+i+1].type & 1)) {
+ // next point is also a curve point, so interpolate an on-point curve
+ sx = (x + (stbtt_int32) vertices[off+i+1].x) >> 1;
+ sy = (y + (stbtt_int32) vertices[off+i+1].y) >> 1;
+ } else {
+ // otherwise just use the next point as our start point
+ sx = (stbtt_int32) vertices[off+i+1].x;
+ sy = (stbtt_int32) vertices[off+i+1].y;
+ ++i; // we're using point i+1 as the starting point, so skip it
+ }
+ } else {
+ sx = x;
+ sy = y;
+ }
+ stbtt_setvertex(&vertices[num_vertices++], STBTT_vmove,sx,sy,0,0);
+ was_off = 0;
+ next_move = 1 + ttUSHORT(endPtsOfContours+j*2);
+ ++j;
+ } else {
+ if (!(flags & 1)) { // if it's a curve
+ if (was_off) // two off-curve control points in a row means interpolate an on-curve midpoint
+ stbtt_setvertex(&vertices[num_vertices++], STBTT_vcurve, (cx+x)>>1, (cy+y)>>1, cx, cy);
+ cx = x;
+ cy = y;
+ was_off = 1;
+ } else {
+ if (was_off)
+ stbtt_setvertex(&vertices[num_vertices++], STBTT_vcurve, x,y, cx, cy);
+ else
+ stbtt_setvertex(&vertices[num_vertices++], STBTT_vline, x,y,0,0);
+ was_off = 0;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ num_vertices = stbtt__close_shape(vertices, num_vertices, was_off, start_off, sx,sy,scx,scy,cx,cy);
+ } else if (numberOfContours == -1) {
+ // Compound shapes.
+ int more = 1;
+ stbtt_uint8 *comp = data + g + 10;
+ num_vertices = 0;
+ vertices = 0;
+ while (more) {
+ stbtt_uint16 flags, gidx;
+ int comp_num_verts = 0, i;
+ stbtt_vertex *comp_verts = 0, *tmp = 0;
+ float mtx[6] = {1,0,0,1,0,0}, m, n;
+
+ flags = ttSHORT(comp); comp+=2;
+ gidx = ttSHORT(comp); comp+=2;
+
+ if (flags & 2) { // XY values
+ if (flags & 1) { // shorts
+ mtx[4] = ttSHORT(comp); comp+=2;
+ mtx[5] = ttSHORT(comp); comp+=2;
+ } else {
+ mtx[4] = ttCHAR(comp); comp+=1;
+ mtx[5] = ttCHAR(comp); comp+=1;
+ }
+ }
+ else {
+ // @TODO handle matching point
+ STBTT_assert(0);
+ }
+ if (flags & (1<<3)) { // WE_HAVE_A_SCALE
+ mtx[0] = mtx[3] = ttSHORT(comp)/16384.0f; comp+=2;
+ mtx[1] = mtx[2] = 0;
+ } else if (flags & (1<<6)) { // WE_HAVE_AN_X_AND_YSCALE
+ mtx[0] = ttSHORT(comp)/16384.0f; comp+=2;
+ mtx[1] = mtx[2] = 0;
+ mtx[3] = ttSHORT(comp)/16384.0f; comp+=2;
+ } else if (flags & (1<<7)) { // WE_HAVE_A_TWO_BY_TWO
+ mtx[0] = ttSHORT(comp)/16384.0f; comp+=2;
+ mtx[1] = ttSHORT(comp)/16384.0f; comp+=2;
+ mtx[2] = ttSHORT(comp)/16384.0f; comp+=2;
+ mtx[3] = ttSHORT(comp)/16384.0f; comp+=2;
+ }
+
+ // Find transformation scales.
+ m = (float) STBTT_sqrt(mtx[0]*mtx[0] + mtx[1]*mtx[1]);
+ n = (float) STBTT_sqrt(mtx[2]*mtx[2] + mtx[3]*mtx[3]);
+
+ // Get indexed glyph.
+ comp_num_verts = stbtt_GetGlyphShape(info, gidx, &comp_verts);
+ if (comp_num_verts > 0) {
+ // Transform vertices.
+ for (i = 0; i < comp_num_verts; ++i) {
+ stbtt_vertex* v = &comp_verts[i];
+ stbtt_vertex_type x,y;
+ x=v->x; y=v->y;
+ v->x = (stbtt_vertex_type)(m * (mtx[0]*x + mtx[2]*y + mtx[4]));
+ v->y = (stbtt_vertex_type)(n * (mtx[1]*x + mtx[3]*y + mtx[5]));
+ x=v->cx; y=v->cy;
+ v->cx = (stbtt_vertex_type)(m * (mtx[0]*x + mtx[2]*y + mtx[4]));
+ v->cy = (stbtt_vertex_type)(n * (mtx[1]*x + mtx[3]*y + mtx[5]));
+ }
+ // Append vertices.
+ tmp = (stbtt_vertex*)STBTT_malloc((num_vertices+comp_num_verts)*sizeof(stbtt_vertex), info->userdata);
+ if (!tmp) {
+ if (vertices) STBTT_free(vertices, info->userdata);
+ if (comp_verts) STBTT_free(comp_verts, info->userdata);
+ return 0;
+ }
+ if (num_vertices > 0) STBTT_memcpy(tmp, vertices, num_vertices*sizeof(stbtt_vertex));
+ STBTT_memcpy(tmp+num_vertices, comp_verts, comp_num_verts*sizeof(stbtt_vertex));
+ if (vertices) STBTT_free(vertices, info->userdata);
+ vertices = tmp;
+ STBTT_free(comp_verts, info->userdata);
+ num_vertices += comp_num_verts;
+ }
+ // More components ?
+ more = flags & (1<<5);
+ }
+ } else if (numberOfContours < 0) {
+ // @TODO other compound variations?
+ STBTT_assert(0);
+ } else {
+ // numberOfCounters == 0, do nothing
+ }
+
+ *pvertices = vertices;
+ return num_vertices;
+}
+
+typedef struct
+{
+ int bounds;
+ int started;
+ float first_x, first_y;
+ float x, y;
+ stbtt_int32 min_x, max_x, min_y, max_y;
+
+ stbtt_vertex *pvertices;
+ int num_vertices;
+} stbtt__csctx;
+
+#define STBTT__CSCTX_INIT(bounds) {bounds,0, 0,0, 0,0, 0,0,0,0, NULL, 0}
+
+static void stbtt__track_vertex(stbtt__csctx *c, stbtt_int32 x, stbtt_int32 y)
+{
+ if (x > c->max_x || !c->started) c->max_x = x;
+ if (y > c->max_y || !c->started) c->max_y = y;
+ if (x < c->min_x || !c->started) c->min_x = x;
+ if (y < c->min_y || !c->started) c->min_y = y;
+ c->started = 1;
+}
+
+static void stbtt__csctx_v(stbtt__csctx *c, stbtt_uint8 type, stbtt_int32 x, stbtt_int32 y, stbtt_int32 cx, stbtt_int32 cy, stbtt_int32 cx1, stbtt_int32 cy1)
+{
+ if (c->bounds) {
+ stbtt__track_vertex(c, x, y);
+ if (type == STBTT_vcubic) {
+ stbtt__track_vertex(c, cx, cy);
+ stbtt__track_vertex(c, cx1, cy1);
+ }
+ } else {
+ stbtt_setvertex(&c->pvertices[c->num_vertices], type, x, y, cx, cy);
+ c->pvertices[c->num_vertices].cx1 = (stbtt_int16) cx1;
+ c->pvertices[c->num_vertices].cy1 = (stbtt_int16) cy1;
+ }
+ c->num_vertices++;
+}
+
+static void stbtt__csctx_close_shape(stbtt__csctx *ctx)
+{
+ if (ctx->first_x != ctx->x || ctx->first_y != ctx->y)
+ stbtt__csctx_v(ctx, STBTT_vline, (int)ctx->first_x, (int)ctx->first_y, 0, 0, 0, 0);
+}
+
+static void stbtt__csctx_rmove_to(stbtt__csctx *ctx, float dx, float dy)
+{
+ stbtt__csctx_close_shape(ctx);
+ ctx->first_x = ctx->x = ctx->x + dx;
+ ctx->first_y = ctx->y = ctx->y + dy;
+ stbtt__csctx_v(ctx, STBTT_vmove, (int)ctx->x, (int)ctx->y, 0, 0, 0, 0);
+}
+
+static void stbtt__csctx_rline_to(stbtt__csctx *ctx, float dx, float dy)
+{
+ ctx->x += dx;
+ ctx->y += dy;
+ stbtt__csctx_v(ctx, STBTT_vline, (int)ctx->x, (int)ctx->y, 0, 0, 0, 0);
+}
+
+static void stbtt__csctx_rccurve_to(stbtt__csctx *ctx, float dx1, float dy1, float dx2, float dy2, float dx3, float dy3)
+{
+ float cx1 = ctx->x + dx1;
+ float cy1 = ctx->y + dy1;
+ float cx2 = cx1 + dx2;
+ float cy2 = cy1 + dy2;
+ ctx->x = cx2 + dx3;
+ ctx->y = cy2 + dy3;
+ stbtt__csctx_v(ctx, STBTT_vcubic, (int)ctx->x, (int)ctx->y, (int)cx1, (int)cy1, (int)cx2, (int)cy2);
+}
+
+static stbtt__buf stbtt__get_subr(stbtt__buf idx, int n)
+{
+ int count = stbtt__cff_index_count(&idx);
+ int bias = 107;
+ if (count >= 33900)
+ bias = 32768;
+ else if (count >= 1240)
+ bias = 1131;
+ n += bias;
+ if (n < 0 || n >= count)
+ return stbtt__new_buf(NULL, 0);
+ return stbtt__cff_index_get(idx, n);
+}
+
+static stbtt__buf stbtt__cid_get_glyph_subrs(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int glyph_index)
+{
+ stbtt__buf fdselect = info->fdselect;
+ int nranges, start, end, v, fmt, fdselector = -1, i;
+
+ stbtt__buf_seek(&fdselect, 0);
+ fmt = stbtt__buf_get8(&fdselect);
+ if (fmt == 0) {
+ // untested
+ stbtt__buf_skip(&fdselect, glyph_index);
+ fdselector = stbtt__buf_get8(&fdselect);
+ } else if (fmt == 3) {
+ nranges = stbtt__buf_get16(&fdselect);
+ start = stbtt__buf_get16(&fdselect);
+ for (i = 0; i < nranges; i++) {
+ v = stbtt__buf_get8(&fdselect);
+ end = stbtt__buf_get16(&fdselect);
+ if (glyph_index >= start && glyph_index < end) {
+ fdselector = v;
+ break;
+ }
+ start = end;
+ }
+ }
+ if (fdselector == -1) stbtt__new_buf(NULL, 0);
+ return stbtt__get_subrs(info->cff, stbtt__cff_index_get(info->fontdicts, fdselector));
+}
+
+static int stbtt__run_charstring(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int glyph_index, stbtt__csctx *c)
+{
+ int in_header = 1, maskbits = 0, subr_stack_height = 0, sp = 0, v, i, b0;
+ int has_subrs = 0, clear_stack;
+ float s[48];
+ stbtt__buf subr_stack[10], subrs = info->subrs, b;
+ float f;
+
+#define STBTT__CSERR(s) (0)
+
+ // this currently ignores the initial width value, which isn't needed if we have hmtx
+ b = stbtt__cff_index_get(info->charstrings, glyph_index);
+ while (b.cursor < b.size) {
+ i = 0;
+ clear_stack = 1;
+ b0 = stbtt__buf_get8(&b);
+ switch (b0) {
+ // @TODO implement hinting
+ case 0x13: // hintmask
+ case 0x14: // cntrmask
+ if (in_header)
+ maskbits += (sp / 2); // implicit "vstem"
+ in_header = 0;
+ stbtt__buf_skip(&b, (maskbits + 7) / 8);
+ break;
+
+ case 0x01: // hstem
+ case 0x03: // vstem
+ case 0x12: // hstemhm
+ case 0x17: // vstemhm
+ maskbits += (sp / 2);
+ break;
+
+ case 0x15: // rmoveto
+ in_header = 0;
+ if (sp < 2) return STBTT__CSERR("rmoveto stack");
+ stbtt__csctx_rmove_to(c, s[sp-2], s[sp-1]);
+ break;
+ case 0x04: // vmoveto
+ in_header = 0;
+ if (sp < 1) return STBTT__CSERR("vmoveto stack");
+ stbtt__csctx_rmove_to(c, 0, s[sp-1]);
+ break;
+ case 0x16: // hmoveto
+ in_header = 0;
+ if (sp < 1) return STBTT__CSERR("hmoveto stack");
+ stbtt__csctx_rmove_to(c, s[sp-1], 0);
+ break;
+
+ case 0x05: // rlineto
+ if (sp < 2) return STBTT__CSERR("rlineto stack");
+ for (; i + 1 < sp; i += 2)
+ stbtt__csctx_rline_to(c, s[i], s[i+1]);
+ break;
+
+ // hlineto/vlineto and vhcurveto/hvcurveto alternate horizontal and vertical
+ // starting from a different place.
+
+ case 0x07: // vlineto
+ if (sp < 1) return STBTT__CSERR("vlineto stack");
+ goto vlineto;
+ case 0x06: // hlineto
+ if (sp < 1) return STBTT__CSERR("hlineto stack");
+ for (;;) {
+ if (i >= sp) break;
+ stbtt__csctx_rline_to(c, s[i], 0);
+ i++;
+ vlineto:
+ if (i >= sp) break;
+ stbtt__csctx_rline_to(c, 0, s[i]);
+ i++;
+ }
+ break;
+
+ case 0x1F: // hvcurveto
+ if (sp < 4) return STBTT__CSERR("hvcurveto stack");
+ goto hvcurveto;
+ case 0x1E: // vhcurveto
+ if (sp < 4) return STBTT__CSERR("vhcurveto stack");
+ for (;;) {
+ if (i + 3 >= sp) break;
+ stbtt__csctx_rccurve_to(c, 0, s[i], s[i+1], s[i+2], s[i+3], (sp - i == 5) ? s[i + 4] : 0.0f);
+ i += 4;
+ hvcurveto:
+ if (i + 3 >= sp) break;
+ stbtt__csctx_rccurve_to(c, s[i], 0, s[i+1], s[i+2], (sp - i == 5) ? s[i+4] : 0.0f, s[i+3]);
+ i += 4;
+ }
+ break;
+
+ case 0x08: // rrcurveto
+ if (sp < 6) return STBTT__CSERR("rcurveline stack");
+ for (; i + 5 < sp; i += 6)
+ stbtt__csctx_rccurve_to(c, s[i], s[i+1], s[i+2], s[i+3], s[i+4], s[i+5]);
+ break;
+
+ case 0x18: // rcurveline
+ if (sp < 8) return STBTT__CSERR("rcurveline stack");
+ for (; i + 5 < sp - 2; i += 6)
+ stbtt__csctx_rccurve_to(c, s[i], s[i+1], s[i+2], s[i+3], s[i+4], s[i+5]);
+ if (i + 1 >= sp) return STBTT__CSERR("rcurveline stack");
+ stbtt__csctx_rline_to(c, s[i], s[i+1]);
+ break;
+
+ case 0x19: // rlinecurve
+ if (sp < 8) return STBTT__CSERR("rlinecurve stack");
+ for (; i + 1 < sp - 6; i += 2)
+ stbtt__csctx_rline_to(c, s[i], s[i+1]);
+ if (i + 5 >= sp) return STBTT__CSERR("rlinecurve stack");
+ stbtt__csctx_rccurve_to(c, s[i], s[i+1], s[i+2], s[i+3], s[i+4], s[i+5]);
+ break;
+
+ case 0x1A: // vvcurveto
+ case 0x1B: // hhcurveto
+ if (sp < 4) return STBTT__CSERR("(vv|hh)curveto stack");
+ f = 0.0;
+ if (sp & 1) { f = s[i]; i++; }
+ for (; i + 3 < sp; i += 4) {
+ if (b0 == 0x1B)
+ stbtt__csctx_rccurve_to(c, s[i], f, s[i+1], s[i+2], s[i+3], 0.0);
+ else
+ stbtt__csctx_rccurve_to(c, f, s[i], s[i+1], s[i+2], 0.0, s[i+3]);
+ f = 0.0;
+ }
+ break;
+
+ case 0x0A: // callsubr
+ if (!has_subrs) {
+ if (info->fdselect.size)
+ subrs = stbtt__cid_get_glyph_subrs(info, glyph_index);
+ has_subrs = 1;
+ }
+ // fallthrough
+ case 0x1D: // callgsubr
+ if (sp < 1) return STBTT__CSERR("call(g|)subr stack");
+ v = (int) s[--sp];
+ if (subr_stack_height >= 10) return STBTT__CSERR("recursion limit");
+ subr_stack[subr_stack_height++] = b;
+ b = stbtt__get_subr(b0 == 0x0A ? subrs : info->gsubrs, v);
+ if (b.size == 0) return STBTT__CSERR("subr not found");
+ b.cursor = 0;
+ clear_stack = 0;
+ break;
+
+ case 0x0B: // return
+ if (subr_stack_height <= 0) return STBTT__CSERR("return outside subr");
+ b = subr_stack[--subr_stack_height];
+ clear_stack = 0;
+ break;
+
+ case 0x0E: // endchar
+ stbtt__csctx_close_shape(c);
+ return 1;
+
+ case 0x0C: { // two-byte escape
+ float dx1, dx2, dx3, dx4, dx5, dx6, dy1, dy2, dy3, dy4, dy5, dy6;
+ float dx, dy;
+ int b1 = stbtt__buf_get8(&b);
+ switch (b1) {
+ // @TODO These "flex" implementations ignore the flex-depth and resolution,
+ // and always draw beziers.
+ case 0x22: // hflex
+ if (sp < 7) return STBTT__CSERR("hflex stack");
+ dx1 = s[0];
+ dx2 = s[1];
+ dy2 = s[2];
+ dx3 = s[3];
+ dx4 = s[4];
+ dx5 = s[5];
+ dx6 = s[6];
+ stbtt__csctx_rccurve_to(c, dx1, 0, dx2, dy2, dx3, 0);
+ stbtt__csctx_rccurve_to(c, dx4, 0, dx5, -dy2, dx6, 0);
+ break;
+
+ case 0x23: // flex
+ if (sp < 13) return STBTT__CSERR("flex stack");
+ dx1 = s[0];
+ dy1 = s[1];
+ dx2 = s[2];
+ dy2 = s[3];
+ dx3 = s[4];
+ dy3 = s[5];
+ dx4 = s[6];
+ dy4 = s[7];
+ dx5 = s[8];
+ dy5 = s[9];
+ dx6 = s[10];
+ dy6 = s[11];
+ //fd is s[12]
+ stbtt__csctx_rccurve_to(c, dx1, dy1, dx2, dy2, dx3, dy3);
+ stbtt__csctx_rccurve_to(c, dx4, dy4, dx5, dy5, dx6, dy6);
+ break;
+
+ case 0x24: // hflex1
+ if (sp < 9) return STBTT__CSERR("hflex1 stack");
+ dx1 = s[0];
+ dy1 = s[1];
+ dx2 = s[2];
+ dy2 = s[3];
+ dx3 = s[4];
+ dx4 = s[5];
+ dx5 = s[6];
+ dy5 = s[7];
+ dx6 = s[8];
+ stbtt__csctx_rccurve_to(c, dx1, dy1, dx2, dy2, dx3, 0);
+ stbtt__csctx_rccurve_to(c, dx4, 0, dx5, dy5, dx6, -(dy1+dy2+dy5));
+ break;
+
+ case 0x25: // flex1
+ if (sp < 11) return STBTT__CSERR("flex1 stack");
+ dx1 = s[0];
+ dy1 = s[1];
+ dx2 = s[2];
+ dy2 = s[3];
+ dx3 = s[4];
+ dy3 = s[5];
+ dx4 = s[6];
+ dy4 = s[7];
+ dx5 = s[8];
+ dy5 = s[9];
+ dx6 = dy6 = s[10];
+ dx = dx1+dx2+dx3+dx4+dx5;
+ dy = dy1+dy2+dy3+dy4+dy5;
+ if (STBTT_fabs(dx) > STBTT_fabs(dy))
+ dy6 = -dy;
+ else
+ dx6 = -dx;
+ stbtt__csctx_rccurve_to(c, dx1, dy1, dx2, dy2, dx3, dy3);
+ stbtt__csctx_rccurve_to(c, dx4, dy4, dx5, dy5, dx6, dy6);
+ break;
+
+ default:
+ return STBTT__CSERR("unimplemented");
+ }
+ } break;
+
+ default:
+ if (b0 != 255 && b0 != 28 && (b0 < 32 || b0 > 254))
+ return STBTT__CSERR("reserved operator");
+
+ // push immediate
+ if (b0 == 255) {
+ f = (float)stbtt__buf_get32(&b) / 0x10000;
+ } else {
+ stbtt__buf_skip(&b, -1);
+ f = (float)(stbtt_int16)stbtt__cff_int(&b);
+ }
+ if (sp >= 48) return STBTT__CSERR("push stack overflow");
+ s[sp++] = f;
+ clear_stack = 0;
+ break;
+ }
+ if (clear_stack) sp = 0;
+ }
+ return STBTT__CSERR("no endchar");
+
+#undef STBTT__CSERR
+}
+
+static int stbtt__GetGlyphShapeT2(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int glyph_index, stbtt_vertex **pvertices)
+{
+ // runs the charstring twice, once to count and once to output (to avoid realloc)
+ stbtt__csctx count_ctx = STBTT__CSCTX_INIT(1);
+ stbtt__csctx output_ctx = STBTT__CSCTX_INIT(0);
+ if (stbtt__run_charstring(info, glyph_index, &count_ctx)) {
+ *pvertices = (stbtt_vertex*)STBTT_malloc(count_ctx.num_vertices*sizeof(stbtt_vertex), info->userdata);
+ output_ctx.pvertices = *pvertices;
+ if (stbtt__run_charstring(info, glyph_index, &output_ctx)) {
+ STBTT_assert(output_ctx.num_vertices == count_ctx.num_vertices);
+ return output_ctx.num_vertices;
+ }
+ }
+ *pvertices = NULL;
+ return 0;
+}
+
+static int stbtt__GetGlyphInfoT2(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int glyph_index, int *x0, int *y0, int *x1, int *y1)
+{
+ stbtt__csctx c = STBTT__CSCTX_INIT(1);
+ int r = stbtt__run_charstring(info, glyph_index, &c);
+ if (x0) {
+ *x0 = r ? c.min_x : 0;
+ *y0 = r ? c.min_y : 0;
+ *x1 = r ? c.max_x : 0;
+ *y1 = r ? c.max_y : 0;
+ }
+ return r ? c.num_vertices : 0;
+}
+
+STBTT_DEF int stbtt_GetGlyphShape(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int glyph_index, stbtt_vertex **pvertices)
+{
+ if (!info->cff.size)
+ return stbtt__GetGlyphShapeTT(info, glyph_index, pvertices);
+ else
+ return stbtt__GetGlyphShapeT2(info, glyph_index, pvertices);
+}
+
+STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetGlyphHMetrics(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int glyph_index, int *advanceWidth, int *leftSideBearing)
+{
+ stbtt_uint16 numOfLongHorMetrics = ttUSHORT(info->data+info->hhea + 34);
+ if (glyph_index < numOfLongHorMetrics) {
+ if (advanceWidth) *advanceWidth = ttSHORT(info->data + info->hmtx + 4*glyph_index);
+ if (leftSideBearing) *leftSideBearing = ttSHORT(info->data + info->hmtx + 4*glyph_index + 2);
+ } else {
+ if (advanceWidth) *advanceWidth = ttSHORT(info->data + info->hmtx + 4*(numOfLongHorMetrics-1));
+ if (leftSideBearing) *leftSideBearing = ttSHORT(info->data + info->hmtx + 4*numOfLongHorMetrics + 2*(glyph_index - numOfLongHorMetrics));
+ }
+}
+
+STBTT_DEF int stbtt_GetGlyphKernAdvance(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int glyph1, int glyph2)
+{
+ stbtt_uint8 *data = info->data + info->kern;
+ stbtt_uint32 needle, straw;
+ int l, r, m;
+
+ // we only look at the first table. it must be 'horizontal' and format 0.
+ if (!info->kern)
+ return 0;
+ if (ttUSHORT(data+2) < 1) // number of tables, need at least 1
+ return 0;
+ if (ttUSHORT(data+8) != 1) // horizontal flag must be set in format
+ return 0;
+
+ l = 0;
+ r = ttUSHORT(data+10) - 1;
+ needle = glyph1 << 16 | glyph2;
+ while (l <= r) {
+ m = (l + r) >> 1;
+ straw = ttULONG(data+18+(m*6)); // note: unaligned read
+ if (needle < straw)
+ r = m - 1;
+ else if (needle > straw)
+ l = m + 1;
+ else
+ return ttSHORT(data+22+(m*6));
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+STBTT_DEF int stbtt_GetCodepointKernAdvance(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int ch1, int ch2)
+{
+ if (!info->kern) // if no kerning table, don't waste time looking up both codepoint->glyphs
+ return 0;
+ return stbtt_GetGlyphKernAdvance(info, stbtt_FindGlyphIndex(info,ch1), stbtt_FindGlyphIndex(info,ch2));
+}
+
+STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetCodepointHMetrics(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int codepoint, int *advanceWidth, int *leftSideBearing)
+{
+ stbtt_GetGlyphHMetrics(info, stbtt_FindGlyphIndex(info,codepoint), advanceWidth, leftSideBearing);
+}
+
+STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetFontVMetrics(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int *ascent, int *descent, int *lineGap)
+{
+ if (ascent ) *ascent = ttSHORT(info->data+info->hhea + 4);
+ if (descent) *descent = ttSHORT(info->data+info->hhea + 6);
+ if (lineGap) *lineGap = ttSHORT(info->data+info->hhea + 8);
+}
+
+STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetFontBoundingBox(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, int *x0, int *y0, int *x1, int *y1)
+{
+ *x0 = ttSHORT(info->data + info->head + 36);
+ *y0 = ttSHORT(info->data + info->head + 38);
+ *x1 = ttSHORT(info->data + info->head + 40);
+ *y1 = ttSHORT(info->data + info->head + 42);
+}
+
+STBTT_DEF float stbtt_ScaleForPixelHeight(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, float height)
+{
+ int fheight = ttSHORT(info->data + info->hhea + 4) - ttSHORT(info->data + info->hhea + 6);
+ return (float) height / fheight;
+}
+
+STBTT_DEF float stbtt_ScaleForMappingEmToPixels(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, float pixels)
+{
+ int unitsPerEm = ttUSHORT(info->data + info->head + 18);
+ return pixels / unitsPerEm;
+}
+
+STBTT_DEF void stbtt_FreeShape(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, stbtt_vertex *v)
+{
+ STBTT_free(v, info->userdata);
+}
+
+//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+//
+// antialiasing software rasterizer
+//
+
+STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetGlyphBitmapBoxSubpixel(const stbtt_fontinfo *font, int glyph, float scale_x, float scale_y,float shift_x, float shift_y, int *ix0, int *iy0, int *ix1, int *iy1)
+{
+ int x0=0,y0=0,x1,y1; // =0 suppresses compiler warning
+ if (!stbtt_GetGlyphBox(font, glyph, &x0,&y0,&x1,&y1)) {
+ // e.g. space character
+ if (ix0) *ix0 = 0;
+ if (iy0) *iy0 = 0;
+ if (ix1) *ix1 = 0;
+ if (iy1) *iy1 = 0;
+ } else {
+ // move to integral bboxes (treating pixels as little squares, what pixels get touched)?
+ if (ix0) *ix0 = STBTT_ifloor( x0 * scale_x + shift_x);
+ if (iy0) *iy0 = STBTT_ifloor(-y1 * scale_y + shift_y);
+ if (ix1) *ix1 = STBTT_iceil ( x1 * scale_x + shift_x);
+ if (iy1) *iy1 = STBTT_iceil (-y0 * scale_y + shift_y);
+ }
+}
+
+STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetGlyphBitmapBox(const stbtt_fontinfo *font, int glyph, float scale_x, float scale_y, int *ix0, int *iy0, int *ix1, int *iy1)
+{
+ stbtt_GetGlyphBitmapBoxSubpixel(font, glyph, scale_x, scale_y,0.0f,0.0f, ix0, iy0, ix1, iy1);
+}
+
+STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetCodepointBitmapBoxSubpixel(const stbtt_fontinfo *font, int codepoint, float scale_x, float scale_y, float shift_x, float shift_y, int *ix0, int *iy0, int *ix1, int *iy1)
+{
+ stbtt_GetGlyphBitmapBoxSubpixel(font, stbtt_FindGlyphIndex(font,codepoint), scale_x, scale_y,shift_x,shift_y, ix0,iy0,ix1,iy1);
+}
+
+STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetCodepointBitmapBox(const stbtt_fontinfo *font, int codepoint, float scale_x, float scale_y, int *ix0, int *iy0, int *ix1, int *iy1)
+{
+ stbtt_GetCodepointBitmapBoxSubpixel(font, codepoint, scale_x, scale_y,0.0f,0.0f, ix0,iy0,ix1,iy1);
+}
+
+//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+//
+// Rasterizer
+
+typedef struct stbtt__hheap_chunk
+{
+ struct stbtt__hheap_chunk *next;
+} stbtt__hheap_chunk;
+
+typedef struct stbtt__hheap
+{
+ struct stbtt__hheap_chunk *head;
+ void *first_free;
+ int num_remaining_in_head_chunk;
+} stbtt__hheap;
+
+static void *stbtt__hheap_alloc(stbtt__hheap *hh, size_t size, void *userdata)
+{
+ if (hh->first_free) {
+ void *p = hh->first_free;
+ hh->first_free = * (void **) p;
+ return p;
+ } else {
+ if (hh->num_remaining_in_head_chunk == 0) {
+ int count = (size < 32 ? 2000 : size < 128 ? 800 : 100);
+ stbtt__hheap_chunk *c = (stbtt__hheap_chunk *) STBTT_malloc(sizeof(stbtt__hheap_chunk) + size * count, userdata);
+ if (c == NULL)
+ return NULL;
+ c->next = hh->head;
+ hh->head = c;
+ hh->num_remaining_in_head_chunk = count;
+ }
+ --hh->num_remaining_in_head_chunk;
+ return (char *) (hh->head) + size * hh->num_remaining_in_head_chunk;
+ }
+}
+
+static void stbtt__hheap_free(stbtt__hheap *hh, void *p)
+{
+ *(void **) p = hh->first_free;
+ hh->first_free = p;
+}
+
+static void stbtt__hheap_cleanup(stbtt__hheap *hh, void *userdata)
+{
+ stbtt__hheap_chunk *c = hh->head;
+ while (c) {
+ stbtt__hheap_chunk *n = c->next;
+ STBTT_free(c, userdata);
+ c = n;
+ }
+}
+
+typedef struct stbtt__edge {
+ float x0,y0, x1,y1;
+ int invert;
+} stbtt__edge;
+
+
+typedef struct stbtt__active_edge
+{
+ struct stbtt__active_edge *next;
+ #if STBTT_RASTERIZER_VERSION==1
+ int x,dx;
+ float ey;
+ int direction;
+ #elif STBTT_RASTERIZER_VERSION==2
+ float fx,fdx,fdy;
+ float direction;
+ float sy;
+ float ey;
+ #else
+ #error "Unrecognized value of STBTT_RASTERIZER_VERSION"
+ #endif
+} stbtt__active_edge;
+
+#if STBTT_RASTERIZER_VERSION == 1
+#define STBTT_FIXSHIFT 10
+#define STBTT_FIX (1 << STBTT_FIXSHIFT)
+#define STBTT_FIXMASK (STBTT_FIX-1)
+
+static stbtt__active_edge *stbtt__new_active(stbtt__hheap *hh, stbtt__edge *e, int off_x, float start_point, void *userdata)
+{
+ stbtt__active_edge *z = (stbtt__active_edge *) stbtt__hheap_alloc(hh, sizeof(*z), userdata);
+ float dxdy = (e->x1 - e->x0) / (e->y1 - e->y0);
+ STBTT_assert(z != NULL);
+ if (!z) return z;
+
+ // round dx down to avoid overshooting
+ if (dxdy < 0)
+ z->dx = -STBTT_ifloor(STBTT_FIX * -dxdy);
+ else
+ z->dx = STBTT_ifloor(STBTT_FIX * dxdy);
+
+ z->x = STBTT_ifloor(STBTT_FIX * e->x0 + z->dx * (start_point - e->y0)); // use z->dx so when we offset later it's by the same amount
+ z->x -= off_x * STBTT_FIX;
+
+ z->ey = e->y1;
+ z->next = 0;
+ z->direction = e->invert ? 1 : -1;
+ return z;
+}
+#elif STBTT_RASTERIZER_VERSION == 2
+static stbtt__active_edge *stbtt__new_active(stbtt__hheap *hh, stbtt__edge *e, int off_x, float start_point, void *userdata)
+{
+ stbtt__active_edge *z = (stbtt__active_edge *) stbtt__hheap_alloc(hh, sizeof(*z), userdata);
+ float dxdy = (e->x1 - e->x0) / (e->y1 - e->y0);
+ STBTT_assert(z != NULL);
+ //STBTT_assert(e->y0 <= start_point);
+ if (!z) return z;
+ z->fdx = dxdy;
+ z->fdy = dxdy != 0.0f ? (1.0f/dxdy) : 0.0f;
+ z->fx = e->x0 + dxdy * (start_point - e->y0);
+ z->fx -= off_x;
+ z->direction = e->invert ? 1.0f : -1.0f;
+ z->sy = e->y0;
+ z->ey = e->y1;
+ z->next = 0;
+ return z;
+}
+#else
+#error "Unrecognized value of STBTT_RASTERIZER_VERSION"
+#endif
+
+#if STBTT_RASTERIZER_VERSION == 1
+// note: this routine clips fills that extend off the edges... ideally this
+// wouldn't happen, but it could happen if the truetype glyph bounding boxes
+// are wrong, or if the user supplies a too-small bitmap
+static void stbtt__fill_active_edges(unsigned char *scanline, int len, stbtt__active_edge *e, int max_weight)
+{
+ // non-zero winding fill
+ int x0=0, w=0;
+
+ while (e) {
+ if (w == 0) {
+ // if we're currently at zero, we need to record the edge start point
+ x0 = e->x; w += e->direction;
+ } else {
+ int x1 = e->x; w += e->direction;
+ // if we went to zero, we need to draw
+ if (w == 0) {
+ int i = x0 >> STBTT_FIXSHIFT;
+ int j = x1 >> STBTT_FIXSHIFT;
+
+ if (i < len && j >= 0) {
+ if (i == j) {
+ // x0,x1 are the same pixel, so compute combined coverage
+ scanline[i] = scanline[i] + (stbtt_uint8) ((x1 - x0) * max_weight >> STBTT_FIXSHIFT);
+ } else {
+ if (i >= 0) // add antialiasing for x0
+ scanline[i] = scanline[i] + (stbtt_uint8) (((STBTT_FIX - (x0 & STBTT_FIXMASK)) * max_weight) >> STBTT_FIXSHIFT);
+ else
+ i = -1; // clip
+
+ if (j < len) // add antialiasing for x1
+ scanline[j] = scanline[j] + (stbtt_uint8) (((x1 & STBTT_FIXMASK) * max_weight) >> STBTT_FIXSHIFT);
+ else
+ j = len; // clip
+
+ for (++i; i < j; ++i) // fill pixels between x0 and x1
+ scanline[i] = scanline[i] + (stbtt_uint8) max_weight;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ }
+
+ e = e->next;
+ }
+}
+
+static void stbtt__rasterize_sorted_edges(stbtt__bitmap *result, stbtt__edge *e, int n, int vsubsample, int off_x, int off_y, void *userdata)
+{
+ stbtt__hheap hh = { 0, 0, 0 };
+ stbtt__active_edge *active = NULL;
+ int y,j=0;
+ int max_weight = (255 / vsubsample); // weight per vertical scanline
+ int s; // vertical subsample index
+ unsigned char scanline_data[512], *scanline;
+
+ if (result->w > 512)
+ scanline = (unsigned char *) STBTT_malloc(result->w, userdata);
+ else
+ scanline = scanline_data;
+
+ y = off_y * vsubsample;
+ e[n].y0 = (off_y + result->h) * (float) vsubsample + 1;
+
+ while (j < result->h) {
+ STBTT_memset(scanline, 0, result->w);
+ for (s=0; s < vsubsample; ++s) {
+ // find center of pixel for this scanline
+ float scan_y = y + 0.5f;
+ stbtt__active_edge **step = &active;
+
+ // update all active edges;
+ // remove all active edges that terminate before the center of this scanline
+ while (*step) {
+ stbtt__active_edge * z = *step;
+ if (z->ey <= scan_y) {
+ *step = z->next; // delete from list
+ STBTT_assert(z->direction);
+ z->direction = 0;
+ stbtt__hheap_free(&hh, z);
+ } else {
+ z->x += z->dx; // advance to position for current scanline
+ step = &((*step)->next); // advance through list
+ }
+ }
+
+ // resort the list if needed
+ for(;;) {
+ int changed=0;
+ step = &active;
+ while (*step && (*step)->next) {
+ if ((*step)->x > (*step)->next->x) {
+ stbtt__active_edge *t = *step;
+ stbtt__active_edge *q = t->next;
+
+ t->next = q->next;
+ q->next = t;
+ *step = q;
+ changed = 1;
+ }
+ step = &(*step)->next;
+ }
+ if (!changed) break;
+ }
+
+ // insert all edges that start before the center of this scanline -- omit ones that also end on this scanline
+ while (e->y0 <= scan_y) {
+ if (e->y1 > scan_y) {
+ stbtt__active_edge *z = stbtt__new_active(&hh, e, off_x, scan_y, userdata);
+ if (z != NULL) {
+ // find insertion point
+ if (active == NULL)
+ active = z;
+ else if (z->x < active->x) {
+ // insert at front
+ z->next = active;
+ active = z;
+ } else {
+ // find thing to insert AFTER
+ stbtt__active_edge *p = active;
+ while (p->next && p->next->x < z->x)
+ p = p->next;
+ // at this point, p->next->x is NOT < z->x
+ z->next = p->next;
+ p->next = z;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ ++e;
+ }
+
+ // now process all active edges in XOR fashion
+ if (active)
+ stbtt__fill_active_edges(scanline, result->w, active, max_weight);
+
+ ++y;
+ }
+ STBTT_memcpy(result->pixels + j * result->stride, scanline, result->w);
+ ++j;
+ }
+
+ stbtt__hheap_cleanup(&hh, userdata);
+
+ if (scanline != scanline_data)
+ STBTT_free(scanline, userdata);
+}
+
+#elif STBTT_RASTERIZER_VERSION == 2
+
+// the edge passed in here does not cross the vertical line at x or the vertical line at x+1
+// (i.e. it has already been clipped to those)
+static void stbtt__handle_clipped_edge(float *scanline, int x, stbtt__active_edge *e, float x0, float y0, float x1, float y1)
+{
+ if (y0 == y1) return;
+ STBTT_assert(y0 < y1);
+ STBTT_assert(e->sy <= e->ey);
+ if (y0 > e->ey) return;
+ if (y1 < e->sy) return;
+ if (y0 < e->sy) {
+ x0 += (x1-x0) * (e->sy - y0) / (y1-y0);
+ y0 = e->sy;
+ }
+ if (y1 > e->ey) {
+ x1 += (x1-x0) * (e->ey - y1) / (y1-y0);
+ y1 = e->ey;
+ }
+
+ if (x0 == x)
+ STBTT_assert(x1 <= x+1);
+ else if (x0 == x+1)
+ STBTT_assert(x1 >= x);
+ else if (x0 <= x)
+ STBTT_assert(x1 <= x);
+ else if (x0 >= x+1)
+ STBTT_assert(x1 >= x+1);
+ else
+ STBTT_assert(x1 >= x && x1 <= x+1);
+
+ if (x0 <= x && x1 <= x)
+ scanline[x] += e->direction * (y1-y0);
+ else if (x0 >= x+1 && x1 >= x+1)
+ ;
+ else {
+ STBTT_assert(x0 >= x && x0 <= x+1 && x1 >= x && x1 <= x+1);
+ scanline[x] += e->direction * (y1-y0) * (1-((x0-x)+(x1-x))/2); // coverage = 1 - average x position
+ }
+}
+
+static void stbtt__fill_active_edges_new(float *scanline, float *scanline_fill, int len, stbtt__active_edge *e, float y_top)
+{
+ float y_bottom = y_top+1;
+
+ while (e) {
+ // brute force every pixel
+
+ // compute intersection points with top & bottom
+ STBTT_assert(e->ey >= y_top);
+
+ if (e->fdx == 0) {
+ float x0 = e->fx;
+ if (x0 < len) {
+ if (x0 >= 0) {
+ stbtt__handle_clipped_edge(scanline,(int) x0,e, x0,y_top, x0,y_bottom);
+ stbtt__handle_clipped_edge(scanline_fill-1,(int) x0+1,e, x0,y_top, x0,y_bottom);
+ } else {
+ stbtt__handle_clipped_edge(scanline_fill-1,0,e, x0,y_top, x0,y_bottom);
+ }
+ }
+ } else {
+ float x0 = e->fx;
+ float dx = e->fdx;
+ float xb = x0 + dx;
+ float x_top, x_bottom;
+ float sy0,sy1;
+ float dy = e->fdy;
+ STBTT_assert(e->sy <= y_bottom && e->ey >= y_top);
+
+ // compute endpoints of line segment clipped to this scanline (if the
+ // line segment starts on this scanline. x0 is the intersection of the
+ // line with y_top, but that may be off the line segment.
+ if (e->sy > y_top) {
+ x_top = x0 + dx * (e->sy - y_top);
+ sy0 = e->sy;
+ } else {
+ x_top = x0;
+ sy0 = y_top;
+ }
+ if (e->ey < y_bottom) {
+ x_bottom = x0 + dx * (e->ey - y_top);
+ sy1 = e->ey;
+ } else {
+ x_bottom = xb;
+ sy1 = y_bottom;
+ }
+
+ if (x_top >= 0 && x_bottom >= 0 && x_top < len && x_bottom < len) {
+ // from here on, we don't have to range check x values
+
+ if ((int) x_top == (int) x_bottom) {
+ float height;
+ // simple case, only spans one pixel
+ int x = (int) x_top;
+ height = sy1 - sy0;
+ STBTT_assert(x >= 0 && x < len);
+ scanline[x] += e->direction * (1-((x_top - x) + (x_bottom-x))/2) * height;
+ scanline_fill[x] += e->direction * height; // everything right of this pixel is filled
+ } else {
+ int x,x1,x2;
+ float y_crossing, step, sign, area;
+ // covers 2+ pixels
+ if (x_top > x_bottom) {
+ // flip scanline vertically; signed area is the same
+ float t;
+ sy0 = y_bottom - (sy0 - y_top);
+ sy1 = y_bottom - (sy1 - y_top);
+ t = sy0, sy0 = sy1, sy1 = t;
+ t = x_bottom, x_bottom = x_top, x_top = t;
+ dx = -dx;
+ dy = -dy;
+ t = x0, x0 = xb, xb = t;
+ }
+
+ x1 = (int) x_top;
+ x2 = (int) x_bottom;
+ // compute intersection with y axis at x1+1
+ y_crossing = (x1+1 - x0) * dy + y_top;
+
+ sign = e->direction;
+ // area of the rectangle covered from y0..y_crossing
+ area = sign * (y_crossing-sy0);
+ // area of the triangle (x_top,y0), (x+1,y0), (x+1,y_crossing)
+ scanline[x1] += area * (1-((x_top - x1)+(x1+1-x1))/2);
+
+ step = sign * dy;
+ for (x = x1+1; x < x2; ++x) {
+ scanline[x] += area + step/2;
+ area += step;
+ }
+ y_crossing += dy * (x2 - (x1+1));
+
+ STBTT_assert(STBTT_fabs(area) <= 1.01f);
+
+ scanline[x2] += area + sign * (1-((x2-x2)+(x_bottom-x2))/2) * (sy1-y_crossing);
+
+ scanline_fill[x2] += sign * (sy1-sy0);
+ }
+ } else {
+ // if edge goes outside of box we're drawing, we require
+ // clipping logic. since this does not match the intended use
+ // of this library, we use a different, very slow brute
+ // force implementation
+ int x;
+ for (x=0; x < len; ++x) {
+ // cases:
+ //
+ // there can be up to two intersections with the pixel. any intersection
+ // with left or right edges can be handled by splitting into two (or three)
+ // regions. intersections with top & bottom do not necessitate case-wise logic.
+ //
+ // the old way of doing this found the intersections with the left & right edges,
+ // then used some simple logic to produce up to three segments in sorted order
+ // from top-to-bottom. however, this had a problem: if an x edge was epsilon
+ // across the x border, then the corresponding y position might not be distinct
+ // from the other y segment, and it might ignored as an empty segment. to avoid
+ // that, we need to explicitly produce segments based on x positions.
+
+ // rename variables to clear pairs
+ float y0 = y_top;
+ float x1 = (float) (x);
+ float x2 = (float) (x+1);
+ float x3 = xb;
+ float y3 = y_bottom;
+ float y1,y2;
+
+ // x = e->x + e->dx * (y-y_top)
+ // (y-y_top) = (x - e->x) / e->dx
+ // y = (x - e->x) / e->dx + y_top
+ y1 = (x - x0) / dx + y_top;
+ y2 = (x+1 - x0) / dx + y_top;
+
+ if (x0 < x1 && x3 > x2) { // three segments descending down-right
+ stbtt__handle_clipped_edge(scanline,x,e, x0,y0, x1,y1);
+ stbtt__handle_clipped_edge(scanline,x,e, x1,y1, x2,y2);
+ stbtt__handle_clipped_edge(scanline,x,e, x2,y2, x3,y3);
+ } else if (x3 < x1 && x0 > x2) { // three segments descending down-left
+ stbtt__handle_clipped_edge(scanline,x,e, x0,y0, x2,y2);
+ stbtt__handle_clipped_edge(scanline,x,e, x2,y2, x1,y1);
+ stbtt__handle_clipped_edge(scanline,x,e, x1,y1, x3,y3);
+ } else if (x0 < x1 && x3 > x1) { // two segments across x, down-right
+ stbtt__handle_clipped_edge(scanline,x,e, x0,y0, x1,y1);
+ stbtt__handle_clipped_edge(scanline,x,e, x1,y1, x3,y3);
+ } else if (x3 < x1 && x0 > x1) { // two segments across x, down-left
+ stbtt__handle_clipped_edge(scanline,x,e, x0,y0, x1,y1);
+ stbtt__handle_clipped_edge(scanline,x,e, x1,y1, x3,y3);
+ } else if (x0 < x2 && x3 > x2) { // two segments across x+1, down-right
+ stbtt__handle_clipped_edge(scanline,x,e, x0,y0, x2,y2);
+ stbtt__handle_clipped_edge(scanline,x,e, x2,y2, x3,y3);
+ } else if (x3 < x2 && x0 > x2) { // two segments across x+1, down-left
+ stbtt__handle_clipped_edge(scanline,x,e, x0,y0, x2,y2);
+ stbtt__handle_clipped_edge(scanline,x,e, x2,y2, x3,y3);
+ } else { // one segment
+ stbtt__handle_clipped_edge(scanline,x,e, x0,y0, x3,y3);
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ e = e->next;
+ }
+}
+
+// directly AA rasterize edges w/o supersampling
+static void stbtt__rasterize_sorted_edges(stbtt__bitmap *result, stbtt__edge *e, int n, int vsubsample, int off_x, int off_y, void *userdata)
+{
+ stbtt__hheap hh = { 0, 0, 0 };
+ stbtt__active_edge *active = NULL;
+ int y,j=0, i;
+ float scanline_data[129], *scanline, *scanline2;
+
+ STBTT__NOTUSED(vsubsample);
+
+ if (result->w > 64)
+ scanline = (float *) STBTT_malloc((result->w*2+1) * sizeof(float), userdata);
+ else
+ scanline = scanline_data;
+
+ scanline2 = scanline + result->w;
+
+ y = off_y;
+ e[n].y0 = (float) (off_y + result->h) + 1;
+
+ while (j < result->h) {
+ // find center of pixel for this scanline
+ float scan_y_top = y + 0.0f;
+ float scan_y_bottom = y + 1.0f;
+ stbtt__active_edge **step = &active;
+
+ STBTT_memset(scanline , 0, result->w*sizeof(scanline[0]));
+ STBTT_memset(scanline2, 0, (result->w+1)*sizeof(scanline[0]));
+
+ // update all active edges;
+ // remove all active edges that terminate before the top of this scanline
+ while (*step) {
+ stbtt__active_edge * z = *step;
+ if (z->ey <= scan_y_top) {
+ *step = z->next; // delete from list
+ STBTT_assert(z->direction);
+ z->direction = 0;
+ stbtt__hheap_free(&hh, z);
+ } else {
+ step = &((*step)->next); // advance through list
+ }
+ }
+
+ // insert all edges that start before the bottom of this scanline
+ while (e->y0 <= scan_y_bottom) {
+ if (e->y0 != e->y1) {
+ stbtt__active_edge *z = stbtt__new_active(&hh, e, off_x, scan_y_top, userdata);
+ if (z != NULL) {
+ STBTT_assert(z->ey >= scan_y_top);
+ // insert at front
+ z->next = active;
+ active = z;
+ }
+ }
+ ++e;
+ }
+
+ // now process all active edges
+ if (active)
+ stbtt__fill_active_edges_new(scanline, scanline2+1, result->w, active, scan_y_top);
+
+ {
+ float sum = 0;
+ for (i=0; i < result->w; ++i) {
+ float k;
+ int m;
+ sum += scanline2[i];
+ k = scanline[i] + sum;
+ k = (float) STBTT_fabs(k)*255 + 0.5f;
+ m = (int) k;
+ if (m > 255) m = 255;
+ result->pixels[j*result->stride + i] = (unsigned char) m;
+ }
+ }
+ // advance all the edges
+ step = &active;
+ while (*step) {
+ stbtt__active_edge *z = *step;
+ z->fx += z->fdx; // advance to position for current scanline
+ step = &((*step)->next); // advance through list
+ }
+
+ ++y;
+ ++j;
+ }
+
+ stbtt__hheap_cleanup(&hh, userdata);
+
+ if (scanline != scanline_data)
+ STBTT_free(scanline, userdata);
+}
+#else
+#error "Unrecognized value of STBTT_RASTERIZER_VERSION"
+#endif
+
+#define STBTT__COMPARE(a,b) ((a)->y0 < (b)->y0)
+
+static void stbtt__sort_edges_ins_sort(stbtt__edge *p, int n)
+{
+ int i,j;
+ for (i=1; i < n; ++i) {
+ stbtt__edge t = p[i], *a = &t;
+ j = i;
+ while (j > 0) {
+ stbtt__edge *b = &p[j-1];
+ int c = STBTT__COMPARE(a,b);
+ if (!c) break;
+ p[j] = p[j-1];
+ --j;
+ }
+ if (i != j)
+ p[j] = t;
+ }
+}
+
+static void stbtt__sort_edges_quicksort(stbtt__edge *p, int n)
+{
+ /* threshhold for transitioning to insertion sort */
+ while (n > 12) {
+ stbtt__edge t;
+ int c01,c12,c,m,i,j;
+
+ /* compute median of three */
+ m = n >> 1;
+ c01 = STBTT__COMPARE(&p[0],&p[m]);
+ c12 = STBTT__COMPARE(&p[m],&p[n-1]);
+ /* if 0 >= mid >= end, or 0 < mid < end, then use mid */
+ if (c01 != c12) {
+ /* otherwise, we'll need to swap something else to middle */
+ int z;
+ c = STBTT__COMPARE(&p[0],&p[n-1]);
+ /* 0>mid && mid<n: 0>n => n; 0<n => 0 */
+ /* 0<mid && mid>n: 0>n => 0; 0<n => n */
+ z = (c == c12) ? 0 : n-1;
+ t = p[z];
+ p[z] = p[m];
+ p[m] = t;
+ }
+ /* now p[m] is the median-of-three */
+ /* swap it to the beginning so it won't move around */
+ t = p[0];
+ p[0] = p[m];
+ p[m] = t;
+
+ /* partition loop */
+ i=1;
+ j=n-1;
+ for(;;) {
+ /* handling of equality is crucial here */
+ /* for sentinels & efficiency with duplicates */
+ for (;;++i) {
+ if (!STBTT__COMPARE(&p[i], &p[0])) break;
+ }
+ for (;;--j) {
+ if (!STBTT__COMPARE(&p[0], &p[j])) break;
+ }
+ /* make sure we haven't crossed */
+ if (i >= j) break;
+ t = p[i];
+ p[i] = p[j];
+ p[j] = t;
+
+ ++i;
+ --j;
+ }
+ /* recurse on smaller side, iterate on larger */
+ if (j < (n-i)) {
+ stbtt__sort_edges_quicksort(p,j);
+ p = p+i;
+ n = n-i;
+ } else {
+ stbtt__sort_edges_quicksort(p+i, n-i);
+ n = j;
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+static void stbtt__sort_edges(stbtt__edge *p, int n)
+{
+ stbtt__sort_edges_quicksort(p, n);
+ stbtt__sort_edges_ins_sort(p, n);
+}
+
+typedef struct
+{
+ float x,y;
+} stbtt__point;
+
+static void stbtt__rasterize(stbtt__bitmap *result, stbtt__point *pts, int *wcount, int windings, float scale_x, float scale_y, float shift_x, float shift_y, int off_x, int off_y, int invert, void *userdata)
+{
+ float y_scale_inv = invert ? -scale_y : scale_y;
+ stbtt__edge *e;
+ int n,i,j,k,m;
+#if STBTT_RASTERIZER_VERSION == 1
+ int vsubsample = result->h < 8 ? 15 : 5;
+#elif STBTT_RASTERIZER_VERSION == 2
+ int vsubsample = 1;
+#else
+ #error "Unrecognized value of STBTT_RASTERIZER_VERSION"
+#endif
+ // vsubsample should divide 255 evenly; otherwise we won't reach full opacity
+
+ // now we have to blow out the windings into explicit edge lists
+ n = 0;
+ for (i=0; i < windings; ++i)
+ n += wcount[i];
+
+ e = (stbtt__edge *) STBTT_malloc(sizeof(*e) * (n+1), userdata); // add an extra one as a sentinel
+ if (e == 0) return;
+ n = 0;
+
+ m=0;
+ for (i=0; i < windings; ++i) {
+ stbtt__point *p = pts + m;
+ m += wcount[i];
+ j = wcount[i]-1;
+ for (k=0; k < wcount[i]; j=k++) {
+ int a=k,b=j;
+ // skip the edge if horizontal
+ if (p[j].y == p[k].y)
+ continue;
+ // add edge from j to k to the list
+ e[n].invert = 0;
+ if (invert ? p[j].y > p[k].y : p[j].y < p[k].y) {
+ e[n].invert = 1;
+ a=j,b=k;
+ }
+ e[n].x0 = p[a].x * scale_x + shift_x;
+ e[n].y0 = (p[a].y * y_scale_inv + shift_y) * vsubsample;
+ e[n].x1 = p[b].x * scale_x + shift_x;
+ e[n].y1 = (p[b].y * y_scale_inv + shift_y) * vsubsample;
+ ++n;
+ }
+ }
+
+ // now sort the edges by their highest point (should snap to integer, and then by x)
+ //STBTT_sort(e, n, sizeof(e[0]), stbtt__edge_compare);
+ stbtt__sort_edges(e, n);
+
+ // now, traverse the scanlines and find the intersections on each scanline, use xor winding rule
+ stbtt__rasterize_sorted_edges(result, e, n, vsubsample, off_x, off_y, userdata);
+
+ STBTT_free(e, userdata);
+}
+
+static void stbtt__add_point(stbtt__point *points, int n, float x, float y)
+{
+ if (!points) return; // during first pass, it's unallocated
+ points[n].x = x;
+ points[n].y = y;
+}
+
+// tesselate until threshhold p is happy... @TODO warped to compensate for non-linear stretching
+static int stbtt__tesselate_curve(stbtt__point *points, int *num_points, float x0, float y0, float x1, float y1, float x2, float y2, float objspace_flatness_squared, int n)
+{
+ // midpoint
+ float mx = (x0 + 2*x1 + x2)/4;
+ float my = (y0 + 2*y1 + y2)/4;
+ // versus directly drawn line
+ float dx = (x0+x2)/2 - mx;
+ float dy = (y0+y2)/2 - my;
+ if (n > 16) // 65536 segments on one curve better be enough!
+ return 1;
+ if (dx*dx+dy*dy > objspace_flatness_squared) { // half-pixel error allowed... need to be smaller if AA
+ stbtt__tesselate_curve(points, num_points, x0,y0, (x0+x1)/2.0f,(y0+y1)/2.0f, mx,my, objspace_flatness_squared,n+1);
+ stbtt__tesselate_curve(points, num_points, mx,my, (x1+x2)/2.0f,(y1+y2)/2.0f, x2,y2, objspace_flatness_squared,n+1);
+ } else {
+ stbtt__add_point(points, *num_points,x2,y2);
+ *num_points = *num_points+1;
+ }
+ return 1;
+}
+
+static void stbtt__tesselate_cubic(stbtt__point *points, int *num_points, float x0, float y0, float x1, float y1, float x2, float y2, float x3, float y3, float objspace_flatness_squared, int n)
+{
+ // @TODO this "flatness" calculation is just made-up nonsense that seems to work well enough
+ float dx0 = x1-x0;
+ float dy0 = y1-y0;
+ float dx1 = x2-x1;
+ float dy1 = y2-y1;
+ float dx2 = x3-x2;
+ float dy2 = y3-y2;
+ float dx = x3-x0;
+ float dy = y3-y0;
+ float longlen = (float) (STBTT_sqrt(dx0*dx0+dy0*dy0)+STBTT_sqrt(dx1*dx1+dy1*dy1)+STBTT_sqrt(dx2*dx2+dy2*dy2));
+ float shortlen = (float) STBTT_sqrt(dx*dx+dy*dy);
+ float flatness_squared = longlen*longlen-shortlen*shortlen;
+
+ if (n > 16) // 65536 segments on one curve better be enough!
+ return;
+
+ if (flatness_squared > objspace_flatness_squared) {
+ float x01 = (x0+x1)/2;
+ float y01 = (y0+y1)/2;
+ float x12 = (x1+x2)/2;
+ float y12 = (y1+y2)/2;
+ float x23 = (x2+x3)/2;
+ float y23 = (y2+y3)/2;
+
+ float xa = (x01+x12)/2;
+ float ya = (y01+y12)/2;
+ float xb = (x12+x23)/2;
+ float yb = (y12+y23)/2;
+
+ float mx = (xa+xb)/2;
+ float my = (ya+yb)/2;
+
+ stbtt__tesselate_cubic(points, num_points, x0,y0, x01,y01, xa,ya, mx,my, objspace_flatness_squared,n+1);
+ stbtt__tesselate_cubic(points, num_points, mx,my, xb,yb, x23,y23, x3,y3, objspace_flatness_squared,n+1);
+ } else {
+ stbtt__add_point(points, *num_points,x3,y3);
+ *num_points = *num_points+1;
+ }
+}
+
+// returns number of contours
+static stbtt__point *stbtt_FlattenCurves(stbtt_vertex *vertices, int num_verts, float objspace_flatness, int **contour_lengths, int *num_contours, void *userdata)
+{
+ stbtt__point *points=0;
+ int num_points=0;
+
+ float objspace_flatness_squared = objspace_flatness * objspace_flatness;
+ int i,n=0,start=0, pass;
+
+ // count how many "moves" there are to get the contour count
+ for (i=0; i < num_verts; ++i)
+ if (vertices[i].type == STBTT_vmove)
+ ++n;
+
+ *num_contours = n;
+ if (n == 0) return 0;
+
+ *contour_lengths = (int *) STBTT_malloc(sizeof(**contour_lengths) * n, userdata);
+
+ if (*contour_lengths == 0) {
+ *num_contours = 0;
+ return 0;
+ }
+
+ // make two passes through the points so we don't need to realloc
+ for (pass=0; pass < 2; ++pass) {
+ float x=0,y=0;
+ if (pass == 1) {
+ points = (stbtt__point *) STBTT_malloc(num_points * sizeof(points[0]), userdata);
+ if (points == NULL) goto error;
+ }
+ num_points = 0;
+ n= -1;
+ for (i=0; i < num_verts; ++i) {
+ switch (vertices[i].type) {
+ case STBTT_vmove:
+ // start the next contour
+ if (n >= 0)
+ (*contour_lengths)[n] = num_points - start;
+ ++n;
+ start = num_points;
+
+ x = vertices[i].x, y = vertices[i].y;
+ stbtt__add_point(points, num_points++, x,y);
+ break;
+ case STBTT_vline:
+ x = vertices[i].x, y = vertices[i].y;
+ stbtt__add_point(points, num_points++, x, y);
+ break;
+ case STBTT_vcurve:
+ stbtt__tesselate_curve(points, &num_points, x,y,
+ vertices[i].cx, vertices[i].cy,
+ vertices[i].x, vertices[i].y,
+ objspace_flatness_squared, 0);
+ x = vertices[i].x, y = vertices[i].y;
+ break;
+ case STBTT_vcubic:
+ stbtt__tesselate_cubic(points, &num_points, x,y,
+ vertices[i].cx, vertices[i].cy,
+ vertices[i].cx1, vertices[i].cy1,
+ vertices[i].x, vertices[i].y,
+ objspace_flatness_squared, 0);
+ x = vertices[i].x, y = vertices[i].y;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ (*contour_lengths)[n] = num_points - start;
+ }
+
+ return points;
+error:
+ STBTT_free(points, userdata);
+ STBTT_free(*contour_lengths, userdata);
+ *contour_lengths = 0;
+ *num_contours = 0;
+ return NULL;
+}
+
+STBTT_DEF void stbtt_Rasterize(stbtt__bitmap *result, float flatness_in_pixels, stbtt_vertex *vertices, int num_verts, float scale_x, float scale_y, float shift_x, float shift_y, int x_off, int y_off, int invert, void *userdata)
+{
+ float scale = scale_x > scale_y ? scale_y : scale_x;
+ int winding_count, *winding_lengths;
+ stbtt__point *windings = stbtt_FlattenCurves(vertices, num_verts, flatness_in_pixels / scale, &winding_lengths, &winding_count, userdata);
+ if (windings) {
+ stbtt__rasterize(result, windings, winding_lengths, winding_count, scale_x, scale_y, shift_x, shift_y, x_off, y_off, invert, userdata);
+ STBTT_free(winding_lengths, userdata);
+ STBTT_free(windings, userdata);
+ }
+}
+
+STBTT_DEF void stbtt_FreeBitmap(unsigned char *bitmap, void *userdata)
+{
+ STBTT_free(bitmap, userdata);
+}
+
+STBTT_DEF unsigned char *stbtt_GetGlyphBitmapSubpixel(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, float scale_x, float scale_y, float shift_x, float shift_y, int glyph, int *width, int *height, int *xoff, int *yoff)
+{
+ int ix0,iy0,ix1,iy1;
+ stbtt__bitmap gbm;
+ stbtt_vertex *vertices;
+ int num_verts = stbtt_GetGlyphShape(info, glyph, &vertices);
+
+ if (scale_x == 0) scale_x = scale_y;
+ if (scale_y == 0) {
+ if (scale_x == 0) {
+ STBTT_free(vertices, info->userdata);
+ return NULL;
+ }
+ scale_y = scale_x;
+ }
+
+ stbtt_GetGlyphBitmapBoxSubpixel(info, glyph, scale_x, scale_y, shift_x, shift_y, &ix0,&iy0,&ix1,&iy1);
+
+ // now we get the size
+ gbm.w = (ix1 - ix0);
+ gbm.h = (iy1 - iy0);
+ gbm.pixels = NULL; // in case we error
+
+ if (width ) *width = gbm.w;
+ if (height) *height = gbm.h;
+ if (xoff ) *xoff = ix0;
+ if (yoff ) *yoff = iy0;
+
+ if (gbm.w && gbm.h) {
+ gbm.pixels = (unsigned char *) STBTT_malloc(gbm.w * gbm.h, info->userdata);
+ if (gbm.pixels) {
+ gbm.stride = gbm.w;
+
+ stbtt_Rasterize(&gbm, 0.35f, vertices, num_verts, scale_x, scale_y, shift_x, shift_y, ix0, iy0, 1, info->userdata);
+ }
+ }
+ STBTT_free(vertices, info->userdata);
+ return gbm.pixels;
+}
+
+STBTT_DEF unsigned char *stbtt_GetGlyphBitmap(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, float scale_x, float scale_y, int glyph, int *width, int *height, int *xoff, int *yoff)
+{
+ return stbtt_GetGlyphBitmapSubpixel(info, scale_x, scale_y, 0.0f, 0.0f, glyph, width, height, xoff, yoff);
+}
+
+STBTT_DEF void stbtt_MakeGlyphBitmapSubpixel(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, unsigned char *output, int out_w, int out_h, int out_stride, float scale_x, float scale_y, float shift_x, float shift_y, int glyph)
+{
+ int ix0,iy0;
+ stbtt_vertex *vertices;
+ int num_verts = stbtt_GetGlyphShape(info, glyph, &vertices);
+ stbtt__bitmap gbm;
+
+ stbtt_GetGlyphBitmapBoxSubpixel(info, glyph, scale_x, scale_y, shift_x, shift_y, &ix0,&iy0,0,0);
+ gbm.pixels = output;
+ gbm.w = out_w;
+ gbm.h = out_h;
+ gbm.stride = out_stride;
+
+ if (gbm.w && gbm.h)
+ stbtt_Rasterize(&gbm, 0.35f, vertices, num_verts, scale_x, scale_y, shift_x, shift_y, ix0,iy0, 1, info->userdata);
+
+ STBTT_free(vertices, info->userdata);
+}
+
+STBTT_DEF void stbtt_MakeGlyphBitmap(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, unsigned char *output, int out_w, int out_h, int out_stride, float scale_x, float scale_y, int glyph)
+{
+ stbtt_MakeGlyphBitmapSubpixel(info, output, out_w, out_h, out_stride, scale_x, scale_y, 0.0f,0.0f, glyph);
+}
+
+STBTT_DEF unsigned char *stbtt_GetCodepointBitmapSubpixel(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, float scale_x, float scale_y, float shift_x, float shift_y, int codepoint, int *width, int *height, int *xoff, int *yoff)
+{
+ return stbtt_GetGlyphBitmapSubpixel(info, scale_x, scale_y,shift_x,shift_y, stbtt_FindGlyphIndex(info,codepoint), width,height,xoff,yoff);
+}
+
+STBTT_DEF void stbtt_MakeCodepointBitmapSubpixel(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, unsigned char *output, int out_w, int out_h, int out_stride, float scale_x, float scale_y, float shift_x, float shift_y, int codepoint)
+{
+ stbtt_MakeGlyphBitmapSubpixel(info, output, out_w, out_h, out_stride, scale_x, scale_y, shift_x, shift_y, stbtt_FindGlyphIndex(info,codepoint));
+}
+
+STBTT_DEF unsigned char *stbtt_GetCodepointBitmap(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, float scale_x, float scale_y, int codepoint, int *width, int *height, int *xoff, int *yoff)
+{
+ return stbtt_GetCodepointBitmapSubpixel(info, scale_x, scale_y, 0.0f,0.0f, codepoint, width,height,xoff,yoff);
+}
+
+STBTT_DEF void stbtt_MakeCodepointBitmap(const stbtt_fontinfo *info, unsigned char *output, int out_w, int out_h, int out_stride, float scale_x, float scale_y, int codepoint)
+{
+ stbtt_MakeCodepointBitmapSubpixel(info, output, out_w, out_h, out_stride, scale_x, scale_y, 0.0f,0.0f, codepoint);
+}
+
+//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+//
+// bitmap baking
+//
+// This is SUPER-CRAPPY packing to keep source code small
+
+static int stbtt_BakeFontBitmap_internal(unsigned char *data, int offset, // font location (use offset=0 for plain .ttf)
+ float pixel_height, // height of font in pixels
+ unsigned char *pixels, int pw, int ph, // bitmap to be filled in
+ int first_char, int num_chars, // characters to bake
+ stbtt_bakedchar *chardata)
+{
+ float scale;
+ int x,y,bottom_y, i;
+ stbtt_fontinfo f;
+ f.userdata = NULL;
+ if (!stbtt_InitFont(&f, data, offset))
+ return -1;
+ STBTT_memset(pixels, 0, pw*ph); // background of 0 around pixels
+ x=y=1;
+ bottom_y = 1;
+
+ scale = stbtt_ScaleForPixelHeight(&f, pixel_height);
+
+ for (i=0; i < num_chars; ++i) {
+ int advance, lsb, x0,y0,x1,y1,gw,gh;
+ int g = stbtt_FindGlyphIndex(&f, first_char + i);
+ stbtt_GetGlyphHMetrics(&f, g, &advance, &lsb);
+ stbtt_GetGlyphBitmapBox(&f, g, scale,scale, &x0,&y0,&x1,&y1);
+ gw = x1-x0;
+ gh = y1-y0;
+ if (x + gw + 1 >= pw)
+ y = bottom_y, x = 1; // advance to next row
+ if (y + gh + 1 >= ph) // check if it fits vertically AFTER potentially moving to next row
+ return -i;
+ STBTT_assert(x+gw < pw);
+ STBTT_assert(y+gh < ph);
+ stbtt_MakeGlyphBitmap(&f, pixels+x+y*pw, gw,gh,pw, scale,scale, g);
+ chardata[i].x0 = (stbtt_int16) x;
+ chardata[i].y0 = (stbtt_int16) y;
+ chardata[i].x1 = (stbtt_int16) (x + gw);
+ chardata[i].y1 = (stbtt_int16) (y + gh);
+ chardata[i].xadvance = scale * advance;
+ chardata[i].xoff = (float) x0;
+ chardata[i].yoff = (float) y0;
+ x = x + gw + 1;
+ if (y+gh+1 > bottom_y)
+ bottom_y = y+gh+1;
+ }
+ return bottom_y;
+}
+
+STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetBakedQuad(stbtt_bakedchar *chardata, int pw, int ph, int char_index, float *xpos, float *ypos, stbtt_aligned_quad *q, int opengl_fillrule)
+{
+ float d3d_bias = opengl_fillrule ? 0 : -0.5f;
+ float ipw = 1.0f / pw, iph = 1.0f / ph;
+ stbtt_bakedchar *b = chardata + char_index;
+ int round_x = STBTT_ifloor((*xpos + b->xoff) + 0.5f);
+ int round_y = STBTT_ifloor((*ypos + b->yoff) + 0.5f);
+
+ q->x0 = round_x + d3d_bias;
+ q->y0 = round_y + d3d_bias;
+ q->x1 = round_x + b->x1 - b->x0 + d3d_bias;
+ q->y1 = round_y + b->y1 - b->y0 + d3d_bias;
+
+ q->s0 = b->x0 * ipw;
+ q->t0 = b->y0 * iph;
+ q->s1 = b->x1 * ipw;
+ q->t1 = b->y1 * iph;
+
+ *xpos += b->xadvance;
+}
+
+//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+//
+// rectangle packing replacement routines if you don't have stb_rect_pack.h
+//
+
+#ifndef STB_RECT_PACK_VERSION
+
+typedef int stbrp_coord;
+
+////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+// //
+// //
+// COMPILER WARNING ?!?!? //
+// //
+// //
+// if you get a compile warning due to these symbols being defined more than //
+// once, move #include "stb_rect_pack.h" before #include "stb_truetype.h" //
+// //
+////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+
+typedef struct
+{
+ int width,height;
+ int x,y,bottom_y;
+} stbrp_context;
+
+typedef struct
+{
+ unsigned char x;
+} stbrp_node;
+
+struct stbrp_rect
+{
+ stbrp_coord x,y;
+ int id,w,h,was_packed;
+};
+
+static void stbrp_init_target(stbrp_context *con, int pw, int ph, stbrp_node *nodes, int num_nodes)
+{
+ con->width = pw;
+ con->height = ph;
+ con->x = 0;
+ con->y = 0;
+ con->bottom_y = 0;
+ STBTT__NOTUSED(nodes);
+ STBTT__NOTUSED(num_nodes);
+}
+
+static void stbrp_pack_rects(stbrp_context *con, stbrp_rect *rects, int num_rects)
+{
+ int i;
+ for (i=0; i < num_rects; ++i) {
+ if (con->x + rects[i].w > con->width) {
+ con->x = 0;
+ con->y = con->bottom_y;
+ }
+ if (con->y + rects[i].h > con->height)
+ break;
+ rects[i].x = con->x;
+ rects[i].y = con->y;
+ rects[i].was_packed = 1;
+ con->x += rects[i].w;
+ if (con->y + rects[i].h > con->bottom_y)
+ con->bottom_y = con->y + rects[i].h;
+ }
+ for ( ; i < num_rects; ++i)
+ rects[i].was_packed = 0;
+}
+#endif
+
+//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+//
+// bitmap baking
+//
+// This is SUPER-AWESOME (tm Ryan Gordon) packing using stb_rect_pack.h. If
+// stb_rect_pack.h isn't available, it uses the BakeFontBitmap strategy.
+
+STBTT_DEF int stbtt_PackBegin(stbtt_pack_context *spc, unsigned char *pixels, int pw, int ph, int stride_in_bytes, int padding, void *alloc_context)
+{
+ stbrp_context *context = (stbrp_context *) STBTT_malloc(sizeof(*context) ,alloc_context);
+ int num_nodes = pw - padding;
+ stbrp_node *nodes = (stbrp_node *) STBTT_malloc(sizeof(*nodes ) * num_nodes,alloc_context);
+
+ if (context == NULL || nodes == NULL) {
+ if (context != NULL) STBTT_free(context, alloc_context);
+ if (nodes != NULL) STBTT_free(nodes , alloc_context);
+ return 0;
+ }
+
+ spc->user_allocator_context = alloc_context;
+ spc->width = pw;
+ spc->height = ph;
+ spc->pixels = pixels;
+ spc->pack_info = context;
+ spc->nodes = nodes;
+ spc->padding = padding;
+ spc->stride_in_bytes = stride_in_bytes != 0 ? stride_in_bytes : pw;
+ spc->h_oversample = 1;
+ spc->v_oversample = 1;
+
+ stbrp_init_target(context, pw-padding, ph-padding, nodes, num_nodes);
+
+ if (pixels)
+ STBTT_memset(pixels, 0, pw*ph); // background of 0 around pixels
+
+ return 1;
+}
+
+STBTT_DEF void stbtt_PackEnd (stbtt_pack_context *spc)
+{
+ STBTT_free(spc->nodes , spc->user_allocator_context);
+ STBTT_free(spc->pack_info, spc->user_allocator_context);
+}
+
+STBTT_DEF void stbtt_PackSetOversampling(stbtt_pack_context *spc, unsigned int h_oversample, unsigned int v_oversample)
+{
+ STBTT_assert(h_oversample <= STBTT_MAX_OVERSAMPLE);
+ STBTT_assert(v_oversample <= STBTT_MAX_OVERSAMPLE);
+ if (h_oversample <= STBTT_MAX_OVERSAMPLE)
+ spc->h_oversample = h_oversample;
+ if (v_oversample <= STBTT_MAX_OVERSAMPLE)
+ spc->v_oversample = v_oversample;
+}
+
+#define STBTT__OVER_MASK (STBTT_MAX_OVERSAMPLE-1)
+
+static void stbtt__h_prefilter(unsigned char *pixels, int w, int h, int stride_in_bytes, unsigned int kernel_width)
+{
+ unsigned char buffer[STBTT_MAX_OVERSAMPLE];
+ int safe_w = w - kernel_width;
+ int j;
+ STBTT_memset(buffer, 0, STBTT_MAX_OVERSAMPLE); // suppress bogus warning from VS2013 -analyze
+ for (j=0; j < h; ++j) {
+ int i;
+ unsigned int total;
+ STBTT_memset(buffer, 0, kernel_width);
+
+ total = 0;
+
+ // make kernel_width a constant in common cases so compiler can optimize out the divide
+ switch (kernel_width) {
+ case 2:
+ for (i=0; i <= safe_w; ++i) {
+ total += pixels[i] - buffer[i & STBTT__OVER_MASK];
+ buffer[(i+kernel_width) & STBTT__OVER_MASK] = pixels[i];
+ pixels[i] = (unsigned char) (total / 2);
+ }
+ break;
+ case 3:
+ for (i=0; i <= safe_w; ++i) {
+ total += pixels[i] - buffer[i & STBTT__OVER_MASK];
+ buffer[(i+kernel_width) & STBTT__OVER_MASK] = pixels[i];
+ pixels[i] = (unsigned char) (total / 3);
+ }
+ break;
+ case 4:
+ for (i=0; i <= safe_w; ++i) {
+ total += pixels[i] - buffer[i & STBTT__OVER_MASK];
+ buffer[(i+kernel_width) & STBTT__OVER_MASK] = pixels[i];
+ pixels[i] = (unsigned char) (total / 4);
+ }
+ break;
+ case 5:
+ for (i=0; i <= safe_w; ++i) {
+ total += pixels[i] - buffer[i & STBTT__OVER_MASK];
+ buffer[(i+kernel_width) & STBTT__OVER_MASK] = pixels[i];
+ pixels[i] = (unsigned char) (total / 5);
+ }
+ break;
+ default:
+ for (i=0; i <= safe_w; ++i) {
+ total += pixels[i] - buffer[i & STBTT__OVER_MASK];
+ buffer[(i+kernel_width) & STBTT__OVER_MASK] = pixels[i];
+ pixels[i] = (unsigned char) (total / kernel_width);
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+
+ for (; i < w; ++i) {
+ STBTT_assert(pixels[i] == 0);
+ total -= buffer[i & STBTT__OVER_MASK];
+ pixels[i] = (unsigned char) (total / kernel_width);
+ }
+
+ pixels += stride_in_bytes;
+ }
+}
+
+static void stbtt__v_prefilter(unsigned char *pixels, int w, int h, int stride_in_bytes, unsigned int kernel_width)
+{
+ unsigned char buffer[STBTT_MAX_OVERSAMPLE];
+ int safe_h = h - kernel_width;
+ int j;
+ STBTT_memset(buffer, 0, STBTT_MAX_OVERSAMPLE); // suppress bogus warning from VS2013 -analyze
+ for (j=0; j < w; ++j) {
+ int i;
+ unsigned int total;
+ STBTT_memset(buffer, 0, kernel_width);
+
+ total = 0;
+
+ // make kernel_width a constant in common cases so compiler can optimize out the divide
+ switch (kernel_width) {
+ case 2:
+ for (i=0; i <= safe_h; ++i) {
+ total += pixels[i*stride_in_bytes] - buffer[i & STBTT__OVER_MASK];
+ buffer[(i+kernel_width) & STBTT__OVER_MASK] = pixels[i*stride_in_bytes];
+ pixels[i*stride_in_bytes] = (unsigned char) (total / 2);
+ }
+ break;
+ case 3:
+ for (i=0; i <= safe_h; ++i) {
+ total += pixels[i*stride_in_bytes] - buffer[i & STBTT__OVER_MASK];
+ buffer[(i+kernel_width) & STBTT__OVER_MASK] = pixels[i*stride_in_bytes];
+ pixels[i*stride_in_bytes] = (unsigned char) (total / 3);
+ }
+ break;
+ case 4:
+ for (i=0; i <= safe_h; ++i) {
+ total += pixels[i*stride_in_bytes] - buffer[i & STBTT__OVER_MASK];
+ buffer[(i+kernel_width) & STBTT__OVER_MASK] = pixels[i*stride_in_bytes];
+ pixels[i*stride_in_bytes] = (unsigned char) (total / 4);
+ }
+ break;
+ case 5:
+ for (i=0; i <= safe_h; ++i) {
+ total += pixels[i*stride_in_bytes] - buffer[i & STBTT__OVER_MASK];
+ buffer[(i+kernel_width) & STBTT__OVER_MASK] = pixels[i*stride_in_bytes];
+ pixels[i*stride_in_bytes] = (unsigned char) (total / 5);
+ }
+ break;
+ default:
+ for (i=0; i <= safe_h; ++i) {
+ total += pixels[i*stride_in_bytes] - buffer[i & STBTT__OVER_MASK];
+ buffer[(i+kernel_width) & STBTT__OVER_MASK] = pixels[i*stride_in_bytes];
+ pixels[i*stride_in_bytes] = (unsigned char) (total / kernel_width);
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+
+ for (; i < h; ++i) {
+ STBTT_assert(pixels[i*stride_in_bytes] == 0);
+ total -= buffer[i & STBTT__OVER_MASK];
+ pixels[i*stride_in_bytes] = (unsigned char) (total / kernel_width);
+ }
+
+ pixels += 1;
+ }
+}
+
+static float stbtt__oversample_shift(int oversample)
+{
+ if (!oversample)
+ return 0.0f;
+
+ // The prefilter is a box filter of width "oversample",
+ // which shifts phase by (oversample - 1)/2 pixels in
+ // oversampled space. We want to shift in the opposite
+ // direction to counter this.
+ return (float)-(oversample - 1) / (2.0f * (float)oversample);
+}
+
+// rects array must be big enough to accommodate all characters in the given ranges
+STBTT_DEF int stbtt_PackFontRangesGatherRects(stbtt_pack_context *spc, const stbtt_fontinfo *info, stbtt_pack_range *ranges, int num_ranges, stbrp_rect *rects)
+{
+ int i,j,k;
+
+ k=0;
+ for (i=0; i < num_ranges; ++i) {
+ float fh = ranges[i].font_size;
+ float scale = fh > 0 ? stbtt_ScaleForPixelHeight(info, fh) : stbtt_ScaleForMappingEmToPixels(info, -fh);
+ ranges[i].h_oversample = (unsigned char) spc->h_oversample;
+ ranges[i].v_oversample = (unsigned char) spc->v_oversample;
+ for (j=0; j < ranges[i].num_chars; ++j) {
+ int x0,y0,x1,y1;
+ int codepoint = ranges[i].array_of_unicode_codepoints == NULL ? ranges[i].first_unicode_codepoint_in_range + j : ranges[i].array_of_unicode_codepoints[j];
+ int glyph = stbtt_FindGlyphIndex(info, codepoint);
+ stbtt_GetGlyphBitmapBoxSubpixel(info,glyph,
+ scale * spc->h_oversample,
+ scale * spc->v_oversample,
+ 0,0,
+ &x0,&y0,&x1,&y1);
+ rects[k].w = (stbrp_coord) (x1-x0 + spc->padding + spc->h_oversample-1);
+ rects[k].h = (stbrp_coord) (y1-y0 + spc->padding + spc->v_oversample-1);
+ ++k;
+ }
+ }
+
+ return k;
+}
+
+// rects array must be big enough to accommodate all characters in the given ranges
+STBTT_DEF int stbtt_PackFontRangesRenderIntoRects(stbtt_pack_context *spc, const stbtt_fontinfo *info, stbtt_pack_range *ranges, int num_ranges, stbrp_rect *rects)
+{
+ int i,j,k, return_value = 1;
+
+ // save current values
+ int old_h_over = spc->h_oversample;
+ int old_v_over = spc->v_oversample;
+
+ k = 0;
+ for (i=0; i < num_ranges; ++i) {
+ float fh = ranges[i].font_size;
+ float scale = fh > 0 ? stbtt_ScaleForPixelHeight(info, fh) : stbtt_ScaleForMappingEmToPixels(info, -fh);
+ float recip_h,recip_v,sub_x,sub_y;
+ spc->h_oversample = ranges[i].h_oversample;
+ spc->v_oversample = ranges[i].v_oversample;
+ recip_h = 1.0f / spc->h_oversample;
+ recip_v = 1.0f / spc->v_oversample;
+ sub_x = stbtt__oversample_shift(spc->h_oversample);
+ sub_y = stbtt__oversample_shift(spc->v_oversample);
+ for (j=0; j < ranges[i].num_chars; ++j) {
+ stbrp_rect *r = &rects[k];
+ if (r->was_packed) {
+ stbtt_packedchar *bc = &ranges[i].chardata_for_range[j];
+ int advance, lsb, x0,y0,x1,y1;
+ int codepoint = ranges[i].array_of_unicode_codepoints == NULL ? ranges[i].first_unicode_codepoint_in_range + j : ranges[i].array_of_unicode_codepoints[j];
+ int glyph = stbtt_FindGlyphIndex(info, codepoint);
+ stbrp_coord pad = (stbrp_coord) spc->padding;
+
+ // pad on left and top
+ r->x += pad;
+ r->y += pad;
+ r->w -= pad;
+ r->h -= pad;
+ stbtt_GetGlyphHMetrics(info, glyph, &advance, &lsb);
+ stbtt_GetGlyphBitmapBox(info, glyph,
+ scale * spc->h_oversample,
+ scale * spc->v_oversample,
+ &x0,&y0,&x1,&y1);
+ stbtt_MakeGlyphBitmapSubpixel(info,
+ spc->pixels + r->x + r->y*spc->stride_in_bytes,
+ r->w - spc->h_oversample+1,
+ r->h - spc->v_oversample+1,
+ spc->stride_in_bytes,
+ scale * spc->h_oversample,
+ scale * spc->v_oversample,
+ 0,0,
+ glyph);
+
+ if (spc->h_oversample > 1)
+ stbtt__h_prefilter(spc->pixels + r->x + r->y*spc->stride_in_bytes,
+ r->w, r->h, spc->stride_in_bytes,
+ spc->h_oversample);
+
+ if (spc->v_oversample > 1)
+ stbtt__v_prefilter(spc->pixels + r->x + r->y*spc->stride_in_bytes,
+ r->w, r->h, spc->stride_in_bytes,
+ spc->v_oversample);
+
+ bc->x0 = (stbtt_int16) r->x;
+ bc->y0 = (stbtt_int16) r->y;
+ bc->x1 = (stbtt_int16) (r->x + r->w);
+ bc->y1 = (stbtt_int16) (r->y + r->h);
+ bc->xadvance = scale * advance;
+ bc->xoff = (float) x0 * recip_h + sub_x;
+ bc->yoff = (float) y0 * recip_v + sub_y;
+ bc->xoff2 = (x0 + r->w) * recip_h + sub_x;
+ bc->yoff2 = (y0 + r->h) * recip_v + sub_y;
+ } else {
+ return_value = 0; // if any fail, report failure
+ }
+
+ ++k;
+ }
+ }
+
+ // restore original values
+ spc->h_oversample = old_h_over;
+ spc->v_oversample = old_v_over;
+
+ return return_value;
+}
+
+STBTT_DEF void stbtt_PackFontRangesPackRects(stbtt_pack_context *spc, stbrp_rect *rects, int num_rects)
+{
+ stbrp_pack_rects((stbrp_context *) spc->pack_info, rects, num_rects);
+}
+
+STBTT_DEF int stbtt_PackFontRanges(stbtt_pack_context *spc, unsigned char *fontdata, int font_index, stbtt_pack_range *ranges, int num_ranges)
+{
+ stbtt_fontinfo info;
+ int i,j,n, return_value = 1;
+ //stbrp_context *context = (stbrp_context *) spc->pack_info;
+ stbrp_rect *rects;
+
+ // flag all characters as NOT packed
+ for (i=0; i < num_ranges; ++i)
+ for (j=0; j < ranges[i].num_chars; ++j)
+ ranges[i].chardata_for_range[j].x0 =
+ ranges[i].chardata_for_range[j].y0 =
+ ranges[i].chardata_for_range[j].x1 =
+ ranges[i].chardata_for_range[j].y1 = 0;
+
+ n = 0;
+ for (i=0; i < num_ranges; ++i)
+ n += ranges[i].num_chars;
+
+ rects = (stbrp_rect *) STBTT_malloc(sizeof(*rects) * n, spc->user_allocator_context);
+ if (rects == NULL)
+ return 0;
+
+ info.userdata = spc->user_allocator_context;
+ stbtt_InitFont(&info, fontdata, stbtt_GetFontOffsetForIndex(fontdata,font_index));
+
+ n = stbtt_PackFontRangesGatherRects(spc, &info, ranges, num_ranges, rects);
+
+ stbtt_PackFontRangesPackRects(spc, rects, n);
+
+ return_value = stbtt_PackFontRangesRenderIntoRects(spc, &info, ranges, num_ranges, rects);
+
+ STBTT_free(rects, spc->user_allocator_context);
+ return return_value;
+}
+
+STBTT_DEF int stbtt_PackFontRange(stbtt_pack_context *spc, unsigned char *fontdata, int font_index, float font_size,
+ int first_unicode_codepoint_in_range, int num_chars_in_range, stbtt_packedchar *chardata_for_range)
+{
+ stbtt_pack_range range;
+ range.first_unicode_codepoint_in_range = first_unicode_codepoint_in_range;
+ range.array_of_unicode_codepoints = NULL;
+ range.num_chars = num_chars_in_range;
+ range.chardata_for_range = chardata_for_range;
+ range.font_size = font_size;
+ return stbtt_PackFontRanges(spc, fontdata, font_index, &range, 1);
+}
+
+STBTT_DEF void stbtt_GetPackedQuad(stbtt_packedchar *chardata, int pw, int ph, int char_index, float *xpos, float *ypos, stbtt_aligned_quad *q, int align_to_integer)
+{
+ float ipw = 1.0f / pw, iph = 1.0f / ph;
+ stbtt_packedchar *b = chardata + char_index;
+
+ if (align_to_integer) {
+ float x = (float) STBTT_ifloor((*xpos + b->xoff) + 0.5f);
+ float y = (float) STBTT_ifloor((*ypos + b->yoff) + 0.5f);
+ q->x0 = x;
+ q->y0 = y;
+ q->x1 = x + b->xoff2 - b->xoff;
+ q->y1 = y + b->yoff2 - b->yoff;
+ } else {
+ q->x0 = *xpos + b->xoff;
+ q->y0 = *ypos + b->yoff;
+ q->x1 = *xpos + b->xoff2;
+ q->y1 = *ypos + b->yoff2;
+ }
+
+ q->s0 = b->x0 * ipw;
+ q->t0 = b->y0 * iph;
+ q->s1 = b->x1 * ipw;
+ q->t1 = b->y1 * iph;
+
+ *xpos += b->xadvance;
+}
+
+
+//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+//
+// font name matching -- recommended not to use this
+//
+
+// check if a utf8 string contains a prefix which is the utf16 string; if so return length of matching utf8 string
+static stbtt_int32 stbtt__CompareUTF8toUTF16_bigendian_prefix(stbtt_uint8 *s1, stbtt_int32 len1, stbtt_uint8 *s2, stbtt_int32 len2)
+{
+ stbtt_int32 i=0;
+
+ // convert utf16 to utf8 and compare the results while converting
+ while (len2) {
+ stbtt_uint16 ch = s2[0]*256 + s2[1];
+ if (ch < 0x80) {
+ if (i >= len1) return -1;
+ if (s1[i++] != ch) return -1;
+ } else if (ch < 0x800) {
+ if (i+1 >= len1) return -1;
+ if (s1[i++] != 0xc0 + (ch >> 6)) return -1;
+ if (s1[i++] != 0x80 + (ch & 0x3f)) return -1;
+ } else if (ch >= 0xd800 && ch < 0xdc00) {
+ stbtt_uint32 c;
+ stbtt_uint16 ch2 = s2[2]*256 + s2[3];
+ if (i+3 >= len1) return -1;
+ c = ((ch - 0xd800) << 10) + (ch2 - 0xdc00) + 0x10000;
+ if (s1[i++] != 0xf0 + (c >> 18)) return -1;
+ if (s1[i++] != 0x80 + ((c >> 12) & 0x3f)) return -1;
+ if (s1[i++] != 0x80 + ((c >> 6) & 0x3f)) return -1;
+ if (s1[i++] != 0x80 + ((c ) & 0x3f)) return -1;
+ s2 += 2; // plus another 2 below
+ len2 -= 2;
+ } else if (ch >= 0xdc00 && ch < 0xe000) {
+ return -1;
+ } else {
+ if (i+2 >= len1) return -1;
+ if (s1[i++] != 0xe0 + (ch >> 12)) return -1;
+ if (s1[i++] != 0x80 + ((ch >> 6) & 0x3f)) return -1;
+ if (s1[i++] != 0x80 + ((ch ) & 0x3f)) return -1;
+ }
+ s2 += 2;
+ len2 -= 2;
+ }
+ return i;
+}
+
+static int stbtt_CompareUTF8toUTF16_bigendian_internal(char *s1, int len1, char *s2, int len2)
+{
+ return len1 == stbtt__CompareUTF8toUTF16_bigendian_prefix((stbtt_uint8*) s1, len1, (stbtt_uint8*) s2, len2);
+}
+
+// returns results in whatever encoding you request... but note that 2-byte encodings
+// will be BIG-ENDIAN... use stbtt_CompareUTF8toUTF16_bigendian() to compare
+STBTT_DEF const char *stbtt_GetFontNameString(const stbtt_fontinfo *font, int *length, int platformID, int encodingID, int languageID, int nameID)
+{
+ stbtt_int32 i,count,stringOffset;
+ stbtt_uint8 *fc = font->data;
+ stbtt_uint32 offset = font->fontstart;
+ stbtt_uint32 nm = stbtt__find_table(fc, offset, "name");
+ if (!nm) return NULL;
+
+ count = ttUSHORT(fc+nm+2);
+ stringOffset = nm + ttUSHORT(fc+nm+4);
+ for (i=0; i < count; ++i) {
+ stbtt_uint32 loc = nm + 6 + 12 * i;
+ if (platformID == ttUSHORT(fc+loc+0) && encodingID == ttUSHORT(fc+loc+2)
+ && languageID == ttUSHORT(fc+loc+4) && nameID == ttUSHORT(fc+loc+6)) {
+ *length = ttUSHORT(fc+loc+8);
+ return (const char *) (fc+stringOffset+ttUSHORT(fc+loc+10));
+ }
+ }
+ return NULL;
+}
+
+static int stbtt__matchpair(stbtt_uint8 *fc, stbtt_uint32 nm, stbtt_uint8 *name, stbtt_int32 nlen, stbtt_int32 target_id, stbtt_int32 next_id)
+{
+ stbtt_int32 i;
+ stbtt_int32 count = ttUSHORT(fc+nm+2);
+ stbtt_int32 stringOffset = nm + ttUSHORT(fc+nm+4);
+
+ for (i=0; i < count; ++i) {
+ stbtt_uint32 loc = nm + 6 + 12 * i;
+ stbtt_int32 id = ttUSHORT(fc+loc+6);
+ if (id == target_id) {
+ // find the encoding
+ stbtt_int32 platform = ttUSHORT(fc+loc+0), encoding = ttUSHORT(fc+loc+2), language = ttUSHORT(fc+loc+4);
+
+ // is this a Unicode encoding?
+ if (platform == 0 || (platform == 3 && encoding == 1) || (platform == 3 && encoding == 10)) {
+ stbtt_int32 slen = ttUSHORT(fc+loc+8);
+ stbtt_int32 off = ttUSHORT(fc+loc+10);
+
+ // check if there's a prefix match
+ stbtt_int32 matchlen = stbtt__CompareUTF8toUTF16_bigendian_prefix(name, nlen, fc+stringOffset+off,slen);
+ if (matchlen >= 0) {
+ // check for target_id+1 immediately following, with same encoding & language
+ if (i+1 < count && ttUSHORT(fc+loc+12+6) == next_id && ttUSHORT(fc+loc+12) == platform && ttUSHORT(fc+loc+12+2) == encoding && ttUSHORT(fc+loc+12+4) == language) {
+ slen = ttUSHORT(fc+loc+12+8);
+ off = ttUSHORT(fc+loc+12+10);
+ if (slen == 0) {
+ if (matchlen == nlen)
+ return 1;
+ } else if (matchlen < nlen && name[matchlen] == ' ') {
+ ++matchlen;
+ if (stbtt_CompareUTF8toUTF16_bigendian_internal((char*) (name+matchlen), nlen-matchlen, (char*)(fc+stringOffset+off),slen))
+ return 1;
+ }
+ } else {
+ // if nothing immediately following
+ if (matchlen == nlen)
+ return 1;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+
+ // @TODO handle other encodings
+ }
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+static int stbtt__matches(stbtt_uint8 *fc, stbtt_uint32 offset, stbtt_uint8 *name, stbtt_int32 flags)
+{
+ stbtt_int32 nlen = (stbtt_int32) STBTT_strlen((char *) name);
+ stbtt_uint32 nm,hd;
+ if (!stbtt__isfont(fc+offset)) return 0;
+
+ // check italics/bold/underline flags in macStyle...
+ if (flags) {
+ hd = stbtt__find_table(fc, offset, "head");
+ if ((ttUSHORT(fc+hd+44) & 7) != (flags & 7)) return 0;
+ }
+
+ nm = stbtt__find_table(fc, offset, "name");
+ if (!nm) return 0;
+
+ if (flags) {
+ // if we checked the macStyle flags, then just check the family and ignore the subfamily
+ if (stbtt__matchpair(fc, nm, name, nlen, 16, -1)) return 1;
+ if (stbtt__matchpair(fc, nm, name, nlen, 1, -1)) return 1;
+ if (stbtt__matchpair(fc, nm, name, nlen, 3, -1)) return 1;
+ } else {
+ if (stbtt__matchpair(fc, nm, name, nlen, 16, 17)) return 1;
+ if (stbtt__matchpair(fc, nm, name, nlen, 1, 2)) return 1;
+ if (stbtt__matchpair(fc, nm, name, nlen, 3, -1)) return 1;
+ }
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+static int stbtt_FindMatchingFont_internal(unsigned char *font_collection, char *name_utf8, stbtt_int32 flags)
+{
+ stbtt_int32 i;
+ for (i=0;;++i) {
+ stbtt_int32 off = stbtt_GetFontOffsetForIndex(font_collection, i);
+ if (off < 0) return off;
+ if (stbtt__matches((stbtt_uint8 *) font_collection, off, (stbtt_uint8*) name_utf8, flags))
+ return off;
+ }
+}
+
+#if defined(__GNUC__) || defined(__clang__)
+#pragma GCC diagnostic push
+#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wcast-qual"
+#endif
+
+STBTT_DEF int stbtt_BakeFontBitmap(const unsigned char *data, int offset,
+ float pixel_height, unsigned char *pixels, int pw, int ph,
+ int first_char, int num_chars, stbtt_bakedchar *chardata)
+{
+ return stbtt_BakeFontBitmap_internal((unsigned char *) data, offset, pixel_height, pixels, pw, ph, first_char, num_chars, chardata);
+}
+
+STBTT_DEF int stbtt_GetFontOffsetForIndex(const unsigned char *data, int index)
+{
+ return stbtt_GetFontOffsetForIndex_internal((unsigned char *) data, index);
+}
+
+STBTT_DEF int stbtt_GetNumberOfFonts(const unsigned char *data)
+{
+ return stbtt_GetNumberOfFonts_internal((unsigned char *) data);
+}
+
+STBTT_DEF int stbtt_InitFont(stbtt_fontinfo *info, const unsigned char *data, int offset)
+{
+ return stbtt_InitFont_internal(info, (unsigned char *) data, offset);
+}
+
+STBTT_DEF int stbtt_FindMatchingFont(const unsigned char *fontdata, const char *name, int flags)
+{
+ return stbtt_FindMatchingFont_internal((unsigned char *) fontdata, (char *) name, flags);
+}
+
+STBTT_DEF int stbtt_CompareUTF8toUTF16_bigendian(const char *s1, int len1, const char *s2, int len2)
+{
+ return stbtt_CompareUTF8toUTF16_bigendian_internal((char *) s1, len1, (char *) s2, len2);
+}
+
+#if defined(__GNUC__) || defined(__clang__)
+#pragma GCC diagnostic pop
+#endif
+
+#endif // STB_TRUETYPE_IMPLEMENTATION
+
+
+// FULL VERSION HISTORY
+//
+// 1.12 (2016-10-25) suppress warnings about casting away const with -Wcast-qual
+// 1.11 (2016-04-02) fix unused-variable warning
+// 1.10 (2016-04-02) allow user-defined fabs() replacement
+// fix memory leak if fontsize=0.0
+// fix warning from duplicate typedef
+// 1.09 (2016-01-16) warning fix; avoid crash on outofmem; use alloc userdata for PackFontRanges
+// 1.08 (2015-09-13) document stbtt_Rasterize(); fixes for vertical & horizontal edges
+// 1.07 (2015-08-01) allow PackFontRanges to accept arrays of sparse codepoints;
+// allow PackFontRanges to pack and render in separate phases;
+// fix stbtt_GetFontOFfsetForIndex (never worked for non-0 input?);
+// fixed an assert() bug in the new rasterizer
+// replace assert() with STBTT_assert() in new rasterizer
+// 1.06 (2015-07-14) performance improvements (~35% faster on x86 and x64 on test machine)
+// also more precise AA rasterizer, except if shapes overlap
+// remove need for STBTT_sort
+// 1.05 (2015-04-15) fix misplaced definitions for STBTT_STATIC
+// 1.04 (2015-04-15) typo in example
+// 1.03 (2015-04-12) STBTT_STATIC, fix memory leak in new packing, various fixes
+// 1.02 (2014-12-10) fix various warnings & compile issues w/ stb_rect_pack, C++
+// 1.01 (2014-12-08) fix subpixel position when oversampling to exactly match
+// non-oversampled; STBTT_POINT_SIZE for packed case only
+// 1.00 (2014-12-06) add new PackBegin etc. API, w/ support for oversampling
+// 0.99 (2014-09-18) fix multiple bugs with subpixel rendering (ryg)
+// 0.9 (2014-08-07) support certain mac/iOS fonts without an MS platformID
+// 0.8b (2014-07-07) fix a warning
+// 0.8 (2014-05-25) fix a few more warnings
+// 0.7 (2013-09-25) bugfix: subpixel glyph bug fixed in 0.5 had come back
+// 0.6c (2012-07-24) improve documentation
+// 0.6b (2012-07-20) fix a few more warnings
+// 0.6 (2012-07-17) fix warnings; added stbtt_ScaleForMappingEmToPixels,
+// stbtt_GetFontBoundingBox, stbtt_IsGlyphEmpty
+// 0.5 (2011-12-09) bugfixes:
+// subpixel glyph renderer computed wrong bounding box
+// first vertex of shape can be off-curve (FreeSans)
+// 0.4b (2011-12-03) fixed an error in the font baking example
+// 0.4 (2011-12-01) kerning, subpixel rendering (tor)
+// bugfixes for:
+// codepoint-to-glyph conversion using table fmt=12
+// codepoint-to-glyph conversion using table fmt=4
+// stbtt_GetBakedQuad with non-square texture (Zer)
+// updated Hello World! sample to use kerning and subpixel
+// fixed some warnings
+// 0.3 (2009-06-24) cmap fmt=12, compound shapes (MM)
+// userdata, malloc-from-userdata, non-zero fill (stb)
+// 0.2 (2009-03-11) Fix unsigned/signed char warnings
+// 0.1 (2009-03-09) First public release
+//